Canon Digital Camera 0020C003 User Manual

EOS REBEL T6S (W)  
EOS 760D (W)  
E
INSTRUCTION  
MANUAL  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Item Check List  
Before starting, check that all the following items are included with your  
camera. If anything is missing, contact your dealer.  
Battery Pack  
LP-E17  
Battery Charger  
LC-E17/LC-E17E*  
Camera  
(with protective cover)  
(with eyecup and body cap)  
Wide Strap  
Interface Cable  
* Battery Charger LC-E17 or LC-E17E is provided. (The LC-E17E comes with a  
power cord.)  
The Instruction Manuals and CD-ROMs provided are listed on the next page.  
If you purchased a Lens Kit, check that the lenses are included.  
Depending on the Lens Kit type, lens instruction manuals may also be  
included.  
Be careful not to lose any of the above items.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
     
Instruction Manual and CD-ROMs  
The instruction manual consists of a booklet and electronic manuals  
(PDF files on the CD-ROM). The booklet is the Basic Instruction  
Manual. For more detailed instructions, see the Camera Instruction  
Manual on the CD-ROM.  
Camera and Wi-Fi/NFC Function  
Basic Instruction Manual  
Camera Instruction Manual CD-ROM  
Contains the following manuals (PDF files):  
• Camera Instruction Manual  
• Wi-Fi/NFC Function Instruction Manual  
• Quick Reference Guide  
Instructions for viewing the Camera Instruction Manual  
CD-ROM are on pages 416-417.  
EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk (Software CD-ROM)  
Contains software such as image-editing software and  
Software Instruction Manuals (PDF files).  
For more information and installation procedures of the  
software, see pages 420-421.  
Instructions for viewing the Software Instruction Manual  
are on page 422.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
 
Compatible Cards  
The camera can use the following cards regardless of capacity: If the  
card is new or was previously formatted by another camera or  
computer, format the card with this camera (p.65).  
• SD memory cards  
• SDHC memory cards*  
• SDXC memory cards*  
* UHS-I cards supported.  
Cards that Can Record Movies  
When shooting movies, use a large-capacity SD card rated SD  
Speed Class 6 “  
” or higher.  
If you use a slow-writing card when shooting movies, the movie may  
not be recorded properly. Also, if you play back a movie on a card  
with a slow reading speed, the movie may not play back properly.  
If you want to shoot still photos while shooting a movie, you will need  
an even faster card.  
To check the card’s reading/writing speed, refer to the card  
manufacturer’s Web site.  
In this manual, “card” refers to SD memory cards, SDHC memory  
cards, and SDXC memory cards.  
* The camera does not come with a card for recording images/  
movies. Please purchase it separately.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
     
Quick Start Guide  
Insert the battery (p.38).  
To charge the battery, see page 36.  
1
Insert the card (p.39).  
With the card’s label facing  
toward the back of the  
camera, insert it into the  
card slot.  
2
White index  
Red index Attach the lens (p.47).  
Align the lens’s white or red mount  
index with the camera’s mount  
index of the same color.  
3
4
5
Set the lens focus mode switch  
to <f> (p.47).  
Set the power switch to <1>,  
then set the Mode Dial to <A>  
(Scene Intelligent Auto) (p.76).  
Turn the Mode Dial while holding down  
the lock release button at the center.  
All the necessary camera settings  
will be set automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
 
Quick Start Guide  
Flip out the LCD monitor (p.41).  
When the LCD monitor displays the  
date/time/zone setting screens, see  
6
7
Focus on the subject (p.52).  
Look through the viewfinder and  
aim the viewfinder center over the  
subject.  
Press the shutter button halfway,  
and the camera will focus on the  
subject.  
If necessary, the built-in flash will be  
raised.  
Take the picture (p.52).  
Press the shutter button completely  
to take the picture.  
8
9
Review the picture.  
The captured image will be  
displayed for 2 sec. on the LCD  
monitor.  
To display the image again, press  
To shoot while looking at the LCD monitor, see “Live View  
Shooting” (p.201).  
To view the images captured so far, see “Image Playback” (p.107).  
To delete an image, see “Erasing Images” (p.318).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
Conventions Used in this Manual  
Icons in this Manual  
<6>  
: Indicates the Main Dial.  
<5>  
: Indicates the Quick Control Dial.  
<W><X><Y><Z>  
: Indicates the direction of the shift or move  
when the key on the Quick Control Dial is  
pressed.  
<0>  
: Indicates the Setting button.  
0, 9, 7, 8  
: Indicates that each function remains active  
for 4 sec., 6 sec., 10 sec., or 16 sec. after  
you let go of the button.  
* In this manual, the icons and markings indicating the camera’s buttons, dials,  
and settings correspond to the icons and markings on the camera and on the  
LCD monitor.  
3
J
: Indicates a function that can be changed by pressing the  
<M> button to change its settings.  
:
When shown on the upper right of a page, it indicates that the  
function is available only in the Creative Zone modes (p.31).  
(p.**)  
: Reference page numbers for more information.  
: Warning to prevent shooting problems.  
: Supplemental information.  
: Tips or advice for better shooting.  
: Troubleshooting advice.  
Basic Assumptions  
All operations explained in this manual assume that the power switch  
is set to <1> and the <R> switch is set to the left (Multi  
function lock released) (p.55).  
It is assumed that all the menu settings, Custom Functions, etc. are  
set to their defaults.  
The illustrations in this manual show the camera attached with the  
EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM lens as an example.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
     
Chapters  
Introduction  
Getting Started  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
Basic Shooting and Image Playback  
Setting the AF and Drive Modes  
Image Settings  
Advanced Operations  
Flash Photography  
Shooting with the LCD Monitor (Live View Shooting)  
Shooting Movies  
Handy Features  
Image Playback  
Post-Processing Images  
Printing Images  
Customizing the Camera  
Reference  
Viewing the CD-ROM Instruction Manuals /  
Downloading Images to Your Computer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
 
Contents at a Glance  
Shooting  
Shoot automatically  
Shoot continuously  
p.75-106 (Basic Zone modes)  
p.122 (i Continuous shooting)  
Take a picture of yourself in a group p.124 (j Self-timer)  
Freeze the action  
Blur the action  
p.160 (s Shutter-priority AE)  
Blur the background  
p.82 (C Creative Auto)  
Keep the background in sharp focus p.162 (f Aperture-priority AE)  
Adjust the image brightness (exposure)p.169 (Exposure compensation)  
Shoot in low light  
p.76, 176 (D Flash photography)  
p.132 (ISO speed setting)  
Shoot without flash  
p.81 (7 Flash Off)  
p.99 (b Flash off)  
Shoot fireworks at night  
p.166 (Bulb exposure)  
Shoot while viewing the LCD monitor p.201 (A Live View shooting)  
Use Creative filters  
Shoot movies  
p.210 (Creative filters)  
p.233 (k Movie shooting)  
Image Quality  
Shoot with image effects matching the subject p.135 (Picture Style)  
Make a large-size print of the picture  
p.126 (73, 83, 1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
 
Take many pictures  
p.126 (7a, 8a, b, c)  
AF (Focusing)  
Change the AF area selection mode p.114  
(
S
AF area selection mode)  
Shoot a moving subject  
p.89, 91, 112 (AI Servo AF)  
Playback  
View the images on the camera p.107 (x Playback)  
Search for pictures quickly  
p.292 (H Index display)  
p.293 (I Image browsing)  
Rate images  
p.298 (Ratings)  
Prevent important images  
p.316 (K Image protect)  
from accidental deletion  
Delete unnecessary images  
p.318 (L Delete)  
Auto play back images and movies p.308 (Slide show)  
View the photos or movies on a TV set p.312 (Video OUT)  
Adjust the LCD monitor brightness p.274 (LCD monitor brightness)  
Apply special effect to images p.326 (Creative filters)  
Printing  
Print pictures easily  
p.333 (Direct printing)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
Index to Features  
Power  
AF  
Battery  
AF operation  
p.110  
• Charging  
AF area selection mode p.114  
• Installing/Removing  
• Battery check  
• Checking battery  
information  
AF point selection  
Manual focusing  
p.116  
p.121  
Drive  
p.364  
Household power outlet p.365  
Drive mode  
p.122  
p.122  
p.124  
p.128  
Auto power off  
p.42  
Continuous shooting  
Self-timer  
Cards  
Maximum burst  
Installing/Removing  
Formatting  
p.65  
Image Quality  
Release shutter without cardp.272  
Image-recording quality p.126  
Picture Style  
White balance  
p.135  
p.142  
Lens  
Attaching/Detaching  
Zoom  
Auto Lighting Optimizer p.146  
Noise reduction for long  
Image Stabilizer  
exposures  
p.148  
Noise reduction for high  
ISO speeds  
Basic Settings  
p.147  
Dioptric adjustment  
Language  
p.51  
p.46  
p.44  
Lens aberration correctionp.150  
Reducing flicker  
Highlight tone priority  
Color space  
p.154  
p.353  
p.156  
Date/Time/Zone  
Beeper  
LCD Monitor  
Shooting  
Using the LCD Monitor p.41  
LCD auto off/on p.285  
Brightness adjustment p.274  
Shooting mode  
Feature guide  
ISO speed  
p.31  
p.73  
p.132  
p.130  
p.166  
p.167  
p.173  
p.366  
Touch screen  
p.62  
Aspect ratio  
Bulb  
Recording Images  
Metering mode  
Mirror lockup  
Remote control  
Creating/Selecting a folder p.275  
File numbering  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
 
Index to Features  
Exposure Adjustment  
Playback  
Exposure compensation p.169  
Image review time  
p.273  
AEB  
Single-image display  
Shooting information  
display  
p.107  
AE lock  
p.320  
p.292  
Flash  
Index display  
Image browsing  
(Jump display)  
Magnified view  
Image rotate  
Rating  
Built-in flash  
External flash  
p.293  
p.294  
p.297  
p.298  
p.304  
p.308  
Flash function settings p.183  
Wireless shooting  
p.189  
Live View Shooting  
Movie playback  
Slide show  
Live View shooting  
AF operation  
AF method  
p.216  
p.218  
Viewing images on a TV setp.312  
Protect  
Erase  
p.316  
p.318  
Continuous AF  
Touch Shutter  
Creative filters  
Image Editing  
Creative filters  
Resize  
p.326  
p.329  
p.331  
Movie Shooting  
Movie shooting  
AF method  
p.218  
p.245  
p.248  
p.249  
Cropping  
Movie recording size  
Movie Servo AF  
Sound recording  
Manual exposure  
Still photo shooting  
Digital zoom  
Printing  
p.336  
Customization  
Custom Functions (C.Fn) p.350  
My Menu  
p.360  
Software  
p.415  
HDR movies  
Miniature Effect Movies p.251  
Video snapshot p.253  
Wi-Fi/NFC function  
Wi-Fi/NFC Function Instruction  
Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13  
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14  
 
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15  
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16  
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
17  
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
18  
Contents  
Viewing the CD-ROM Instruction Manuals /  
Downloading Images to Your Computer  
415  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
19  
Safety Precautions  
The following precautions are provided to prevent harm or injury to  
yourself and others. Make sure to thoroughly understand and follow  
these precautions before using the product.  
If you experience any malfunctions, problems, or damage to the  
product, contact the nearest Canon Service Center or the dealer  
from whom you purchased the product.  
Follow the warnings below. Otherwise, death or  
serious injuries may result.  
Warnings  
To prevent fire, excessive heat, chemical leakage, explosions, and electrical shock,  
follow the safeguards below:  
• Do not use any batteries, power sources, or accessories not specified in the  
Instruction Manual. Do not use any home-made or modified batteries.  
• Do not short-circuit, disassemble, or modify the battery. Do not apply heat or solder  
to the battery. Do not expose the battery to fire or water. Do not subject the battery  
to strong physical shock.  
• Do not insert the battery’s plus and minus ends incorrectly.  
• Do not recharge the battery in temperatures outside the allowable ambient  
temperature range. Also, do not exceed the recharging time indicated in the  
Instruction Manual.  
• Do not insert any foreign metallic objects into the electrical contacts of the camera,  
accessories, connecting cables, etc.  
When disposing of a battery, insulate the electrical contacts with tape to prevent  
contact with other metallic objects or batteries. This is to prevent a fire or an  
explosion.  
If excessive heat, smoke, or fumes are emitted when recharging the battery,  
immediately unplug the battery charger from the power outlet to stop recharging.  
Otherwise, it may cause a fire, heat damage, or electrical shock.  
If the battery leaks, changes color, deforms, or emits smoke or fumes, remove it  
immediately. Be careful not to get burned in the process. It may cause a fire, electrical  
shock or skin burn if you keep using it.  
Prevent any battery leakage from contacting your eyes, skin, and clothing. It can  
cause blindness or skin problems. If the battery leakage contacts your eyes, skin, or  
clothing, flush the affected area with lots of clean water without rubbing it. See a  
physician immediately.  
Do not leave any cords near a heat source. It can deform the cord or melt the  
insulation and cause a fire or electrical shock.  
Do not hold the camera in the same position for long periods of time. Even if the  
camera does not feel too hot, prolonged contact with the same body part may cause  
skin redness, blistering or low-temperature contact burns. Using a tripod is  
recommended for people with circulation problems or very sensitive skin, or when  
using the camera in very hot places.  
Do not fire the flash at anyone driving a car or other vehicle. It may cause an  
accident.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
20  
   
Safety Precautions  
Do not fire the flash near a person’s eyes. It may impair the person’s vision. When  
using flash to photograph an infant, keep at least 1 meter/3.3 feet away.  
When the camera or accessories are not in use, make sure to remove the battery and  
disconnect the power plug from the equipment before storing. This is to prevent  
electrical shock, excessive heat, fire, or corrosion.  
Do not use the equipment where there is flammable gas. This is to prevent an explosion or  
a fire.  
If you drop the equipment and the casing breaks open to expose the internal parts, do  
not touch the internal parts. There is a possibility of an electrical shock.  
Do not disassemble or modify the equipment. High-voltage internal parts can cause  
electrical shock.  
Do not look at the sun or an extremely bright light source through the camera or lens.  
Doing so may damage your vision.  
Keep equipment out of the reach of children and infants, including when in use. Straps  
or cords may accidentally cause choking, electrical shock, or injury. Choking or injury  
may also occur if a child or infant accidentally swallows a camera part or accessory. If  
a child or infant swallows a part or accessory, consult a physician immediately.  
Do not use or store the equipment in dusty or humid places. Likewise, store the  
battery with its protective cover attached to prevent short-circuit. This is to prevent a  
fire, excessive heat, electrical shock, or burn.  
Before using the camera inside an airplane or hospital, check if it is allowed.  
Electromagnetic waves emitted by the camera may interfere with the plane’s  
instruments or the hospital’s medical equipment.  
To prevent a fire and electrical shock, follow the safeguards below:  
• Always insert the power plug all the way in.  
• Do not handle a power plug with wet hands.  
• When unplugging a power plug, grasp and pull the plug instead of the cord.  
• Do not scratch, cut, or excessively bend the cord or put a heavy object on the cord.  
Also do not twist or tie the cords.  
• Do not connect too many power plugs to the same power outlet.  
• Do not use a cord whose wire is broken or insulation is damaged.  
Unplug the power plug periodically and clean off the dust around the power outlet with  
a dry cloth. If the surrounding is dusty, humid, or oily, the dust on the power outlet may  
become moist and short-circuit the outlet, causing a fire.  
Do not connect the battery directly to an electrical outlet or a car’s cigarette lighter outlet.  
The battery may leak, generate excessive heat or explode, causing a fire, burns or injuries.  
A thorough explanation of how to use the product by an adult is required when the  
product is used by children. Supervise children while they are using the product.  
Incorrect usage may result in electrical shock or injury.  
Do not leave a lens or lens-attached camera in the sun without the lens cap attached.  
Otherwise, the lens may concentrate the sun’s rays and cause a fire.  
Do not cover or wrap the product with a cloth. Doing so may trap heat within and  
cause the casing to deform or catch fire.  
Be careful not to get the camera wet. If you drop the product in the water or if water or  
metal get inside the product, promptly remove the battery. This is to prevent a fire and  
an electrical shock.  
Do not use paint thinner, benzene, or other organic solvents to clean the product.  
Doing so may cause fire or a health hazard.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21  
Safety Precautions  
Follow the cautions below. Otherwise, physical  
injury or property damage may result.  
Cautions  
Do not use or store the product inside a car under the hot sun or near a heat source.  
The product may become hot and cause skin burns. Doing so may also cause battery  
leakage or explosion, which will degrade the performance or shorten the life of the  
product.  
Do not carry the camera around when it is attached to a tripod. Doing so may cause  
injury. Also make sure the tripod is sturdy enough to support the camera and lens.  
Do not leave the product in a low-temperature environment for an extended period of  
time. The product will become cold and may cause injury when touched.  
Never play the provided CD-ROM in a drive that is not compatible with the CD-ROM.  
If you use it in a music CD player, you may damage the speakers and other  
components. When using headphones, there is also a risk of injury to your ears from  
excessively loud volume.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
22  
 
Handling Precautions  
Camera Care  
This camera is a precision instrument. Do not drop it or subject it to physical  
shock.  
The camera is not waterproof and cannot be used underwater. If you  
accidentally drop the camera into water, promptly consult the nearest Canon  
Service Center. Wipe off any water droplets with a dry and clean cloth. If the  
camera has been exposed to salty air, wipe it with a well-wrung wet cloth.  
Never leave the camera near anything having a strong magnetic field such  
as a magnet or electric motor. Also avoid using or leaving the camera near  
anything emitting strong radio waves, such as a large antenna. Strong  
magnetic fields can cause camera misoperation or destroy image data.  
Do not leave the camera in excessive heat, such as in a car in direct  
sunlight. High temperatures can cause the camera to malfunction.  
The camera contains precision electronic circuitry. Never attempt to  
disassemble the camera yourself.  
Do not block the built-in flash, mirror operation with your finger, etc. Doing so  
may cause a malfunction.  
Use a blower to blow away dust on the lens, viewfinder, reflex mirror, and  
focusing screen. Do not use cleaners that contain organic solvents to clean  
the camera body or lens. For stubborn dirt, take the camera to the nearest  
Canon Service Center.  
Do not touch the camera’s electrical contacts with your fingers. This is to  
prevent the contacts from corroding. Corroded contacts can cause camera  
misoperation.  
If the camera is suddenly brought in from the cold into a warm room,  
condensation may form on the camera and internal parts. To prevent  
condensation, first put the camera in a sealed plastic bag and let it adjust to  
the warmer temperature before taking it out of the bag.  
If condensation forms on the camera, do not use the camera. This is to avoid  
damaging the camera. If there is condensation, remove the lens, card and  
battery from the camera, and wait until condensation has evaporated before  
using the camera.  
If the camera will not be used for an extended period, remove the battery  
and store the camera in a cool, dry, well-ventilated location. Even while the  
camera is in storage, press the shutter button a few times once in a while to  
check that the camera is still working.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
23  
 
Handling Precautions  
Avoid storing the camera where there are chemicals that result in rust and  
corrosion such as in a chemical lab.  
If the camera has not been used for an extended period, test all its functions  
before using it. If you have not used the camera for some time or if there is  
an important shoot such as a foreign trip coming up, have the camera  
checked by your nearest Canon Service Center or check the camera  
yourself and make sure it is working properly.  
If you use continuous shooting, Live View shooting, or movie shooting for a  
prolonged period, the camera may become hot. This is not a malfunction.  
If there is a bright light source inside or outside the image area, ghosting  
may occur.  
LCD Panel and LCD Monitor  
Although the LCD monitor is manufactured with very high precision  
technology with over 99.99% effective pixels, there may be a few dead pixels  
displaying only black or red, etc. among the remaining 0.01% or less pixels.  
Dead pixels are not a malfunction. They do not affect the images recorded.  
If the LCD monitor is left on for a prolonged period, screen burn-in may occur  
where you see remnants of what was displayed. However, this is only  
temporary and will disappear when the camera is left unused for a few days.  
The LCD monitor display may seem slow in low temperatures, or look black  
in high temperatures. It will return to normal at room temperature.  
Cards  
To protect the card and its recorded data, note the following:  
Do not drop, bend, or wet the card. Do not subject it to excessive force,  
physical shock, or vibration.  
Do not touch the card’s electronic contacts with your fingers or anything  
metallic.  
Do not affix any stickers, etc., on the card.  
Do not store or use the card near anything that has a strong magnetic field,  
such as a TV set, speakers, or magnet. Also avoid places prone to having  
static electricity.  
Do not leave the card in direct sunlight or near a heat source.  
Store the card in a case.  
Do not store the card in hot, dusty, or humid locations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
24  
     
Handling Precautions  
Smudges Adhering to the Front of the Sensor  
Besides dust entering the camera from outside, in rare cases lubricant from the  
camera’s internal parts may adhere to the front of the sensor. If visible spots  
remain on the image, having the sensor cleaned by a Canon Service Center is  
recommended.  
Lens  
Contacts  
After detaching the lens from the camera, put down the lens  
with the rear end up and attach the rear lens cap to avoid  
scratching the lens surface and electrical contacts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
25  
   
Nomenclature  
Built-in flash/AF-assist beam  
EF Lens mount index (p.47)  
Flash sync contacts  
Hot shoe (p.181)  
<V> Focal plane mark  
(p.88)  
EF-S Lens mount index  
<B> AF area  
selection button (p.115)  
<D> Flash button  
(p.176)  
<g> ISO speed  
setting button (p.132)  
Mode Dial lock-release  
button (p.53)  
<6> Main Dial  
(p.53)  
Mode Dial (p.31)  
<U> LCD panel  
illumination button  
(p.55)  
Strap mount  
(p.35)  
Shutter button  
(p.52)  
Speaker  
(p.304)  
Red-eye  
Built-in  
microphones  
reduction/Self-  
timer lamp  
(p.177/124)  
Remote control  
sensor  
Terminal  
cover  
Grip  
Lens release button  
(p.48)  
Contacts (p.25)  
Lens mount  
Lens lock pin  
Depth-of-field preview  
button (p.164)  
<q/C>  
Audio/video OUT/  
Digital terminal (p.315, 334, 418)  
Body cap (p.47)  
<F> Remote control  
terminal (p.367)  
<Y> External microphone  
IN terminal (p.266)  
<D> HDMI mini OUT  
terminal (p.312)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
26  
             
Nomenclature  
Display-off sensor (p.67, 285)  
Dioptric adjustment knob (p.51)  
<A> Live View shooting/  
Viewfinder eyepiece  
Eyecup (p.367)  
Movie shooting button (p.201/234)  
<Q> Quick Control button (p.57)  
<A/I> AE lock/  
FE lock button/Index/  
Reduce button  
<B> Info button  
<S/u>  
Power switch  
AF point selection/  
Magnify button  
<M> Menu  
button (p.59)  
Access lamp  
(p.40)  
LCD monitor/  
Touch screen  
Card slot cover  
(p.39)  
DC cord hole  
(p.365)  
p (N-Mark)  
Multi function lock switch  
(p.55)  
Serial number  
Battery compartment cover  
release lever (p.38)  
Tripod socket  
Battery compartment cover  
<x> Playback button (p.107)  
<L> Erase button (p.318)  
<0> Setting button (p.59)  
<5> Quick Control Dial (p.54)  
<WB> White balance selection button (p.142)  
<XA> Picture Style selection button (p.135)  
<YQi> Drive mode selection button (p.122, 124)  
<Zf> AF operation selection button (p.110)  
Card slot (p.39)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
27  
     
Nomenclature  
Shooting Function Settings (in Creative Zone modes, p.31)  
Shutter speed  
Aperture  
Multi function lock (LOCK) (p.55)  
Multi function lock (LOCK) (p.55)  
Exposure level indicator  
Exposure compensation  
amount (p.169)  
Auto Lighting Optimizer (p.146)  
ISO speed (p.132)  
AEB range (p.170)  
Multi function lock (LOCK) (p.55)  
Highlight tone priority  
(p.353)  
Shooting mode  
y Flash exposure  
compensation  
Picture Style  
(p.135)  
AF operation (p.110)  
X
One-Shot AF  
9
AI Focus AF  
Z
AI Servo AF  
MF  
Image-recording quality  
(p.126)  
73 Large/Fine  
83 Large/Normal  
74 Medium/Fine  
84 Medium/Normal  
7a Small 1/Fine  
8a Small 1/Normal  
Manual Focus  
b
c
Small 2 (Fine)  
Small 3 (Fine)  
Quick Control icon  
(p.58)  
1+73  
RAW+Large/Fine  
Battery check (p.43)  
zxcn  
1 RAW  
Possible shots  
AF area selection mode (p.114)  
Possible shots  
during WB bracketing  
White balance (p.142)  
Q Auto  
Self-timer countdown  
W
Daylight  
E Shade  
R Cloudy  
Multi Shot Noise Reduction (p.147)  
Y
U
I
Tungsten light  
White fluorescent light  
Flash  
u White balance correction (p.144)  
B White balance bracketing (p.145)  
Drive mode (p.122, 124)  
O
Custom  
u Single shooting  
Eye-Fi transmission status (p.368)  
i
Continuous shooting  
BSilent single shooting  
MSilent continuous shooting  
Q Self-timer:10 sec./Remote control  
l Self-timer:2 sec.  
Metering mode (p.167)  
q Evaluative metering  
w Partial metering  
r Spot metering  
e Center-weighted average  
metering  
q Self-timer:Continuous  
GPS connection indicator  
The display will show only the settings currently applied.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
28  
             
Nomenclature  
LCD Panel  
<g> ISO speed (p.132)  
ISO speed (p.132)  
Battery check (p.43)  
<A> Highlight tone priority  
(p.353)  
Wi-Fi function  
Possible shots  
Exposure level indicator  
Self-timer countdown  
Bulb exposure time  
Possible shots  
Exposure compensation amount (p.169)  
AEB range (p.170)  
during WB bracketing  
Card error warning (Err)  
Error number  
Shutter speed  
Bulb exposure mode (buLb)  
FE lock (FEL)  
Busy (buSY)  
Built-in flash recycling (buSY)  
Multi function lock warning (L)  
No card warning (Card)  
Card error (Card)  
Aperture  
AF point selection  
(MAF, SEL N, SEL AF)  
Card full warning (FuLL)  
Error code (Err)  
Cleaning image sensor (CLn)  
The display will show only the settings currently applied.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
29  
 
Nomenclature  
Viewfinder Information  
Spot metering circle (p.167)  
Single-point AF (Manual selection) (p.114)  
Focusing screen  
Zone AF (Manual selection of zone) (p.114)  
19-point automatic selection AF  
(p.114)  
AF point (p.114)  
Grid (p.69)  
Area AF frame  
(p.114)  
Aspect ratio line  
(p.130)  
Flicker detection  
(p.72, 154)  
Electronic level  
<g> ISO speed  
<u> White  
balance  
correction  
<o> Focus indicator  
<A> AE lock/AEB  
in-progress  
Maximum burst  
<0> Monochrome  
shooting  
<D> Flash-ready  
Improper FE lock warning  
ISO speed  
<e> High-speed sync  
<d> FE lock/FEB in-progress  
<A> Highlight tone priority  
Exposure level indicator  
Exposure compensation amount  
AEB range  
<y> Flash exposure  
compensation  
Red-eye reduction lamp ON  
Shutter speed  
AF point selection  
Bulb exposure mode (buLb)  
FE lock (FEL)  
Busy (buSY)  
(M AF, SEL N, SEL AF)  
Aperture (p.162)  
Built-in flash recycling (D buSY)  
Multi function lock warning (L)  
No card warning (Card)  
Card error (Card)  
Card full warning (FuLL)  
Error code (Err)  
The display will show only the settings currently applied.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
30  
     
Nomenclature  
Mode Dial  
You can set the shooting mode. Turn the Mode Dial while holding down  
the Mode Dial center (Mode Dial lock release button).  
Creative Zone  
These modes give you more control for  
shooting various subjects as desired.  
d
: Program AE (p.158)  
s : Shutter-priority AE (p.160)  
a : Manual exposure (p.165)  
Basic Zone  
All you do is press the shutter button.  
The camera sets everything to suit the  
subject or scene for shooting.  
A : Scene Intelligent Auto (p.76)  
7 : Flash Off (p.81)  
C : Creative Auto (p.82)  
2
3 : Landscape (p.87)  
: Close-up (p.88)  
4
5 : Sports (p.89)  
8: Special scene (p.90)  
C : Kids (p.91)  
P : Food (p.92)  
x : Candlelight (p.93)  
6 : Night Portrait (p.94)  
F : Handheld Night Scene (p.95)  
G : HDR Backlight Control (p.96)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
31  
           
Nomenclature  
Lens without a Distance Scale  
Focusing ring (p.121, 228)  
Focus mode switch (p.47)  
Zoom position index (p.48)  
Hood mount (p.49)  
Zoom ring lock lever  
(p.48)  
Filter thread  
(front of lens)  
Zoom ring (p.48)  
Contacts (p.25)  
Image Stabilizer switch (p.50)  
Lens mount index (p.47)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
32  
 
Nomenclature  
Battery Charger LC-E17  
Charger for Battery Pack LP-E17 (p.36).  
Power plug  
Charge lamp  
Full-charge lamp  
Battery pack slot  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS-SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS.  
DANGER-TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK,  
CAREFULLY FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS.  
For connection to a supply not in the U.S.A., use an attachment plug adapter  
of the proper configuration for the power outlet, if needed.  
Battery Charger LC-E17E  
Charger for Battery Pack LP-E17 (p.36).  
Battery pack slot  
Power cord  
Full-charge lamp  
Charge lamp  
Power cord socket  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
33  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
Getting Started  
This chapter explains preparatory steps before you start  
shooting and basic camera operations.  
Attaching the Provided Strap  
Pass the end of the strap through  
the camera’s strap mount eyelet  
from the bottom. Then pass it  
through the strap’s buckle as shown  
in the illustration. Pull the strap to  
take up any slack and make sure  
the strap will not loosen from the  
buckle.  
The eyepiece cover is also  
attached to the strap (p.367).  
Eyepiece cover  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
35  
     
Charging the Battery  
Remove the protective cover.  
Detach the protective cover provided  
1
2
3
with the battery.  
Attach the battery.  
As shown in the illustration, attach the  
battery securely to the charger.  
To detach the battery, follow the  
above procedure in reverse.  
LC-E17  
Recharge the battery.  
For LC-E17  
As shown by the arrow, flip out the  
battery charger’s prongs and insert  
the prongs into a power outlet.  
For LC-E17E  
Full-charge lamp  
Charge lamp  
Connect the power cord to the  
charger and insert the plug into a  
power outlet.  
LC-E17E  
Recharging starts automatically and  
the charge lamp lights up in orange.  
When the battery is fully recharged,  
the full-charge lamp will light up in  
green.  
It takes approx. 2 hours to fully recharge a completely  
exhausted battery at room temperature (23°C / 73°F). The time  
required to recharge the battery will vary greatly depending on  
the ambient temperature and the battery’s remaining capacity.  
For safety reasons, recharging in low temperatures (5°C - 10°C /  
41°F - 50°F) will take longer (up to approx. 4 hours).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
36  
       
Charging the Battery  
Tips for Using the Battery and Charger  
Upon purchase, the battery is not fully charged.  
Charge the battery before use.  
Recharge the battery on the day before or on the day it is to be  
used.  
Even during storage, a charged battery will gradually drain and lose  
its capacity.  
After recharging the battery, detach it and disconnect the  
charger from the power outlet.  
When not using the camera, remove the battery.  
If the battery is left in the camera for a prolonged period, a small  
amount of power current is released, resulting in excess discharge  
and shorter battery life. Store the battery with the protective cover  
(provided) attached. Storing the battery when it is fully charged may  
lower the battery’s performance.  
The battery charger can also be used in foreign countries.  
The battery charger is compatible with a 100 V AC to 240 V AC 50/  
60 Hz power source. If necessary, attach a commercially-available  
plug adapter for the respective country or region. Do not attach any  
portable voltage transformer to the battery charger. Doing so can  
damage the battery charger.  
If the battery becomes exhausted quickly even after being fully  
charged, the battery has reached the end of its service life.  
Check the battery’s recharge performance (p.364) and purchase a  
new battery.  
After disconnecting the charger’s power plug, do not touch the prongs for  
at least 5 sec.  
Do not charge any battery other than a Battery Pack LP-E17.  
Battery Pack LP-E17 is dedicated to Canon products only. Using it with  
an incompatible battery charger or product may result in malfunction or  
accidents for which Canon cannot be held liable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
37  
Installing and Removing the Battery  
Load a fully charged Battery Pack LP-E17 into the camera. The  
camera’s viewfinder becomes bright when a battery is installed, and  
darkens when the battery is removed.  
Installing the Battery  
Open the cover.  
Slide the lever as shown by the  
1
arrows and open the cover.  
Insert the battery.  
2
Insert the end with the battery  
contacts.  
Insert the battery until it locks in  
place.  
Close the cover.  
Press the cover until it snaps shut.  
3
Removing the Battery  
Open the cover and remove the  
battery.  
Press the battery release lever as shown  
by the arrow and remove the battery.  
To prevent short circuiting of the battery  
contacts, be sure to attach the protective  
cover (provided, p.36) to the battery.  
After opening the battery compartment cover, be careful not to forcefully  
swing it back further. Otherwise, the hinge may break.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
38  
 
Installing and Removing the Card  
The card (sold separately) can be an SD, SDHC, or SDXC memory  
card. SDHC and SDXC memory cards with UHS-I can also be used.  
The captured images are recorded onto the card.  
Make sure the card’s write-protect switch is set upward to  
enable writing and erasing.  
Installing the Card  
Open the cover.  
Slide the cover as shown by the  
1
arrows to open it.  
Write-protect switch  
Insert the card.  
As shown by the illustration, face  
2
the card’s label side toward you  
and insert it until it clicks in place.  
Close the cover.  
Close the cover and slide it in the  
3
direction shown by the arrows until it  
snaps shut.  
When you set the power switch to  
<1>, the number of possible shots  
will be displayed on the LCD panel.  
Possible shots  
The number of possible shots depends on the remaining capacity of the  
card, image-recording quality, ISO speed, etc.  
Setting [z1: Release shutter without card] to [Disable] will prevent  
you from shooting without a card inserted (p.272).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
39  
   
Installing and Removing the Card  
Removing the Card  
Open the cover.  
1
Set the power switch to <2>.  
Make sure the access lamp is off,  
then open the cover.  
If [Recording...] is displayed, close  
the cover.  
Access lamp  
Remove the card.  
Gently push in the card, then let go to  
eject it.  
2
Pull the card straight out, then close  
the cover.  
When the access lamp is lit or blinking, it indicates that images are  
being written to, read from, or erased from the card, or data is being  
transferred. Do not open the card slot cover during this time. Also,  
never do any of the following while the access lamp is lit or  
blinking. Otherwise, it can damage the image data, card, or camera.  
• Removing the card.  
• Removing the battery.  
• Shaking or banging the camera around.  
• Unplugging and connecting a power cord (when the AC Adapter  
Kit is used).  
If the card already contains recorded images, the image number may not  
start from 0001 (p.277).  
If a card-related error message is displayed on the LCD monitor, remove  
and reinsert the card. If the error persists, use a different card.  
If you can transfer all the images on the card to a computer, transfer all  
the images and then format the card with the camera (p.65). The card  
may then return to normal.  
Do not touch the card’s contacts with your fingers or metal objects. Do  
not expose the contacts to dust or water. If a smudge adheres to the  
contacts, contact failure may result.  
Multimedia cards (MMC) cannot be used (card error will be displayed).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
40  
   
Using the LCD Monitor  
After you flip out the LCD monitor, you can set menu functions, use Live  
View shooting, shoot movies, and play back images and movies. You  
can change the direction and angle of the LCD monitor.  
Flip out the LCD monitor.  
1
Rotate the LCD monitor.  
When the LCD monitor is swung out,  
180°  
2
90°  
you can rotate it up, down, or over  
180° to face the subject.  
The indicated angle is only  
175°  
approximate.  
Face it toward you.  
3
Normally, use the camera with the  
LCD monitor facing you.  
Be careful not to force and break the hinge when rotating the LCD  
monitor.  
When Remote Switch RS-60E3 or an external microphone is connected  
to the camera, the rotation angle range of the flipped out LCD monitor  
will be limited.  
When not using the camera, close the LCD monitor with the screen  
facing inward. This will protect the screen.  
During Live View shooting or movie shooting, facing the LCD monitor  
toward the subject will display a mirror image on the screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
41  
   
Turning on the Power  
If you turn on the power switch and the date/time/zone setting  
screen appears, see page 44 to set the date/time/zone.  
<k>  
: The camera turns on. You can  
shoot movies (p.234).  
<1> : The camera turns on. You can  
shoot still photos.  
<2> : The camera is turned off and  
does not operate. Set to this  
position when not using the  
camera.  
Automatic Sensor Cleaning  
Whenever you set the power switch to <1> or <2>, sensor  
cleaning will be executed automatically. (A small sound may be  
heard.) During the sensor cleaning, the LCD monitor will display  
<f>.  
You can still shoot during sensor cleaning by pressing the shutter  
button halfway (p.52) to stop cleaning and take a picture.  
If you repeatedly turn the power switch <1>/<2> at a short  
interval, the <f> icon may not be displayed. This is normal and  
not a malfunction.  
3 Auto Power Off  
To save battery power, the camera turns off automatically after  
approx. 30 seconds of non-operation. To turn on the camera again,  
just press the shutter button halfway (p.52).  
You can change the auto power off time with [52: Auto power off]  
If you set the power switch to <2> while an image is being recorded to  
the card, [Recording...] will be displayed and the power will turn off after the  
recording finishes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
42  
       
Turning on the Power  
z Checking the Battery Level  
When the power is turned on, the battery level will be indicated in one of  
the four levels.  
H
I
: Battery level is sufficient.  
: Battery level is low, but the  
camera can still be used.  
v
w
: Battery will be exhausted soon.  
(Blinks)  
: Recharge the battery.  
Number of Possible Shots  
(Approx. number of shots)  
Room Temperature  
Low Temperatures  
Temperature  
(23°C / 73°F)  
(0°C / 32°F)  
No Flash  
550  
440  
470  
400  
50% Flash Use  
The figures above are based on a fully-charged Battery Pack LP-E17, no Live  
View shooting, and CIPA (Camera & Imaging Products Association) testing  
standards.  
Possible shots with Battery Grip BG-E18 (sold separately)  
• With LP-E17 x 2: approx, twice the shots without the battery grip.  
Doing any of the following will exhaust the battery sooner:  
• Pressing the shutter button halfway for a prolonged period.  
• Activating the AF frequently without taking a picture.  
• Using the lens Image Stabilizer.  
• Using the LCD monitor frequently.  
The number of possible shots may decrease depending on the actual  
shooting conditions.  
The lens operation is powered by the camera’s battery. Depending on  
the lens used, the battery power may exhaust faster.  
For the number of possible shots with Live View shooting, see page 203.  
See [53: Battery info.] to check the battery’s condition (p.364).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
43  
           
3 Setting the Date, Time, and Zone  
When you turn on the power for the first time or if the date/time/zone are  
reset, the date/time/zone setting screen will appear. Follow the steps  
below, making sure to set the time zone first. Set the camera to the time  
zone in which you currently live so that, when you travel, you can simply  
change the setting to the correct time zone for your destination, and the  
camera will automatically adjust the date/time.  
Note that the date/time appended to recorded images will be based  
on this date/time setting. Be sure to set the correct date/time.  
Display the menu screen.  
1
Press the <M> button to display  
the menu screen.  
Under the [52] tab, select [Date/  
2 Time/Zone].  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the [52] tab.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[Date/Time/Zone], then press <0>.  
Set the time zone.  
3
[London] is set by default.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the time zone box.  
Press <0> so <a> is displayed.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
the time zone, then press <0>.  
(Returns to <b>.)  
The menu setting procedure is explained on pages 60-61.  
In step 3, the time displayed on the upper right of the screen is the time  
difference compared with Coordinated Universal Time (UTC). If you do  
not see your time zone, set the time zone while referring to the difference  
with UTC.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
44  
       
3 Setting the Date, Time, and Zone  
Set the date and time.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the number.  
Press <0> so <a> is displayed.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to set the  
number, then press <0>. (Returns  
to <b>.)  
4
5
Set the daylight saving time.  
Set it if necessary.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select [Y].  
Press <0> so <a> is displayed.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[Z], then press <0>.  
When the daylight saving time is set  
to [Z], the time set in step 4 will  
advance by 1 hour. If [Y] is set, the  
daylight saving time will be canceled  
and the time will go back by 1 hour.  
Exit the setting.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
[OK], then press <0>.  
6
The date/time/zone and daylight  
saving time will be set and the menu  
will reappear.  
The date/time/zone settings may be reset in the following cases. If this  
happens, set the date/time/zone again.  
• When the camera is stored without the battery.  
• When the camera’s battery becomes exhausted.  
• When the camera is exposed to below freezing temperatures for a  
prolonged period.  
The date/time that were set will start when you select [OK] in step 6.  
After changing the time zone, check that the correct date and time are set.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
45  
 
3 Selecting the Interface Language  
Display the menu screen.  
1
Press the <M> button to display  
the menu screen.  
Under the [52] tab, select  
2 [LanguageK].  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the [52] tab.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[LanguageK], then press <0>.  
Set the desired language.  
3
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
the language, then press <0>.  
The interface language will change.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
46  
   
Attaching and Detaching a Lens  
The camera is compatible with all Canon EF and EF-S lenses. The  
camera cannot be used with EF-M lenses.  
Attaching a Lens  
Remove the caps.  
Remove the rear lens cap and the  
1
body cap by turning them as shown  
by the arrows.  
Attach the lens.  
Align the lens’s red or white index  
White index  
2
with the camera’s index matching the  
same color. Turn the lens as shown  
by the arrow until it clicks in place.  
Red index  
Set the lens’s focus mode switch  
3 to <AF>.  
<AF> stands for autofocus.  
<MF> stands for manual focus.  
Remove the front lens cap.  
4
Minimizing Dust  
When changing lenses, do it quickly in a place with minimal dust.  
When storing the camera without a lens attached, be sure to attach the  
body cap to the camera.  
Remove dust on the body cap before attaching it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
47  
       
Attaching and Detaching a Lens  
Zooming  
Turn the zoom ring on the lens  
with your fingers.  
If you want to zoom, do it before  
focusing. Turning the zoom ring after  
achieving focus may throw off the focus.  
Detaching the Lens  
While pressing the lens release  
button, turn the lens as shown by  
the arrow.  
Turn the lens until it stops, then detach it.  
Attach the rear lens cap to the  
detached lens.  
To owners of the EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM lens or  
EF-S18-200mm f/3.5-5.6 IS lens:  
You can prevent the lens from extending out while you are carrying it  
around. Set the zoom ring to the 18mm wide-angle end, then slide the  
zoom ring lock lever to <LOCK>. The zoom ring can be locked only at  
the wide-angle end.  
.
Do not look at the sun directly through any lens. Doing so may cause  
loss of vision.  
When attaching or detaching a lens, set the camera’s power switch to <2>.  
If the front part (focusing ring) of the lens rotates during autofocusing, do  
not touch the rotating part.  
If you purchased a lens kit with the EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM  
lens, EF-S18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM lens, or EF-S55-250mm f/4-5.6  
IS STM lens, see “Handling Precautions” on page 400.  
Angle of View  
Since the image sensor size is smaller  
than the 35mm film format, the angle  
0.88 x 0.59 in.)  
of view of an attached lens will be  
equivalent to that of a lens with approx.  
1.6x of the focal length indicated.  
Image sensor size (Approx.)  
(22.3 x 14.9 mm /  
35mm image size  
(36 x 24 mm /  
1.42 x 0.94 in.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
48  
       
Attaching and Detaching a Lens  
Attaching a Lens Hood  
A lens hood can block unwanted light and prevent rain, snow, dust, etc.  
adhering to the front of the lens. When storing the lens in a bag, etc.,  
you can also attach the hood in reverse.  
If there is no index mark on the lens and hood:  
Attach the lens hood.  
Turn the hood as shown by the arrow  
to attach it securely.  
If there is an index mark on the lens and hood:  
Align the red dots on the hood  
1
and lens edges, then turn the  
hood as shown by the arrow.  
Turn the hood as shown in the  
2 illustration.  
Turn the hood clockwise until it  
attaches securely.  
If the hood is not attached properly, it may obstruct the image’s  
periphery, making the image look dark.  
When attaching or detaching the hood, grasp the base of the hood to  
turn it. Grasping the hood’s edges to turn it may deform the hood,  
resulting in failure to turn.  
When using the camera’s built-in flash, detach the hood. Otherwise, the  
hood will obstruct part of the flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
49  
 
Lens Image Stabilizer  
When you use the IS lens’s built-in Image Stabilizer, camera shake is  
corrected to obtain a sharper shot. The procedure explained here is  
based on the EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM lens as an example.  
* IS stands for Image Stabilizer.  
Set the IS switch to <1>.  
1
Set also the camera’s power switch to  
<1>.  
Press the shutter button halfway.  
2
The Image Stabilizer will operate.  
Take the picture.  
When the picture looks steady in the  
3
viewfinder, press the shutter button  
completely to take the picture.  
The Image Stabilizer will not be effective if the subject moves during the  
exposure.  
For bulb exposures, set the IS switch to <2>. If <1> is set, Image  
Stabilizer misoperation may occur.  
The Image Stabilizer may not be effective for excessive shaking such as  
on a rocking boat.  
The Image Stabilizer can operate with the lens’s focus mode switch set  
to either <AF> or <MF>.  
When using a tripod, you can still shoot with the IS switch set to <1>  
with no problem. However, to save battery power, setting the IS switch to  
<2> is recommended.  
The Image Stabilizer is effective even when the camera is mounted on a  
monopod.  
With the EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM lens, EF-S18-55mm f/3.5-5.6  
IS STM lens, EF-S55-250mm f/4-5.6 IS STM lens, or EF-S18-200mm  
f/3.5-5.6 IS lens, the Image Stabilizer mode will be switched  
automatically to suit the shooting conditions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
50  
       
Basic Operation  
Adjusting the Viewfinder Clarity  
Turn the dioptric adjustment  
knob.  
Turn the knob left or right so that the  
AF points in the viewfinder look the  
sharpest.  
If the camera dioptric adjustment still cannot provide a sharp viewfinder  
image, using E-series Dioptric Adjustment Lenses (sold separately) is  
recommended.  
Holding the Camera  
To obtain sharp images, hold the camera still to minimize camera  
shake.  
Horizontal shooting  
Vertical shooting  
1. Wrap your right hand around the camera grip firmly.  
2. Hold the lens bottom with your left hand.  
3. Rest your hand’s right index finger lightly on the shutter button.  
4. Press your arms and elbows lightly against the front of your body.  
5. To maintain a stable stance, place one foot slightly ahead of the other.  
6. Press the camera against your face and look through the viewfinder.  
To shoot while looking at the LCD monitor, see page 201.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
51  
           
Basic Operation  
Shutter Button  
The shutter button has two steps. You can press the shutter button  
halfway. Then you can further press the shutter button completely.  
Pressing Halfway  
This activates autofocusing and the  
automatic exposure system that sets the  
shutter speed and aperture.  
The exposure setting (shutter speed and  
aperture) is displayed in the viewfinder  
and on the LCD panel (0).  
Pressing Completely  
This releases the shutter and takes the  
picture.  
Preventing Camera Shake  
Hand-held camera movement during the moment of exposure is called  
camera shake. It can cause blurred pictures. To prevent camera shake,  
note the following:  
• Hold and steady the camera as shown on the preceding page.  
• Press the shutter button halfway to autofocus, then slowly press the  
shutter button completely.  
If you press the shutter button completely without pressing it halfway  
first, or if you press the shutter button halfway and then press it  
completely immediately, the camera will take a moment before it takes  
the picture.  
Even during menu display, image playback, or image recording, you can  
instantly go back to shooting-ready by pressing the shutter button  
halfway.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
52  
         
Basic Operation  
Mode Dial  
Turn the dial while holding down  
the lock release button at the  
center of the dial.  
Use it to set the shooting mode.  
6 Main Dial  
After pressing a button, turn the  
(1)  
<6> dial.  
After pressing a button such as <g>  
<WB> <XA> <YQi> <Zf>,  
turn the <6> dial to change the setting.  
For the <g> button, the function  
remains selected for 6 sec. (9) after  
pressing the button.  
When the function selection ends or if  
you press the shutter button halfway, the  
camera will be ready to shoot.  
Use this dial to select or set the ISO  
speed, white balance, Picture Style, drive  
mode, AF operation, AF point, etc.  
Turn the <6> dial only.  
(2)  
While looking at the viewfinder or LCD  
panel, turn the <6> dial to change the  
setting.  
Use this dial to set the shutter speed,  
aperture, etc.  
The operations in (1) are possible even when the <R> switch is set to  
the right (Multi function lock, p.55, 359).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
53  
     
Basic Operation  
5 Quick Control Dial  
After pressing a button, turn the  
(1)  
<5> dial.  
After pressing a button such as <g>  
<WB> <XA> <YQi> <Zf>,  
turn the <5> dial to change the setting.  
For the <g> button, the function  
remains selected for 6 sec. (9) after  
pressing the button.  
When the function selection ends or if  
you press the shutter button halfway, the  
camera will be ready to shoot.  
Use this dial to select or set the ISO  
speed, white balance, Picture Style,  
drive mode, AF operation, AF point,  
etc.  
Turn the <5> dial only.  
(2)  
(3)  
While looking at the viewfinder or LCD  
panel, turn the <5> dial to change the  
setting.  
Use this dial to set the exposure  
compensation amount, the aperture  
setting for manual exposures, etc.  
After pressing a button, press the  
<W>, <X>, <Y>, or <Z> key.  
After pressing the <M> or <Q>  
button, press the <W> <X> or <Y>  
<Z> keys to set menus or Quick Control  
functions.  
The operations in (1) and (3) are possible even when the <R> switch is  
set to the right (Multi function lock, p.55, 359).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
54  
   
Basic Operation  
R Multi Function Lock  
By setting [13: Multi function lock] under [54: Custom Functions  
(C.Fn)] (p.359) and moving the <R> switch to the right, you can  
prevent the Main Dial and Quick Control Dial from moving and changing  
a setting inadvertently.  
<R> switch set to the left:  
Lock released  
<R> switch set to the right:  
Lock engaged  
If the <R> switch is set to the right and you try to use one of the locked  
camera controls, <L> will be displayed in the viewfinder and on the LCD  
panel. On the shooting settings display (p.56), [LOCK] will be displayed.  
U LCD Panel Illumination  
Turn on (9) or off the LCD panel  
illumination by pressing the <U> button.  
During a bulb exposure, pressing the  
shutter button completely will turn off the  
LCD panel illumination.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
55  
         
Basic Operation  
Displaying Shooting Function Settings  
After you press the <B> button a number of times, the shooting  
function settings will be displayed.  
With the shooting function settings displayed, you can turn the Mode  
Dial to see the settings for each shooting mode.  
Pressing the <Q> button enables Quick Control of the shooting  
function settings (p.57).  
Press the <B> button again to turn off the display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
56  
     
Q Quick Control for Shooting Functions  
You can directly select and set the shooting functions displayed on the  
LCD monitor. This is called Quick Control.  
Press the <Q> button (7).  
1
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
Set the desired functions.  
2
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to select a function.  
The selected function and Feature  
guide (p.73) will appear.  
Turn the <6> or <5> dial to  
change the setting.  
Basic Zone modes  
Creative Zone modes  
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter button completely to  
take the picture.  
3
The captured image will be displayed.  
For the functions settable in Basic Zone modes and their setting  
procedures, see page 99.  
In steps 1 and 2, you can also use the LCD monitor’s touch screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
57  
     
Q Quick Control for Shooting Functions  
Sample Quick Control Screen  
Shutter speed (p.160)  
Shooting mode* (p.31)  
Highlight tone priority* (p.353)  
Exposure  
compensation/  
AEB setting  
Flash exposure  
Return  
Built-in flash settings  
White balance (p.142)  
Image-recording quality (p.126)  
White balance correction (p.144)  
Metering mode (p.167)  
Auto Lighting Optimizer (p.146)  
Drive mode (p.122)  
White balance bracketing (p.145)  
*
Functions marked with an asterisk cannot be set with the Quick Control screen.  
Function Setting Screen  
Select the desired function and press  
<0>. The function’s setting screen  
will appear.  
Turn the <6> or <5> dial or press  
the <Y> <Z> keys to change the  
settings. There are also some  
functions that are set by pressing the  
<B>, <B>, or <L> button.  
Press <0> to finalize the setting and  
return to the Quick Control screen.  
When you select <r> (p.114) and  
press the <M> button, the  
<0>  
previous screen will reappear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
58  
 
3 Menu Operations  
You can set various settings with the menus such as the image-  
recording quality, date and time, etc.  
<M> button  
<0> button  
Quick Control Dial  
<W><X><Y><Z>  
LCD monitor  
Menu Screen  
The menu tabs and items displayed will differ depending on the  
shooting mode.  
Basic Zone modes  
Movie shooting  
Creative Zone modes  
3Playback  
5Set-up  
ALive View shooting  
9My Menu  
zShooting  
Tab  
Menu  
Menu items  
settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
59  
     
3 Menu Operations  
Menu Setting Procedure  
Display the menu screen.  
Press the <M> button to display  
1
the menu screen.  
Select a tab.  
2
Press the Quick Control Dial’s <Y>  
<Z> keys to select a tab (group of  
functions).  
For example, in this manual, “the  
[z3] tab” refers to the screen  
displayed when the third z  
(Shooting) tab from the left [t] is  
selected.  
Select the desired item.  
3
Press the Quick Control Dial’s <W>  
<X> keys to select the item, then  
press <0>.  
Select the setting.  
4
Press the Quick Control Dial’s <W>  
<X> or <Y> <Z> keys to select the  
desired setting. (Some settings  
require you to press either the <W>  
<X> or <Y> <Z> keys to select  
those settings.)  
The current setting is indicated in  
blue.  
Set the desired setting.  
Press <0> to set it.  
5
6
Exit the setting.  
Press the <M> button to return to  
the shooting function settings display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
60  
   
3 Menu Operations  
In step 2, you can also turn the <6> dial to select a menu tab. In step  
4, you can also turn the <5> dial to select certain settings.  
In steps 2 to 5, you can also use the LCD monitor’s touch screen (p.62).  
The explanation of menu functions hereinafter assumes that you have  
pressed the <M> button to display the menu screen.  
To cancel, press the <M> button.  
For details about each menu item, see page 378.  
Dimmed Menu Items  
Example: When [Multi Shot  
Noise Reduction] is set  
Dimmed menu items cannot be set. The  
menu item is dimmed if another function  
setting is overriding it.  
You can see the overriding function by  
selecting the dimmed menu item and  
pressing <0>.  
If you cancel the overriding function’s  
setting, the dimmed menu item will  
become settable.  
Some dimmed menu items will not show the overriding function.  
With [Clear all camera settings] under [54: Clear settings], you can reset  
the menu functions to the default settings (p.282).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
61  
 
d Using the Touch Screen  
The LCD monitor is a touch-sensitive panel that you can operate with  
your fingers.  
Tap  
Quick Control (Sample display)  
Use your finger to tap on (touch  
briefly and then remove your finger  
from) the LCD monitor.  
By tapping, you can select menus,  
icons, etc., displayed on the LCD  
monitor.  
When touch-screen operation is  
possible, a frame will appear around  
the icon (except on menu screens).  
For example, when you tap on [Q],  
the Quick Control screen appears. By  
tapping on [2], you can return to the  
preceding screen.  
Operations possible by tapping on the screen  
Setting menu functions after pressing the <M> button  
Quick Control  
Setting functions after pressing the <B>, <g>, <S>, <WB>,  
<XA>, <YQi>, or <Zf> button  
Touch shutter during Live View shooting  
Setting functions during Live View shooting  
Setting functions during movie shooting  
Playback operations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
62  
       
d Using the Touch Screen  
Drag  
Menu screen (Sample display)  
Slide your finger while touching the  
LCD monitor.  
Scale display (Sample display)  
Operations possible by dragging your finger on the screen  
Selecting a menu tab or item after pressing the <M> button  
Setting a scale control  
Quick Control  
Setting functions during Live View shooting  
Setting functions during movie shooting  
Playback operations  
3 Silencing the Beep during Touch Operations  
If [z1: Beep] is set to [Touch to y],  
the beep will not sound during touch  
operations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
63  
   
d Using the Touch Screen  
3 Touch Control Settings  
Select [Touch control].  
Under the [53] tab, select [Touch  
control], then press <0>.  
1
Set the touch control setting.  
Select the preferred setting, then  
press <0>.  
2
[Standard] is the normal setting.  
[Sensitive] provides a more reactive  
touch response than [Standard]. Try  
using both settings and select the one  
you prefer.  
To disable touch-screen operations,  
select [Disable].  
Cautions for Touch Screen Operations  
Since the LCD monitor is not pressure sensitive, do not use any sharp  
objects, such as your fingernail or a ballpoint pen, for touch operations.  
Do not use wet fingers for touch screen operations.  
If the LCD monitor has any moisture or if your fingers are wet, the touch  
screen may not respond or misoperation may occur. In such a case, turn  
off the power and wipe the LCD monitor with a cloth.  
Do not attach any protective sheet (commercially available) or sticker on  
the LCD monitor. It may make the touch operation response slow.  
If you quickly perform touch operation when [Sensitive] is set, the touch  
response may be slower.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
64  
 
3 Formatting the Card  
If the card is new or was previously formatted by another camera or  
computer, format the card with this camera.  
When the card is formatted, all images and data on the card will  
be erased. Even protected images will be erased, so make sure  
there is nothing you need to keep. If necessary, transfer the  
images and data to a computer, etc., before formatting the card.  
Select [Format card].  
1
Under the [51] tab, select [Format  
card], then press <0>.  
Format the card.  
2
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
The card will be formatted.  
When the formatting is completed,  
the menu will reappear.  
For low-level formatting, press the  
<L> button to append [Low level  
format] with a checkmark <X>, then  
select [OK].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
65  
         
3 Formatting the Card  
Execute [Format card] in the following cases:  
The card is new.  
The card was formatted by a different camera or a computer.  
The card is full with images or data.  
A card-related error is displayed (p.399).  
Low-level Formatting  
Perform low-level formatting if the card’s recording or reading speed seems  
slow or if you want to totally erase data on the card.  
Since low-level formatting will format all recordable sectors on the card, the  
formatting will take slightly longer than normal formatting.  
You can stop the low-level formatting by selecting [Cancel]. Even in this  
case, normal formatting will be completed and you can use the card as  
usual.  
When the card is formatted or data is erased, only the file management  
information is changed. The actual data is not completely erased. Be  
aware of this when selling or discarding the card. When discarding the  
card, execute low-level formatting or destroy the card physically to  
prevent the personal data from being leaked.  
Before using a new Eye-Fi card, the software on the card must be  
installed on your computer. Then format the card with the camera.  
The card capacity displayed on the card format screen may be smaller  
than the capacity indicated on the card.  
This device incorporates exFAT technology licensed from Microsoft.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
66  
   
Switching the LCD Monitor Display  
The LCD monitor can display the shooting settings screen, menu  
screen, captured images, etc.  
Shooting Settings  
When you turn on the power, the  
shooting settings will be displayed.  
When your eye is near the viewfinder  
eyepiece, the display-off sensor  
(p.27, 285) will turn off the LCD  
monitor to prevent glare. When your  
eye leaves the viewfinder eyepiece,  
the LCD monitor will turn on again.  
By pressing the <B> button, you  
can switch the LCD monitor screen  
as follows: Display the camera  
settings screen, display the electronic  
level, display the shooting settings  
screen, or turn off the LCD monitor  
Menu Functions  
Captured Image  
Appears when you press the  
<M> button. Press the  
button again to return to the  
shooting settings screen.  
Appears when you press the  
<x> button. Press the button  
again to return to the shooting  
settings screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
67  
       
Switching the LCD Monitor Display  
Under [52: LCD auto off], you can prevent the LCD monitor from  
turning off automatically (p.285).  
Even when the menu screen or captured image is displayed, pressing  
the shutter button will enable you to shoot immediately.  
If you look through the viewfinder eyepiece while wearing sunglasses,  
the LCD monitor may not turn off automatically. If this occurs, press the  
<B> button to turn off the LCD monitor.  
Nearby fluorescent lighting may cause the LCD monitor to turn off. If this  
occurs, take the camera away from the fluorescent lighting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
68  
lDisplaying the Grid  
You can display a grid in the viewfinder to help you check the camera tilt  
or compose the shot.  
Select [Viewfinder display].  
1
Under the [52] tab, select  
[Viewfinder display], then press  
<0>.  
Select [Grid display].  
2
Select [Grid display], then press  
<0>.  
Select [Show].  
Select [Show], then press <0>.  
When you exit the menu, the grid will  
3
appear in the viewfinder.  
You can display a grid on the LCD monitor during Live View shooting and  
before you start shooting a movie (p.214, 265).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
69  
   
Q Displaying the Electronic Level  
You can display the electronic level on the LCD monitor and in the  
viewfinder to help you correct the camera tilt. Note that you can check  
only the horizontal tilt and not the forward/backward tilt.  
Displaying the Electronic Level on the LCD Monitor  
Press the <B> button.  
1
Each time you press the <  
button, the screen display will change.  
Display the electronic level.  
B>  
If the electronic level does not appear,  
set [53: z button display  
options] so that the electronic level  
can be displayed (p.362).  
Check the camera’s tilt.  
2
The horizontal tilt is displayed in 1°  
increments. The tilt scale is marked in  
5° increments.  
When the red line turns green, it  
indicates that the tilt is almost  
corrected.  
Horizontal level  
Even when the tilt is corrected, there may be a margin of error of approx. ±1°.  
If the camera is very tilted, the electronic level’s margin of error will be larger.  
During Live View shooting and before movie shooting (except with u+  
Tracking), you can also display the electronic level as described above  
(p.205, 240).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
70  
     
Q Displaying the Electronic Level  
3 Displaying the Electronic Level in the Viewfinder  
A simple electronic level using a camera icon can be displayed in the  
viewfinder. Since this can be displayed while you shoot, you can correct  
any tilt during handheld shooting.  
Select [Viewfinder display].  
1
Under the [52] tab, select  
[Viewfinder display], then press  
<0>.  
Select [Electronic level].  
2
Select [Electronic level], then press  
<0>.  
Select [Show].  
Select [Show], then press <0>.  
3
Press the shutter button halfway.  
4
The electronic level will appear as  
shown in the illustration.  
Horizontal  
Tilt 1°  
Electronic level  
Tilt 2° or higher  
This also works with vertical shooting.  
Even when the tilt is corrected, there may be a margin of error of ±1°.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
71  
 
Displaying the Flicker DetectionK  
If you set this function, <G> will appear in the viewfinder when  
the camera detects flicker caused by the blinking of the light source. By  
default, flicker detection is set to [Show].  
Select [Viewfinder display].  
1
Under the [52] tab, select  
[Viewfinder display], then press  
<0>.  
Select [Flicker detection].  
2
Select [Flicker detection], then  
press <0>.  
Select [Show].  
Select [Show], then press <0>.  
3
If you set [z3: Anti-flicker shoot.] to [Enable], you can shoot with  
reduced unevenness of exposure caused by the flicker (p.154).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
72  
   
Feature Guide  
The Feature guide appears when you change the shooting mode or set  
a shooting function, Live View shooting, movie shooting, or Quick  
Control for playback, and displays a brief description of that mode,  
function or option. It also displays a description when you select a  
function or option on the Quick Control screen. The Feature guide turns  
off when you tap on the description or proceed with the operation.  
Shooting mode (Sample)  
Quick Control (Sample)  
Shooting settings  
Live View shooting  
Playback  
3 Disabling the Feature Guide  
Select [Feature guide].  
Under the [53] tab, select [Feature  
guide], then press <0>.  
Select [Disable], then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
73  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
Basic Shooting and  
Image Playback  
This chapter explains how to use the Basic Zone modes  
on the Mode Dial for best results and how to play back  
images.  
With Basic Zone modes, all you do is point and shoot while the  
camera sets everything automatically (p.99, 370). Also, to  
prevent botched pictures due to mistaken operations,  
advanced shooting function settings cannot be changed.  
n
If you set the Mode Dial to <8> when the LCD monitor is off,  
press the <Q> button to check the shooting mode before shooting  
(p.90).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
75  
 
A
Fully Automatic Shooting (Scene Intelligent Auto)  
<A> is a fully automatic mode. The camera analyzes the scene  
and sets the optimum settings automatically. It also adjusts focus  
automatically by detecting whether the subject is still or moving (p.79).  
Set the Mode Dial to <A>.  
1
Turn the Mode Dial while holding  
down the lock release button at the  
center.  
Aim the Area AF frame over the  
Area AF frame  
2 subject.  
All the AF points will be used to focus,  
and the camera will focus on the  
closest object.  
Aiming the center of the Area AF  
frame over the subject will make  
focusing easier.  
Focus on the subject.  
3
Press the shutter button halfway. The  
lens focusing ring will rotate to focus.  
The AF point(s) that achieve(s) focus  
will be displayed. At the same time,  
the beeper will sound and the focus  
indicator <o> in the viewfinder will  
light up.  
In low light, the AF point(s) will light  
up briefly in red.  
If necessary, the built-in flash will be  
raised automatically.  
Focus indicator  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
76  
         
A Fully Automatic Shooting (Scene Intelligent Auto)  
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter button completely to  
take the picture.  
4
The captured image will be displayed  
for 2 sec. on the LCD monitor.  
After you finish shooting, push down  
the built-in flash with your fingers.  
The <A> mode makes the colors look more impressive in nature, outdoor,  
and sunset scenes. If you did not obtain the desired color tones, change the  
mode to a Creative Zone mode and select a Picture Style other than  
<D>, then shoot again (p.135).  
FAQ  
The focus indicator <o> blinks and focus is not achieved.  
Aim the Area AF frame over an area with good contrast, then press  
the shutter button halfway (p.52). If you are too close to the subject,  
move away and try again.  
When focus is achieved, the AF points do not light up in red.  
The AF points light up in red only when focus is achieved in low-light  
conditions.  
Multiple AF points light up simultaneously.  
Focus has been achieved at all those points. You can take the  
picture as long as an AF point covering the target subject is lighting  
up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
77  
A Fully Automatic Shooting (Scene Intelligent Auto)  
The beeper continues to beep softly. (The focus indicator <o>  
does not light up.)  
It indicates that the camera is focusing continuously on a moving  
subject. (The focus indicator <o> does not light up.) You can take  
sharp pictures of a moving subject.  
Note that the focus lock (p.79) will not work in this case.  
Pressing the shutter button halfway does not focus on the  
subject.  
If the focus mode switch on the lens is set to <MF> (manual focus),  
set it to <AF> (autofocus).  
The flash fired even though it was daylight.  
For a backlit subject, the flash may fire to help lighten the subject’s  
dark areas. If you do not want the flash to fire, use the Quick Control  
to set [Flash firing] to [b] (p.98) or set the <7> (Flash Off) mode  
and shoot (p.81).  
The flash fired and the picture came out extremely bright.  
Move further from the subject and shoot. When shooting flash  
photography, if the subject is too close to the camera, the picture  
may come out extremely bright (overexposure).  
In low light, the built-in flash fired a series of flashes.  
Pressing the shutter button halfway may trigger the built-in flash to  
fire a series of flashes to assist autofocusing. This is called the AF-  
assist beam. Its effective range is approx. 4 meters/13.1 feet. The  
built-in flash will make a sound when firing continuously. This is  
normal and not a malfunction.  
When flash was used, the bottom part of the picture came out  
unnaturally dark.  
The shadow of the lens barrel was captured in the picture because  
the subject was too close to the camera. Move further away from the  
subject and shoot. If a hood is attached to the lens, remove it before  
taking the flash picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
78  
A
Full Auto Techniques (Scene Intelligent Auto)  
Recomposing the Shot  
Depending on the scene, position the subject toward the left or right to  
create a balanced background and good perspective.  
In the <A> mode, pressing the shutter button halfway to focus on a  
still subject will lock the focus on that subject. Recompose the shot  
while keeping the shutter button pressed halfway, and then press the  
shutter button completely to take the picture. This is called “focus lock”.  
Focus lock is also possible in other Basic Zone modes (except <5>  
<C>).  
Shooting a Moving Subject  
In the <A> mode, if the subject moves (distance to camera changes)  
while or after you focus, AI Servo AF will take effect to focus on the  
subject continuously. (The beeper will continue beeping softly.) As long  
as you keep the Area AF frame positioned over the subject while  
pressing the shutter button halfway, the focusing will be continuous.  
When you want to take the picture, press the shutter button completely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
79  
         
A Full Auto Techniques (Scene Intelligent Auto)  
A Live View Shooting  
You can shoot while viewing the image on the LCD monitor. This is  
called “Live View shooting”. For details, see page 201.  
Display the Live View image on  
the LCD monitor.  
Press the <A> button.  
The Live View image will appear on  
the LCD monitor.  
1
Focus on the subject.  
2
Press the shutter button halfway to  
focus.  
When focus is achieved, the AF point  
will turn green and the beeper will  
sound.  
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter button completely.  
The picture is taken and the captured  
image is displayed on the LCD  
3
monitor.  
When the playback display ends, the  
camera will return to Live View  
shooting automatically.  
Press the <A> button to end the  
Live View shooting.  
You can also rotate the LCD monitor for different angles (p.41).  
Normal angle  
Low angle  
High angle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
80  
   
7 Disabling Flash  
The camera analyzes the scene and sets the optimum settings  
automatically. In places where flash photography is prohibited such as  
in a museum or an aquarium, use the <7> (Flash Off) mode.  
Shooting Tips  
Prevent camera shake if the numeric display in the viewfinder  
blinks.  
Under low light when camera shake is prone to occur, the  
viewfinder’s shutter speed display will blink. Hold the camera steady  
or use a tripod. When using a zoom lens, use the wide-angle end to  
reduce blur caused by camera shake even while handholding the  
camera.  
Take portraits without flash.  
In low-light conditions, tell the subject to keep still until the picture is  
taken. Any movement by the subject during shooting may result in  
the subject being blurred in the picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
81  
       
C Creative Auto Shooting  
In the <C> mode, you can set the following functions for shooting:  
(1) Extra Effect Shot, (2) Ambience-based shots, (3) Background blur,  
(4) Drive mode, and (5) Flash firing. The default settings are the same  
as the <A> mode.  
* CA stands for Creative Auto.  
Set the Mode Dial to <C>.  
1
Press the <Q> button (7).  
2
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
Set the desired function.  
3
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to select a function.  
The selected function and Feature  
guide (p.73) will appear.  
Press <0> to set the function.  
For the setting procedure and details  
on each function, see pages 83-85.  
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter button completely to  
4
take the picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
82  
     
C Creative Auto Shooting  
(2)  
(1)  
Shutter speed  
Aperture  
(3)  
(5)  
(4)  
ISO speed  
If you set (1), (2) or (3) when the camera is set for Live View shooting,  
you can see the effect on the screen before you start shooting.  
(1) Extra Effect Shot  
You can select any of the following effects for shooting: Creative filters  
(p.210), Picture Styles (p.135), and Ambience-based shots (p.100).  
• Turn the <5> dial to select [  
: Enable]. Turn the <6> dial to  
select a shooting effect and shoot.  
• When you take a picture, two images will be recorded. One with  
the effect applied and one without. Both images will be displayed  
together immediately after you take the picture. The image without  
the effect is displayed on the left and the one with the effect on the  
right.  
Registering your favorite shooting effects  
• During the image review immediately after shooting and during  
playback, the image applied with the effect will have the [s  
]
icon. After you press the <0> button and then the <B> button,  
you can check which shooting effect is applied.  
You can register up to two shooting effects under [9:Favorite effect].  
• When you select the registered [9:Favorite effect], you can  
shoot with that shooting effect applied. You can also overwrite the  
[9:Favorite effect].  
If you are using an Eye-Fi card and have set it to erase images after their  
transfer, the image without the effect will not be displayed during the  
playback immediately after shooting.  
The Live View image displayed with Extra Effect Shot applied will not  
look exactly the same as the actual photo.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
83  
   
C Creative Auto Shooting  
(2) Ambience-based shots  
You can select and shoot with the ambience you want to convey in  
your images.  
• Turn the <5> dial to select the ambience. For details, see page  
(3) Background blur  
• If [OFF] is set, the degree of background blur will change  
depending on the brightness.  
• If it is set to any setting other than [OFF], you can adjust the  
background blur regardless of the brightness.  
• If you turn the <6> or <5> dial to move the cursor to the right,  
the background will look sharper.  
• Turning the <6> or <5> dial to move the cursor to the left will  
blur the subject’s background. Note that depending on the lens’s  
maximum aperture (smallest f/number), certain slider adjustments  
may not be selectable.  
• If you use Live View shooting, you can see how the image is  
blurred in front of and behind the point of focus. When you turn the  
<6> or <5> dial, [Simulating blur] will be displayed on the  
LCD monitor.  
• If you want to blur the background, see “Shooting Portraits” on  
• Depending on the lens and shooting conditions, the background  
may not look so blurred.  
• This function cannot be set if you use flash. If <a> has been set  
and you set background blur, <b> will be set automatically.  
If [Simulating blur] is effective during Live View shooting, the image  
displayed with <g> (p.204) blinking may have more noise than the  
actual image being recorded, or it may look dark.  
You cannot set both (1) Extra Effect Shot and (2) Ambience-based shots  
at the same time.  
You cannot set both (1) Extra Effect Shot and (3) Background blur at the  
same time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
84  
   
C Creative Auto Shooting  
(4) Drive mode: Use the <6> or <5> dial to make the selection.  
<u> Single shooting:  
Shoot one image at a time.  
<i> Continuous shooting:  
While you hold down the shutter button completely,  
shots will be taken continuously. You can shoot up to  
approx. 5.0 shots per second.  
<B>Silent single shooting*:  
Single shooting with less shooting sound than <u>.  
<M>Silent continuous shooting*:  
Continuous shooting (max. approx. 3.0 shots per  
second) with less shooting sound than <  
<Q>Self-timer: 10sec./remote control:  
i>.  
The picture is taken 10 seconds after you press the  
shutter button. A remote controller can also be used.  
<l>Self-timer: 2 sec.:  
The picture is taken 2 seconds after you press the  
shutter button.  
<q>Self-timer: Continuous:  
Press the <W> <X> keys to set the number of  
multiple shots (2 to 10) to be taken with the self-timer.  
10 seconds after you press the shutter button, the set  
number of multiple shots will be taken.  
* Cannot be set during Live View shooting.  
(5) Flash firing: Turn the <6> or <5> dial to select the desired  
setting.  
<a> Auto flash : The flash fires automatically when necessary.  
<I> Flash on : The flash fires at all times.  
<b> Flash off : The flash is disabled.  
When using the self-timer, see the  
notes on page 124.  
When using <b>, see “Disabling Flash” on page 81.  
If you have set Extra Effect Shot, 1+73, 1, and <i> <M>  
<q> cannot be set.  
If you have set background blur, you cannot use flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
85  
         
2 Shooting Portraits  
The <2> (Portrait) mode blurs the background to make the human  
subject stand out. It also makes skin tones and hair look softer.  
Shooting Tips  
Select the location where the distance between the subject and  
the background is the farthest.  
The further the distance between the subject and background, the  
more blurred the background will look. The subject will also stand  
out better against an uncluttered dark background.  
Use a telephoto lens.  
If you have a zoom lens, use the telephoto end to fill the frame with  
the subject from the waist up. Move in closer if necessary.  
Focus on the face.  
Check that the AF point covering the face lights up. For close-ups of  
the face, focus on the eyes.  
The default setting is <i> (Continuous shooting). If you hold down the  
shutter button, you can shoot continuously to capture subtle changes in the  
subject’s pose and facial expression (max. approx. 5.0 shots/sec.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
86  
     
3 Shooting Landscapes  
Use the <3> (Landscape) mode for wide scenery or to have  
everything in focus from near to far. For vivid blues and greens, and  
very sharp and crisp images.  
Shooting Tips  
With a zoom lens, use the wide-angle end.  
When using the wide-angle end of a zoom lens, objects near and far  
will be in focus better than at the telephoto end. It also adds breadth  
to landscapes.  
Shooting night scenes.  
The <3> mode is also good for night scenes because it disables  
the built-in flash. When shooting night scenes, use a tripod to  
prevent camera shake.  
The built-in flash will not fire even in backlit or low-light conditions.  
If you are using an external Speedlite, the Speedlite will fire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
87  
   
4 Shooting Close-ups  
When you want to shoot flowers or small things up close, use the <4>  
(Close-up) mode. To make small things appear much larger, use a  
macro lens (sold separately).  
Shooting Tips  
Use a simple background.  
A simple background makes small objects such as flowers stand out  
better.  
Move in as close as possible to the subject.  
Check the lens for its minimum focusing distance. Some lenses  
have indications such as <MACRO 0.25m/0.8ft> on them. The lens  
minimum focusing distance is measured from the <V> (focal  
plane) mark on the top of the camera to the subject. If you are too  
close to the subject, the focus indicator <o> will blink.  
If you use flash and the bottom of the picture looks unusually dark,  
move away from the subject.  
With a zoom lens, use the telephoto end.  
If you have a zoom lens, using the telephoto end will make the  
subject look larger.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
88  
       
5 Shooting Moving Subjects  
Use the <5> (Sports) mode to shoot a moving subject, such as a  
running person or a moving vehicle.  
Shooting Tips  
Use a telephoto lens.  
The use of a telephoto lens is recommended for shooting from a  
distance.  
Track the subject with the Area AF frame.  
Aim the center AF point over the subject, then press the shutter  
button halfway to start autofocusing in Area AF frame. During  
autofocusing, the beeper will continue beeping softly. If focus cannot  
be achieved, the focus indicator <o> will blink.  
The default setting is <i> (Continuous shooting). When you want  
to take the picture, press the shutter button completely. If you hold  
down the shutter button, you will be able to maintain autofocusing  
during continuous shooting of the subject’s movement (max. approx.  
5.0 shots per sec.).  
Under low light when camera shake is prone to occur, the viewfinder’s  
shutter speed display on the bottom left will blink. Hold the camera  
steady and shoot.  
If you are using an external Speedlite, the Speedlite will fire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
89  
   
8: Special Scene Mode  
The camera will automatically choose the appropriate settings when  
you select a shooting mode for your subject or scene.  
Set the Mode Dial to <8>.  
1
Press the <Q> button (7).  
2
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
Select a shooting mode.  
3
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to select the desired shooting  
mode’s icon.  
Turn the <6> or <5> dial to select  
a shooting mode.  
You can also select the shooting  
mode icon and press <0> to display  
a selection of shooting modes from  
which you can select one.  
Available Shooting Modes in the <8> Mode  
Shooting Mode  
Shooting Mode  
Night Portrait  
Page  
Page  
C
Kids  
6
F
G
P
Food  
Handheld Night Scene  
HDR Backlight Control  
Candlelight  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90  
     
C Shooting Children  
When you want to continuously focus and shoot children running  
around, use <C> (Kids). Skin tones will look healthy.  
Shooting Tips  
Track the subject with the Area AF frame.  
Aim the center AF point over the subject, then press the shutter  
button halfway to start autofocusing in Area AF frame. During  
autofocusing, the beeper will continue beeping softly. If focus cannot  
be achieved, the focus indicator <o> will blink.  
Shoot continuously.  
The default setting is <i> (Continuous shooting). When you want  
to take the picture, press the shutter button completely. If you hold  
down the shutter button, you will be able to maintain autofocusing  
during continuous shooting of the subject’s changing facial  
expressions and movement (max. approx. 5.0 shots per sec.).  
While the flash is recycling, “buSY” is displayed in the viewfinder and on the  
LCD panel, and a picture cannot be taken. Take the picture after this display  
turns off. During Live View shooting, “BUSY” is displayed on the LCD  
monitor, and you cannot view the subject.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
91  
       
P Shooting Food  
When shooting food, use <P> (Food). The photo will look bright and  
vivid.  
Shooting Tips  
Change the color tone.  
You can change [Color tone]. Food photos with a reddish tinge  
usually make the food look more vivid. To increase the food’s  
reddish tinge, set it toward [Warm tone]. Set it toward [Cool tone] if  
it looks too red.  
Shoot the subject in close-up.  
If you have a zoom lens, use the telephoto end to shoot the food in  
close-up.  
Avoid using flash.  
If you use flash, the light may reflect off the dish or food and results  
in unnatural shadows. By default, <b> (Flash off) is set. Try to  
prevent camera shake when shooting in low-light conditions.  
Since this mode sets the color tone to make food look vivid, human  
subjects may be shot in an unsuitable skin tone.  
If you use flash, the [Color tone] setting will switch to the standard  
setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
92  
           
x Shooting Candlelight Portraits  
When shooting a human subject in candlelight, use <x> (Candlelight).  
The candlelight color tones will be retained in the photo.  
Shooting Tips  
Use the center AF point to focus.  
Aim the center AF point in the viewfinder over the subject, then shoot.  
Prevent camera shake if the shutter speed in the viewfinder  
blinks.  
Under low light when camera shake is prone to occur, the  
viewfinder’s shutter speed display will blink. Hold the camera steady  
or use a tripod. When using a zoom lens, use the wide-angle end to  
reduce blur caused by camera shake even while handholding the  
camera.  
Change the color tone.  
You can change [Color tone]. To increase the candlelight’s reddish  
tinge, set it toward [Warm tone]. Set it toward [Cool tone] if it looks  
too red.  
Live View shooting cannot be used.  
The built-in flash will not fire. In low light, the AF-assist beam may be  
emitted (p.113).  
If you are using an external Speedlite, the Speedlite will fire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
93  
           
6
Shooting Night Portraits (With a Tripod)  
To shoot people at night and obtain a natural-looking night scene in the  
background, use the <6> (Night Portrait) mode. Using a tripod is  
recommended.  
Shooting Tips  
Use a wide-angle lens and a tripod.  
When using a zoom lens, use the wide-angle end to obtain a wide  
night view. Also, use a tripod to prevent camera shake.  
Check the subject’s brightness.  
Under low light, the built-in flash will fire automatically to obtain a  
good exposure of the subject.  
It is recommended to play back the image after shooting to check  
the image brightness. If the subject looks dark, move nearer and  
shoot again.  
Also shoot in other shooting modes.  
Since camera shake is prone to occur with night shots, shooting also  
with <A> and <F> is recommended.  
Tell the subject to keep still even after the flash fires.  
If you use the self-timer together with flash, the self-timer lamp will light  
up briefly after the picture is taken.  
See the cautions on page 97.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
94  
       
F Shooting Night Scenes (Handheld)  
Using a tripod when shooting a night scene gives the best results.  
However, the <F> (Handheld Night Scene) mode enables you to shoot  
night scenes even while handholding the camera. Four shots are taken  
continuously for each picture, and the resulting one image with reduced  
camera shake is recorded.  
Shooting Tips  
Hold the camera firmly.  
While shooting, hold the camera firmly and steadily. In this mode,  
four shots are aligned and merged into a single image. However, if  
there is significant misalignment in any of the four shots due to  
camera shake, they may not align properly in the final image.  
For shots of people, turn on the flash.  
If you want to include people in the night scene shot, press the <Q>  
button to set <D> (Flash on). To take a nice portrait, the first shot will  
use flash. Tell the subject not to move until all four continuous shots  
are taken.  
See the cautions on page 97.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
95  
       
G Shooting Backlit Scenes  
When shooting a scene having both bright and dark areas, use the  
<G> (HDR Backlight Control) mode. When you take one picture in this  
mode, three continuous shots are taken at different exposures. This  
results in one image, with a wide tonal range, that has minimized the  
clipped shadows caused by backlighting.  
Shooting Tips  
Hold the camera firmly.  
While shooting, hold the camera firmly and steadily. In this mode,  
three shots are aligned and merged into a single image. However, if  
there is significant misalignment in any of the three shots due to  
camera shake, they may not align properly in the final image.  
The flash will not fire. In low light, the AF-assist beam may be emitted  
(p.113).  
See the cautions on page 97.  
HDR stands for High Dynamic Range.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
96  
     
Cautions for both <6> (Night Portrait) and <F> (Handheld Night  
Scene)  
During Live View shooting, it may be difficult to focus on dots of light  
such as in a night scene. In such a case, set the lens’s focus mode  
switch to <MF> and focus manually.  
The Live View image displayed will not look exactly the same as the  
actual image shot.  
Cautions for <F> (Handheld Night Scene)  
When shooting flash photography, if the subject is too close to the  
camera, the picture may come out extremely bright (overexposure).  
If you use flash to shoot a night scene with few lights, the shots may not  
align correctly. This can result in a blurry picture.  
If you use flash and the human subject is close to the background that is also  
illuminated by the flash, the shots may not align correctly. This can result in a  
blurry picture. Unnatural shadows and unsuitable colors may also appear.  
External flash coverage:  
• When using a Speedlite with automatic flash coverage setting, the zoom  
position will be fixed to the wide end, regardless of the lens’s zoom position.  
• If you have to set the flash coverage manually, set the light-emitting  
unit (flash head) to the wide-angle end before shooting.  
Cautions for <6> (Night Portrait)  
During Live View shooting, it may be difficult to focus when the face of  
the subject looks dark. In such a case, set the lens’s focus mode switch  
to <MF> and focus manually.  
Cautions for both <F> (Handheld Night Scene) and <G> (HDR  
Backlight Control)  
Compared to other shooting modes, the shooting range will be smaller.  
1+73 or 1 cannot be selected. If 1+73 or 1 has been set,  
73 will be set.  
If you shoot a moving subject, the subject’s movement may leave  
afterimages, or the surrounding area of the subject may become dark.  
The image alignment may not function properly with repetitive patterns  
(lattice, stripes, etc.), flat or single-tone images, or images significantly  
misaligned due to camera shake.  
It takes some time to record images to the card since they are merged  
after shooting. During the processing of the images, “buSY” will be  
displayed in the viewfinder and on the LCD panel, and you cannot take  
another picture until the processing is completed.  
If the shooting mode is set to <F> or <G>, direct printing is not possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
97  
 
Q Quick Control  
Cautions for <G> (HDR Backlight Control)  
Note that the image may not be rendered with a smooth gradation and  
may look irregular or have significant noise.  
HDR Backlight Control may not be effective for excessively backlit  
scenes or extremely high-contrast scenes.  
When shooting subjects that are sufficiently bright, for example for normally  
lit scenes, the image may look unnatural because of the applied HDR effect.  
Q Quick Control  
In Basic Zone modes when the shooting function settings screen is  
displayed, you can press the <Q> button to display the Quick Control  
screen. The tables on the next page show the functions that can be set  
with the Quick Control screen in each Basic Zone mode.  
Set the Mode Dial to a Basic Zone  
mode.  
1
2
Example: Portrait mode  
Press the <Q> button (7).  
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
Set the functions.  
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to select a function. (This step is  
not necessary in the 7 mode.)  
The selected function and Feature  
guide (p.73) will appear.  
3
Turn the <6> or <5> dial to  
change the setting.  
You can also select from a list by  
selecting a function and pressing  
<0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
98  
     
Q Quick Control  
Settable Functions in Basic Zone Modes  
o: Default setting k: User selectable  
: Not selectable  
Function  
A
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
k
k
7
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
C
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
k
k
k
2
k
o
k
k
k
k
k
o
k
k
k
k
3
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
4
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
k
k
k
k
5
k
o
k
k
k
k
k
u: Single shooting  
i: Continuous shooting  
B: Silent single shooting  
M: Silent continuous shooting  
Q (10 sec.)  
Drive mode  
l (2 sec.)  
q (Continuous)  
a: Automatic firing  
D: Flash on (Fires at all times)  
b: Flash off  
Flash firing  
o
o
k
k
o
k
k
Ambience-based shots (p.100)  
Light/scene-based shots (p.104)  
Background blur (p.84)  
k
k
Color tone (p.92, 93)  
Extra Effect Shot (p.83)  
8
Function  
C
k
o
k
k
k
k
k
o
k
k
k
k
P
x
F
G
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
6
u: Single shooting  
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
i: Continuous shooting  
B: Silent single shooting  
Drive mode  
M: Silent continuous shooting  
Q (10 sec.)  
l (2 sec.)  
q (Continuous)  
a: Automatic firing  
Flash firing  
D: Flash on (Fires at all times)  
b: Flash off  
k
o
k
k
o
k
o
k
o
Ambience-based shots (p.100)  
Light/scene-based shots (p.104)  
Background blur (p.84)  
k
Color tone (p.92, 93)  
k
k
Extra Effect Shot (p.83)  
* If you change the shooting mode or set the power switch to <2>, all the  
functions will revert to the default settings (except the self-timer).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
99  
     
Shoot by Ambience Selection  
Except in the <A>, <7>, and <G> Basic Zone modes, you can  
select the ambience for shooting.  
C/2/3/4/  
8
Ambience  
Ambience Effect  
C/6/F P/x  
5
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
m Standard setting  
n Vivid  
No setting  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Low / Standard / Strong  
Low / Standard / Strong  
Low / Standard / Strong  
Low / Standard / Strong  
Low / Standard / Strong  
Low / Medium / High  
Low / Medium / High  
Blue / B/W / Sepia  
o Soft  
p Warm  
t Intense  
u Cool  
v Brighter  
x Darker  
k
k
k
y Monochrome  
Set the Mode Dial to any of the  
following modes: <C>, <2>,  
<3>, <4>, <5>, or <8>.  
1
If the shooting mode is <8>, set  
one of the following: <C>, <P>,  
<x>, <6>, or <F>.  
Display the Live View image.  
Press the <A> button to display the  
Live View image (except <x>).  
2
On the Quick Control screen,  
3 select the desired ambience.  
Press the <Q> button (7).  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[m Standard setting]. [Ambience-  
based shots] will appear on the  
screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
100  
         
Shoot by Ambience Selection  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the desired ambience.  
The LCD monitor will display how the  
image will look with the selected  
ambience.  
Set the ambience effect.  
4
5
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
the effect so that [Effect] appears at  
the bottom.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the desired effect.  
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter button completely to  
take the picture.  
To return to viewfinder shooting,  
press the <A> button to exit Live  
View shooting. Then press the shutter  
button completely to take the picture.  
If you change the shooting mode or  
set the power switch to <2>, the  
setting will revert back to [m  
Standard setting].  
The Live View image displayed with the ambience setting applied will not  
look exactly the same as the actual image.  
Using flash may minimize the ambience effect.  
In bright outdoors, the Live View image you see on the LCD monitor may  
not have exactly the same brightness or ambience as the actual image.  
Set [52: LCD brightness] to 4, and look at the Live View image so that  
the LCD monitor is unaffected by outside light.  
If you do not want the Live View image to be displayed when setting  
functions, press the <Q> button after step 1 and set [Ambience-based  
shots] and [Effect].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
101  
Shoot by Ambience Selection  
Ambience Settings  
mStandard setting  
Standard image characteristics for the respective shooting mode.  
Note that <2> has image characteristics geared for portraits and  
<3> is geared for landscapes. Each ambience is a modification of  
the respective shooting mode’s image characteristics.  
n Vivid  
The subject will look sharp and vivid. It makes the photo look more  
impressive than with [m Standard setting].  
o Soft  
The subject will look softer and more dainty. Good for portraits, pets,  
flowers, etc.  
pWarm  
The subject will look softer with warmer colors. Good for portraits,  
pets, and other subjects to which you want to give a warm look.  
t Intense  
While the overall brightness is slightly lowered, the subject is  
emphasized for a more intense feeling. Makes the human or living  
subject stand out more.  
u Cool  
The overall brightness is slightly lowered with a cooler color cast. A  
subject in the shade will look more calm and impressive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
102  
Shoot by Ambience Selection  
v Brighter  
The picture will look brighter.  
x Darker  
The picture will look darker.  
y Monochrome  
The picture will be monochrome. You can select the monochrome  
color to be blue, black and white, or sepia. When [Monochrome] is  
selected, <0> will appear in the viewfinder.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
103  
Shoot by Lighting or Scene Type  
In the <2>, <3>, <4>, <5>, and <C> Basic Zone modes, you can  
shoot with the settings matching the lighting or scene type. Normally,  
[e Default setting] is adequate, but if the settings match the lighting  
condition or scene, the picture will look more accurate to your eyes.  
For Live View shooting, if you set both [Light/scene-based shots] and  
[Ambience-based shots] (p.100), you should first set [Light/scene-  
based shots]. This will make it easier to see the resulting effect on the  
LCD monitor.  
8
Lighting or Scene  
2
3
4
5
C
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
e Default setting  
f Daylight  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
g Shade  
h Cloudy  
i Tungsten light  
j Fluorescent light  
r Sunset  
k
Set the Mode Dial to any of the  
following modes: <2>, <3>,  
<4>, <5>, or <8>.  
1
For <8>, set it to <C>.  
Display the Live View image.  
Press the <A> button to display the  
2
Live View image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
104  
   
Shoot by Lighting or Scene Type  
On the Quick Control screen,  
3 select the lighting or scene type.  
Press the <Q> button (7).  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[e Default setting]. [Light/scene-  
based shots] will appear on the  
screen.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the lighting or scene type.  
The resulting image with the selected  
lighting or scene type will be  
displayed.  
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter button completely to  
4
take the picture.  
To return to viewfinder shooting,  
press the <A> button to exit Live  
View shooting. Then press the shutter  
button completely to take the picture.  
If you change the shooting mode or  
set the power switch to <2>, the  
setting will revert back to [e Default  
setting].  
If you use flash, the setting will switch to [e Default setting]. (However,  
the shooting information will display the lighting or scene type that is set.)  
If you want to set this together with [Ambience-based shots], set the  
lighting or scene type that best matches the ambience you have set. In  
the case of [Sunset], for example, warm colors will become prominent so  
the ambience you set may not work well.  
If you do not want the Live View image to be displayed when setting  
functions, press the <Q> button after step 1 and set [Light/scene-based  
shots].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
105  
Shoot by Lighting or Scene Type  
Lighting or Scene Type Settings  
e Default setting  
Default setting suited for most subjects.  
f Daylight  
For subjects under sunlight. Gives more natural-looking blue skies  
and greenery and reproduces light-colored flowers better.  
g Shade  
For subjects in the shade. Suitable for skin tones, which may look  
too bluish, and for light-colored flowers.  
h Cloudy  
For subjects under overcast skies. Makes skin tones and  
landscapes, which may otherwise look dull on a cloudy day, look  
warmer. Also effective for light-colored flowers.  
i Tungsten light  
For subjects lit under tungsten lighting. Reduces the reddish-orange  
color cast caused by tungsten lighting.  
j Fluorescent light  
For subjects under fluorescent lighting. Suited for all types of  
fluorescent lighting.  
r Sunset  
Suitable when you want to capture the sunset’s impressive colors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
106  
 
x Image Playback  
The easiest way to play back images is explained below. For more  
details on the playback procedure, see page 291.  
Play back the image.  
1
Press the <x> button.  
The last image captured or played  
back will appear.  
Select an image.  
To play back images starting with the  
2
last image captured, turn the <5>  
dial counterclockwise. To play back  
images starting with the first captured  
image, turn the <5> dial clockwise.  
Each time you press the <B>  
button, the information display will  
change.  
No information  
Basic information  
display  
Shooting information display  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
107  
       
x Image Playback  
Exit the image playback.  
3
Press the <x> button to exit the  
image playback and return to  
shooting-ready state.  
Shooting Information Display  
With the shooting information screen displayed (p.107), you can press  
the <W> <X> keys to change the shooting information displayed at the  
screen’s bottom as follows. For details, see pages 321-322.  
Detailed information  
GPS information  
Lens / Histogram information  
White balance information  
Picture Style information  
Lens aberration correction information  
Color space / Noise reduction information  
The information displayed varies depending on the shooting mode and  
settings.  
If GPS information is not recorded for the image, the GPS information  
screen will not be displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
108  
3
Setting the AF and  
Drive Modes  
The 19 AF points in the viewfinder  
make AF shooting suitable for a  
wide variety of subjects and  
scenes.  
You can also select the AF operation and drive mode  
that best match the shooting conditions and subject.  
The J icon at the upper right of the page title indicates that  
the function is available only in Creative Zone modes  
In Basic Zone modes, the AF operation and AF point (AF  
area selection mode) are set automatically.  
<AF> stands for autofocus. <MF> stands for manual focus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
109  
 
f: Changing the Autofocus OperationK  
You can select the AF (autofocus) operation characteristics suiting the  
shooting conditions or subject. In Basic Zone modes, the optimum AF  
operation is set automatically for the respective shooting mode.  
Set the lens’s focus mode switch  
to <AF>.  
1
Press the <Zf> button.  
2
[AF operation] will appear.  
Select the AF operation.  
3
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the desired AF operation, then press  
<0>.  
Focus on the subject.  
4
Aim the AF point over the subject and  
press the shutter button halfway. The  
camera will then autofocus in the  
selected AF operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
110  
     
f: Changing the Autofocus OperationK  
One-Shot AF for Still Subjects  
Suited for still subjects. When you  
press the shutter button halfway, the  
camera will focus only once.  
When focus is achieved, the AF point  
that achieved focus will be displayed,  
and the focus indicator <o> in the  
viewfinder will also light up.  
With evaluative metering, the  
exposure setting will be set at the  
same time focus is achieved.  
AF point  
Focus indicator  
While you hold down the shutter button halfway, the focus will be  
locked. You can then recompose the shot if desired.  
If focus cannot be achieved, the focus indicator <o> in the viewfinder  
will blink. If this occurs, the picture cannot be taken even if the shutter  
button is pressed completely. Recompose the shot or see “Subjects  
Difficult to Focus on” (p.120) and try to focus again.  
If [z1: Beep] is set to [Disable], the beeper will not sound when focus  
is achieved.  
After achieving focus with One-Shot AF, you can lock the focus on a  
subject and recompose the shot. This is called “focus lock”. This is  
convenient when you want to focus on a peripheral subject not covered  
by the Area AF frame.  
When a lens equipped with electronic manual focusing function is used,  
after achieving focus, you can focus manually by turning the lens  
focusing ring while pressing the shutter button halfway.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
111  
 
f: Changing the Autofocus OperationK  
AI Servo AF for Moving Subjects  
This AF operation is suited for moving subjects when the focusing  
distance keeps changing. While you hold down the shutter button  
halfway, the subject will be focused on continuously.  
The exposure is set at the moment the picture is taken.  
When the AF area selection mode is set to 19-point automatic  
selection AF (p.114), the camera first uses the manually-selected AF  
point to focus. During autofocusing, if the subject moves away from  
the manually-selected AF point, focus tracking continues as long as  
the subject is covered by the Area AF frame.  
With AI Servo AF, the beeper will not sound even when focus is achieved.  
Also, the focus indicator <o> in the viewfinder will not light up.  
AI Focus AF for Switching the AF Operation Automatically  
AI Focus AF switches the AF operation from One-Shot AF to AI  
Servo AF automatically if a still subject starts moving.  
After the subject is focused on in One-Shot AF, if the subject starts  
moving, the camera will detect the movement, change the AF  
operation automatically to AI Servo AF, and start tracking the moving  
subject.  
When focus is achieved with AI Focus AF with the Servo operation active,  
the beeper will continue beeping softly. However, the focus indicator <o> in  
the viewfinder will not light up. Note that focus will not be locked in this case.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
112  
   
f: Changing the Autofocus OperationK  
AF Points Lighting Up in Red  
By default, the AF points light up in red when focus is achieved in low-  
light conditions. In Creative Zone modes, you can set whether to have  
the AF points light up in red when focus is achieved (p.356).  
AF-Assist Beam with the Built-in Flash  
Under low-light conditions, when you press the shutter button halfway,  
the built-in flash may fire a brief burst of flashes. This illuminates the  
subject to help autofocusing.  
The AF-assist beam will not be emitted from the built-in flash in the  
following shooting modes: <7>, <3>, <5>, and <C>.  
The AF-assist beam will not be emitted with AI Servo AF operation.  
The built-in flash makes a sound when firing continuously. This is normal  
and not a malfunction.  
The effective range of the AF-assist beam emitted by the built-in flash is  
approx. 4 meters/13.1 feet.  
In Creative Zone modes, when you raise the built-in flash with the <I>  
button (p.176), the AF-assist beam will be emitted when necessary. Note  
that depending on the setting for [4: AF-assist beam firing] under [54:  
Custom Functions (C.Fn)], AF-assist beam will not be emitted (p.354).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
113  
 
S Selecting the AF Area and AF PointK  
19 AF points are provided for autofocusing. You can select the AF area  
selection mode and AF point(s) suiting the scene or subject.  
AF Area Selection Mode  
You can select one of three AF area selection modes. See the next  
page for the selection procedure.  
h: Single-point AF (Manual  
selection)  
Select one AF point to focus.  
q: Zone AF (Manual selection of  
zone)  
The 19 AF points are divided into five  
zones for focusing.  
r: 19-point automatic selection  
AF  
All the AF points are used to focus. This  
mode is set automatically in Basic  
Zone modes (except <x>).  
Area AF frame  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
114  
                 
S Selecting the AF Area and AF PointK  
Selecting the AF Area Selection Mode  
Press the <S> or <B> button  
(9).  
Look through the viewfinder and  
press the <S> or <B> button.  
1
Press the <B> button.  
2
Each time you press the <B>  
button, the AF area selection mode  
changes.  
The AF area selection mode currently  
set is indicated on the top of the  
viewfinder.  
AF area selection mode  
h: Single-point AF  
(Manual selection)  
q: Zone AF  
(Manual selection of zone)  
r: 19-point automatic selection  
AF  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if you set [5: AF area selection  
method] to [1: j9Main Dial], you can select the AF area selection mode  
by pressing the <S> or <B> button, then turning the <6> dial (p.354).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
115  
 
S Selecting the AF Area and AF PointK  
Selecting the AF Point Manually  
You can manually select the AF point or zone. If 19-point automatic  
selection AF + AI Servo AF has been set, you can select any position  
where AI Servo AF is to start.  
Press the <S> or <B> button  
(9).  
The AF points will be displayed in the  
viewfinder.  
1
In the Zone AF mode, the selected  
zone will be displayed.  
Select an AF point.  
2
You can select an AF point by shifting  
<6>  
horizontally with the <6> dial or  
vertically with the <5> dial. If you  
<5>  
press <0>, the center AF point (or  
center zone) will be selected.  
In the Zone AF mode, turning the  
<6> or <5> dial will change the  
zone in a looping sequence.  
You can also select an AF point or  
zone by shifting horizontally with the  
<Y> <Z> keys or vertically with the  
<W> <X> keys.  
When you hold down the <Q> button and turn the <6> dial, you can  
select an AF point by shifting vertically.  
When you press the <S> or <B> button, the LCD panel displays the  
following:  
• 19-point automatic selection AF and Zone AF (manual selection of  
zone): M AF  
• 1 pt AF (Manual selection): SEL N (Center)/SEL AF (Off center)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
116  
     
AF Area Selection ModesK  
h Single-point AF (Manual Selection)  
Select one AF point <S> to be used for focusing.  
q Zone AF (Manual Selection of Zone)  
The 19 AF points are divided into five zones for focusing. All the AF  
points in the selected zone are used for the automatic selection of the  
focusing point(s). It is effective for moving subjects.  
However, since it is inclined to focus the nearest subject, focusing a  
specific target is harder than with single-point AF.  
The AF point(s) achieving focus is displayed as <S>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
117  
 
AF Area Selection ModesK  
r 19-point Automatic Selection AF  
All the AF points are used to focus. This mode is set automatically in  
Basic Zone modes (except <x>).  
With One-Shot AF, pressing the shutter button  
halfway will display the AF point(s) <S> that  
achieved focus. If multiple AF points are displayed,  
it means they all have achieved focus.  
With AI Servo AF, the manually-selected (p.116) AF  
point <S> is used first to achieve focus. The AF  
point(s) achieving focus is displayed as <S>.  
AF Using Color Tone Detection  
Configuring the following makes it easier to focus on still human subject.  
• Set the AF operation to One-Shot AF.  
• Set the AF area selection mode to Zone AF (manual selection of zone) or  
19-point automatic selection AF.  
• Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], set [6: Auto AF point selection:  
Color Tracking] to [0: One-Shot AF only] (if set to [1: Disable], basically  
the nearest subject will be focused on) (p.355).  
When AI Servo AF mode is set with 19-point automatic selection AF or  
Zone AF, the active AF point <S> will keep switching to track the  
subject. However, under certain shooting conditions (such as when the  
subject is small), it may not be able to track the subject. Also, in low  
temperatures, the tracking response is slower.  
If the camera cannot focus with the EOS-dedicated external Speedlite’s  
AF-assist beam, set the AF area selection mode to Single-point AF  
(manual selection) and select the center AF point to autofocus.  
When the AF point(s) light up, part or all of the viewfinder may light up in  
red. This is a characteristic of AF point display using liquid crystal.  
In low temperatures, it may sometimes become difficult to see the AF  
point display because of its characteristics using liquid crystal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
118  
 
AF Area Selection ModesK  
AF Operation and Maximum Lens Apertures  
Maximum Lens Aperture: f/3.2 - f/5.6  
With all AF points, cross-type AF sensitive to both vertical and  
horizontal lines is possible. However, with the lenses below, the  
peripheral AF points will detect only vertical or horizontal lines (no  
cross-type focusing).  
Lenses that Do Not Support Cross-Type Focusing with  
Peripheral AF Points  
Cross-type focusing  
Vertical line-sensitive focusing  
Horizontal line-sensitive focusing  
Cross-type focusing at the < > and < > AF points is not possible with the  
following lenses:  
EF35-80mm f/4-5.6, EF35-80mm f/4-5.6 II, EF35-80mm f/4-5.6 III,  
EF35-80mm f/4-5.6 USM, EF35-105mm f/4.5-5.6, EF35-105mm f/4.5-5.6  
USM, EF80-200mm f/4.5-5.6 II, EF80-200mm f/4.5-5.6 USM  
Maximum Lens Aperture: f/1.0 - f/2.8  
Besides cross-type focusing (vertical and horizontal lines detected  
simultaneously), the center AF point can also perform high-precision,  
vertical-line sensitive AF.*  
The remaining 18 AF points perform cross-type focusing, as with the  
maximum aperture at f/3.2 - f/5.6.  
* Except with the EF28-80mm f/2.8-4L USM and EF50mm f/2.5 Compact Macro.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
119  
 
Subjects Difficult to Focus on  
Autofocus can fail to achieve focus (viewfinder’s focus indicator <o>  
blinks) with certain subjects such as the following:  
Very low-contrast subjects  
(Example: Blue sky, solid-color walls, etc.)  
Subjects in very low light  
Strongly backlit or reflective subjects  
(Example: Car with a highly reflective body, etc.)  
Near and distant subjects framed close to an AF point  
(Example: Animal in a cage, etc.)  
Subjects such as dots of light framed close to an AF point  
(Example: Night scenes, etc.)  
Repetitive patterns  
(Example: Skyscraper windows, computer keyboards, etc.)  
In such cases, do either of the following:  
(1) With One-Shot AF, focus on an object at the same distance as  
the subject and lock the focus before recomposing the shot  
(2) Set the lens’s focus mode switch to <MF> and focus manually.  
Depending on the subject, focus may be achieved by slightly  
recomposing the shot and performing AF operation again.  
Conditions that make focusing difficult with AF during Live View shooting  
or movie shooting are listed on page 224.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
120  
     
Subjects Difficult to Focus on  
MF: Manual Focus  
Set the lens focus mode switch to  
<MF>.  
1
2
Focus on the subject.  
Focus by turning the lens focusing  
ring until the subject looks sharp in  
the viewfinder.  
Focusing ring  
If you press the shutter button halfway during manual focusing, the AF point  
that achieved focus and the focus indicator <o> will light up in the  
viewfinder.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
121  
       
i Selecting the Drive Mode  
Single and continuous drive modes are provided.  
Press the <YQi> button.  
[Drive mode] will appear.  
1
Select the drive mode.  
2
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the desired drive mode, then press  
<0>.  
u : Single shooting  
When you press the shutter button completely, only one shot will  
be taken.  
i : Continuous shooting (Max. approx. 5.0 shots/sec.)  
While you hold down the shutter button completely, shots will be  
taken continuously.  
B : Silent single shooting  
Single shooting with less shooting sound than <u>.  
M : Silent continuous shooting (Max. approx. 3.0 shots/sec.)  
Continuous shooting with less shooting sound than <i>.  
Q : Self-timer: 10sec./remote control  
l : Self-timer: 2 sec.  
q : Self-timer: Continuous  
For self-timer shooting, see page 124. For remote control  
shooting, see page 366.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
122  
             
i Selecting the Drive Mode  
If <B> or <M> is set, the time lag from when you press the shutter  
button completely until the picture is shot will be longer than with normal  
single or continuous shooting.  
With Live View shooting, <B> and <M> cannot be set.  
When the battery level is low, the continuous shooting speed may  
become slightly slower.  
In AI Servo AF operation, the continuous shooting speed may become  
slightly slower depending on the subject and the lens used.  
i: The maximum continuous shooting speed of approx. 5.0 shots/sec.  
is attained under the following conditions*: At 1/500 sec. or faster shutter  
speed, at maximum aperture (varies depending on the lens), Distortion  
correction: Disable, and Anti-flicker shooting: Disable. The continuous  
shooting speed may decrease depending on the shutter speed, aperture,  
subject conditions, brightness, lens, flash use, temperature, remaining  
battery level, etc.  
* Set the AF operation mode to One-Shot AF and the Image Stabilizer (IS) switch to  
OFF when using the following lenses: EF300mm f/4L IS USM, EF28-135mm f/3.5-  
5.6 IS USM, EF75-300mm f/4-5.6 IS USM, and EF100-400mm f/4.5-5.6L IS USM.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
123  
j Using the Self-timer  
Press the <YQi> button.  
[Drive mode] will appear.  
1
2
Select the self-timer.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the self-timer, then press <0>.  
Q: 10-sec. self-timer  
The remote controller can also  
be used (p.366).  
l: 2-sec. self-timer (p.85)  
q: 10-sec. self-timer plus continuous shots  
Press the <W> <X> keys to set  
the number of multiple shots (2 to  
10) to be taken with the self-timer.  
Take the picture.  
3
Look through the viewfinder, focus on  
the subject, then press the shutter  
button completely.  
You can check the self-timer  
operation with the self-timer lamp,  
beeper, and countdown display (in  
seconds) on the LCD panel.  
Two sec. before the picture is taken, the self-timer lamp will light up  
and the beeper will sound faster.  
With <q>, the interval between the multiple shots may be prolonged  
depending on the shooting functions settings such as the image-  
recording quality or flash.  
If you do not look through the viewfinder when you press the shutter  
button, attach the eyepiece cover (p.367). If stray light enters the  
viewfinder when the picture is taken, it may throw off the exposure.  
After taking self-timer shots, playing back the image (p.107) to check  
focus and exposure is recommended.  
When using the self-timer to shoot yourself, use focus lock (p.79) on an  
object at the same distance as where you will stand.  
To cancel the self-timer after it starts, either touch the LCD monitor or  
press the <YQi> button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
124  
         
4
Image Settings  
This chapter explains image-related function settings:  
Image-recording quality, ISO speed, Picture Style, white  
balance, Auto Lighting Optimizer, noise reduction, lens  
aberration correction, anti-flicker shooting, and other  
functions.  
In Basic Zone modes, only the following can be set as  
described in this chapter: Image-recording quality and lens  
aberration correction.  
The  
J
icon at the upper right of the page title indicates that  
the function is available only in Creative Zone modes (p.31).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
125  
 
3
Setting the Image-Recording Quality  
You can select the pixel count and the image quality. Ten image-  
recording quality settings are provided: 73, 83, 74, 84, 7a,  
8a, b, c, 1+73, 1.  
Select the image-recording  
quality.  
Under the [z1] tab, select [Image  
quality], then press <0>.  
1
[Image quality] will appear.  
Pixels recorded (pixel count)  
Set the image-recording quality.  
2
The respective quality’s pixel count  
and number of possible shots will be  
displayed to help you select the  
Possible shots  
desired quality. Then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
126  
     
3 Setting the Image-Recording Quality  
Guide to Image-recording Quality Settings  
(Approx.)  
Pixels  
Recorded  
(megapixels)  
File Size  
(MB)  
Possible  
Shots  
Maximum  
Burst  
Image Quality  
73  
7.6  
3.9  
940  
1810  
1770  
3500  
2830  
5320  
5320  
20180  
190  
180 (940)  
1810 (1810)  
1770 (1770)  
3500 (3500)  
2830 (2830)  
5320 (5320)  
5320 (5320)  
20180 (20180)  
6 (6)  
High  
quality  
24 (24M)  
10.6 (11M)  
5.9 (5.9M)  
83  
74  
84  
7a  
8a  
b
4.0  
Medium  
quality  
2.0  
JPEG  
2.5  
1.3  
Low  
quality  
2.5 (2.5M)  
1.3  
c
0.35 (0.3M)  
0.3  
1+73  
28.1+7.6  
28.1  
High  
quality  
24 (24M)  
1
240  
7 (8)  
* The file size, possible shots, and maximum burst during continuous shooting are  
based on Canon’s testing standards (3:2 aspect ratio, ISO 100 and Standard  
Picture Style) using an 8 GB card. These figures will vary by the subject,  
card brand, aspect ratio, ISO speed, Picture Style, Custom Functions, and  
other settings.  
* Figures in parentheses apply to an UHS-I compatible 8 GB card based on  
Canon’s testing standards.  
Even if you use a UHS-I class card, the maximum burst indicator remains  
the same. However, the maximum burst in parentheses in the above table  
will be applied during continuous shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
127  
           
3 Setting the Image-Recording Quality  
FAQ  
I want to select the image-recording quality matching the paper  
size for printing.  
Refer to the diagram on the left when  
Paper size  
choosing the image-recording quality. If  
A2(59.4x42cm/23.4x16.5in.)  
you want to crop the image, selecting a  
73  
83  
higher quality (more pixels) such as 73,  
83, 1+73, or 1 is recommended.  
b is suitable for playing back the image  
with a digital photo frame. c is suitable  
for emailing the image or using it on a  
Web site.  
A3(42x29.7cm/  
16.5x11.7in.)  
1
+73  
74  
84  
1
7a  
8a  
b
A4(29.7x21cm/11.7x8.3in.)  
12.7x8.9cm/5.0x3.5in.  
What’s the difference between 7 and 8?  
These settings indicate the different levels of image quality caused  
by different compression rates. The 7 setting produces a higher  
image quality with the same number of pixels. Although 8 produces  
a slightly lower image quality, this allows more images to be saved  
on the card. Both b and c have 7 (Fine) quality.  
I was able to take more shots than the number of possible shots  
indicated.  
Depending on the shooting conditions, you may be able to take  
more shots than is indicated. It may also be fewer than indicated.  
The number of possible shots displayed is only approximate.  
Does the camera display the maximum burst?  
The maximum burst is displayed on the viewfinder’s right side. Since  
it is only a single-digit indicator 0 - 9, any number higher than 8 will  
be displayed only as “9”. Note that this number will also be displayed  
even when no card is installed in the camera. Be careful not to shoot  
without a card in the camera.  
When should I use 1?  
1 images must be processed on a computer. For details, see  
1” and “1+73” on the next page.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
128  
 
3 Setting the Image-Recording Quality  
1
1 is the raw image data before it is made into 73 or other images.  
1 images cannot be viewed on a computer without the use of EOS  
software, such as Digital Photo Professional (p.420). However, you can  
perform various adjustments on them that are impossible with other  
image types such as 73. 1 is effective when you want to precisely  
adjust the image yourself or shoot an important subject.  
1+73  
1
+73 records a  
1
image and a 73 image with a single shot. The  
two images are saved to the card simultaneously. The two images will be  
saved in the same folder with the same file numbers (file extension .JPG for  
JPEG and .CR2 for RAW). 73 images can be viewed or printed even with  
a computer which does not have the EOS software installed.  
1 image  
73 image  
0001 . CR2  
0001 . JPG  
File number  
File extension  
RAW Image Processing Software  
The use of “Digital Photo Professional” (EOS software, p.420) is  
recommended when viewing RAW images on a computer.  
Older versions of Digital Photo Proessional may not be able to process  
RAW images taken with this camera. If an older version of Digital Photo  
Professional is installed on your computer, update (overwrite) it as follows.  
• When the software CD-ROM (EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk) is provided  
with the camera:  
Install Digital Photo Professional from the CD-ROM.  
• When the software CD-ROM (EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk) is not  
provided with the camera:  
Download a version of Digital Photo Professional compatible with this  
camera from the Canon Web site.  
Commercially-available software may not be able to display RAW  
images taken with this camera. For compatibility information, contact the  
software manufacturer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
129  
   
3Changing the Image’s Aspect RatioK  
You can change the image’s aspect ratio. [3:2] is set by default. When  
[4:3], [16:9], or [1:1] is set, lines will appear to indicate the shooting  
range. During Live View shooting, the image appears with the  
surrounding area masked in black.  
Select the aspect ratio.  
1
Under the [z3] tab, select [Aspect  
ratio], then press <0>.  
[Aspect ratio] will appear.  
Set the aspect ratio.  
2
Select an aspect ratio, then press  
<0>.  
JPEG images  
The images will be saved with the set aspect ratio.  
RAW images  
The images will always be saved with the [3:2] aspect ratio. The  
selected aspect ratio information is added to the RAW image file.  
When you process the RAW image with the EOS software, this  
allows you to generate an image with the same aspect ratio that was  
set for shooting. In the case of the [4:3], [16:9], and [1:1] aspect  
ratios, the lines to indicate the aspect ratio will appear during image  
playback, but they are not actually drawn on the image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
130  
       
3Changing the Image’s Aspect RatioK  
The table below shows the aspect ratio and the number of recorded  
pixels for each image-recording quality.  
Aspect Ratio and Pixel Count (approx.)  
Image  
Quality  
3:2  
4:3  
16:9  
1:1  
3
6000x4000  
5328x4000*  
6000x3368*  
4000x4000  
(24.0 megapixels) (21.3 megapixels) (20.2 megapixels) (16.0 megapixels)  
1
3984x2656 3552x2664 3984x2240* 2656x2656  
4
a
(10.6 megapixels) (9.5 megapixels) (8.9 megapixels) (7.1 megapixels)  
2976x1984 2656x1992 2976x1680* 1984x1984  
(5.9 megapixels) (5.3 megapixels) (5.0 megapixels) (3.9 megapixels)  
1920x1280 1696x1280* 1920x1080 1280x1280  
(2.5 megapixels) (2.2 megapixels) (2.1 megapixels) (1.6 megapixels)  
720x480 640x480 720x408* 480x480  
(0.35 megapixels) (0.31 megapixels) (0.29 megapixels) (0.23 megapixels)  
b
c
The asterisked image-recording quality settings do not match the  
respective aspect ratio exactly.  
The shooting range displayed for the asterisked aspect ratio is slightly  
larger than the recorded area. Check the captured images on the LCD  
monitor when shooting.  
If you use a different camera to directly print images shot with this  
camera in the 1:1 aspect ratio, the images may not be correctly printed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
131  
g: Changing the ISO Speed to Suit the Light  
K
Set the ISO speed (image sensor’s sensitivity to light) to suit the  
ambient light level. In Basic Zone modes, the ISO speed is set  
Press the <g> button (9).  
1
Set the ISO speed.  
2
While looking at the LCD panel or in  
the viewfinder, turn the <6> or  
<5> dial.  
A” indicates ISO Auto. The ISO  
speed will be set automatically  
ISO Speed Guide  
Shooting Situation  
ISO Speed  
Flash Range  
(No flash)  
ISO 100 - ISO 400  
Sunny outdoors  
The higher the ISO  
speed, the farther the  
flash range will extend  
(p.176).  
ISO 400 - ISO 1600 Overcast skies or evening time  
ISO 1600 - ISO 12800, H Dark indoors or night  
* High ISO speeds will result in grainier images.  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [2: ISO expansion] is set to [1:  
On], “H” (equivalent to ISO 25600) can also be selected (p.352).  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [3: Highlight tone priority] is  
set to [1: Enable], ISO 100 and “H” (equivalent to ISO 25600) cannot be  
selected (p.353).  
Shooting in high temperatures may result in images that look grainier.  
Long exposures can also cause irregular colors in the image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
132  
   
g: Changing the ISO Speed to Suit the LightK  
When you shoot at high ISO speeds, noise (such as dots of light and  
banding) may become noticeable.  
If you use a high ISO speed and flash to shoot a close subject,  
overexposure may result.  
When shooting in conditions that produce an extreme amount of noise,  
such as a combination of high ISO speed, high temperature and long  
exposure, images may not be recorded properly.  
As “H” (equivalent to ISO 25600) is an expanded ISO speed setting,  
noise (such as dots of light and banding) and irregular colors will be more  
noticeable, and the resolution will be lower than usual.  
As the maximum ISO speed that can be set differs between still photo  
shooting and movie shooting (manual exposure), the ISO speed you set  
may change when you switch from still photo shooting to movie shooting.  
Even if you switch back to still photo shooting, the ISO speed will not  
revert to the original setting. The maximum ISO speed that can be set  
varies depending on the setting for [2: ISO expansion] under [54:  
Custom Functions (C.Fn)].  
• When [0: Off] is set: If you set ISO 12800 during still photo shooting  
and then switch to movie shooting, ISO speed will be changed to ISO  
6400.  
• When [1: On] is set: If you set ISO 12800 or “H” (equivalent to ISO  
25600) during still photo shooting and then switch to movie shooting,  
ISO speed will be changed to “H” (equivalent to ISO 12800).  
3 Setting the Maximum ISO Speed for [AUTO]K  
For ISO Auto, you can set the maximum ISO speed limit within ISO 400  
- ISO 6400.  
Under the [z3] tab, select [ISO Auto],  
then press <0>. Select the ISO speed,  
then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
133  
     
g: Changing the ISO Speed to Suit the LightK  
ISO [AUTO  
]
If the ISO speed is set to “A” (Auto), the  
actual ISO speed setting will be  
displayed when you press the shutter  
button halfway. As indicated below, the  
ISO speed will be set automatically to  
suit the shooting mode.  
ISO Speed Setting  
Shooting Mode  
No Flash  
With Flash  
A/7/C/2/4/5  
ISO 100 - ISO 6400  
ISO 100 - ISO 1600  
ISO 100 - ISO 6400  
ISO 100 - ISO 12800  
3
*2  
ISO 400  
C/P/x/6/G  
8
F
(Except in the A, C,  
6, and F modes.)  
*1  
d/s/f/a  
ISO 100 - ISO 6400  
ISO 400  
With bulb exposures  
*1: Depends on the maximum ISO speed limit set (p.133).  
*2: (1) If fill flash results in overexposure, ISO 100 or a higher ISO speed will be  
set.  
(2) In the C, 2, 3, 4, 5, x, P, and <d> modes, if you use bounce  
flash with an external Speedlite, the ISO speed will be automatically set  
within ISO 400 - ISO 1600 (or up to the maximum limit).  
When [AUTO] is set, the ISO speed is indicated in whole-stop increments.  
However, the ISO speed is actually set in finer increments. Therefore, in the  
image’s shooting information (p.320), you may find an ISO speed such as  
ISO 125 or ISO 640 displayed as the ISO speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
134  
   
A Selecting a Picture StyleK  
By selecting a Picture Style, you can obtain image characteristics  
matching your photographic expression or the subject.  
In Basic Zone modes, [D] (Auto) is set automatically.  
Press the <XA> button.  
1
The Picture Style selection screen will  
appear.  
Select a Picture Style.  
2
Select a Picture Style, then press  
<0>.  
The Picture Style will be set.  
You can also set the Picture Style with [z2: Picture Style].  
Picture Style Characteristics  
D Auto  
The color tones will be adjusted automatically to suit the scene.  
The colors will look vivid, especially for blue skies, greenery and  
sunsets, and in nature, outdoor and sunset scenes.  
If the desired color tone is not obtained with [Auto], use another Picture Style.  
P Standard  
The image looks vivid, sharp, and crisp. This is a general-purpose  
Picture Style suitable for most scenes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
135  
       
A Selecting a Picture StyleK  
Q Portrait  
For nice skin tones. The image looks softer. Suited for close-up  
portraits.  
By changing the [Color tone] (p.138), you can adjust the skin  
tone.  
R Landscape  
For vivid blues and greens, and very sharp and crisp images.  
Effective for impressive landscapes.  
S Neutral  
This Picture Style is for users who prefer to process images with  
their computer. For natural colors and subdued images with  
modest brightness and color saturation.  
U Faithful  
This Picture Style is for users who prefer to process images with  
their computer. The color of a subject that is captured in sunlight at  
a color temperature of 5200K will be adjusted to match the  
subject’s colorimetrical color. For subdued images with modest  
brightness and color saturation.  
V Monochrome  
Creates black-and-white images.  
Black-and-white images shot in JPEG cannot be turned into color. If  
you want to later shoot pictures in color, make sure the  
[Monochrome] setting is canceled. When [Monochrome] is  
selected, <0> will appear in the viewfinder.  
W User Def. 1-3  
You can register a base style such as [Portrait], [Landscape], a  
Picture Style file, etc., and adjust it as desired (p.140). Any User  
Defined Picture Style that has not been set will have the same  
default settings as the [Auto] Picture Style.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
136  
           
A Customizing a Picture StyleK  
You can customize a Picture Style by adjusting individual parameters  
such as [Sharpness] and [Contrast]. To see the resulting effects, take  
test shots. To customize [Monochrome], see page 139.  
Press the <XA> button.  
1
The Picture Style selection screen will  
appear.  
Select a Picture Style.  
2
Select a Picture Style, then press the  
<B> button.  
Select a parameter.  
3
Select a parameter such as  
[Sharpness], then press <0>.  
Set the parameter.  
4
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to adjust  
the parameter as desired, then press  
<0>.  
Press the <M> button to save the  
adjusted parameters. The Picture  
Style selection screen will reappear.  
Any parameter settings different from  
the default will be displayed in blue.  
By selecting [Default set.] in step 3, you can revert the parameter  
settings of the respective Picture Style to its default.  
To shoot with the Picture Style you adjusted, follow step 2 on page 135 to  
select the adjusted Picture Style, then shoot.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
137  
     
A Customizing a Picture StyleK  
Parameter Settings and Effects  
g
h
i
j
Sharpness  
Adjusts the sharpness of the image.  
To make it less sharp, set it toward the E end. The closer it is to E,  
the softer the image will look.  
To make it sharper, set it toward the F end. The closer it is to F, the  
sharper the image will look.  
Contrast  
Adjusts the image contrast and the vividness of colors.  
To decrease the contrast, set it toward the minus end. The closer it is  
to G, the more muted the image will look.  
To increase the contrast, set it toward the plus end. The closer it is to  
H, the crisper the image will look.  
Saturation  
Adjusts the color saturation in the image.  
To decrease the color saturation, set it toward the minus end. The  
closer it is to G, the more diluted the colors will look.  
To increase the color saturation, set it toward the plus end. The  
closer it is to H, the bolder the colors will look.  
Color tone  
Adjusts the color tone of skin.  
To make the skin tone redder, set it toward the minus end. The  
closer it is to G, the redder the skin tone will look.  
To reduce skin redness, set it toward the plus end. The closer it is to  
H, the more yellow the skin tone will look.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
138  
         
A Customizing a Picture StyleK  
V Monochrome Adjustment  
For Monochrome, you can also set [Filter effect] and [Toning effect] in  
addition to [Sharpness] and [Contrast] explained on the preceding  
page.  
kFilter Effect  
With a filter effect applied to a  
monochrome image, you can make  
white clouds or green trees stand out  
more.  
Filter  
Sample Effects  
N: None  
Normal black-and-white image with no filter effects.  
The blue sky will look more natural, and the white clouds will look  
crisper.  
Ye: Yellow  
Or: Orange  
R: Red  
The blue sky will look slightly darker. The sunset will look more  
brilliant.  
The blue sky will look quite dark. Fall leaves will look crisper and  
brighter.  
Skin tones and lips will appear muted. Green tree leaves will look  
crisper and brighter.  
G: Green  
Increasing the [Contrast] will make the filter effect more pronounced.  
lToning Effect  
By applying a toning effect, you can  
create a monochrome image in that  
color. It can make the image look more  
impressive.  
The following can be selected: [N:None],  
[S:Sepia], [B:Blue], [P:Purple] or  
[G:Green].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
139  
           
A Registering a Picture StyleK  
You can select a base Picture Style such as [Portrait] or [Landscape],  
adjust its parameters as desired and register it under [User Def. 1],  
[User Def. 2], or [User Def. 3].  
You can create multiple Picture Styles with different settings for  
parameters such as sharpness and contrast.  
You can also adjust the parameters of a Picture Style that is registered  
to the camera with EOS Utility (EOS software, p.420).  
Press the <XA> button.  
1
The Picture Style selection screen will  
appear.  
Select [User Def. *].  
2
Select [User Def. *], then press  
<B>.  
The Detail setting screen will appear.  
Press <0>.  
With [Picture Style] selected, press  
3
<0>.  
Select the base Picture Style.  
4
Select the base Picture Style, then  
press <0>.  
To adjust the parameters of a Picture  
Style that is registered to the camera  
with EOS Utility (EOS software),  
select the Picture Style here.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
140  
     
A Registering a Picture StyleK  
Select a parameter.  
Select a parameter such as  
[Sharpness], then press <0>.  
5
Set the parameter.  
6
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to adjust  
the parameter as desired, then press  
<0>.  
For details, see “Customizing a  
Picture Style” on pages 137-139.  
Press the <M> button to register  
the modified Picture Style. The  
Picture Style selection screen will  
then reappear.  
The base Picture Style will be  
indicated on the right of [User Def. *].  
If a Picture Style has already been registered under [User Def. *],  
changing the base Picture Style in step 4 will nullify the parameter  
settings of the registered Picture Style.  
If you perform [Clear all camera settings] (p.282), Picture Styles and  
their parameters set under [User Def. *] will be reverted to their default  
settings. Picture Styles registered via EOS Utility (EOS software) will  
have only their modified parameters reverted to their default settings.  
To shoot with a registered Picture Style, follow step 2 on page 135 to  
select [User Def. *], then shoot.  
Regarding the procedure to register a Picture Style file to the camera,  
refer to the EOS Utility Instruction Manual (p.422).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
141  
B: Matching the Light SourceK  
The function adjusting the color tone so that white objects look white in  
the picture is called white balance (WB). Normally, the [Q] (Auto)  
setting will obtain the correct white balance. If natural-looking colors  
cannot be obtained with [Q], you can select the white balance to  
match the light source or set it manually by shooting a white object.  
Press the <WB> button.  
1
[White balance] will appear.  
Select a white balance setting.  
2
Select the desired setting, then press  
<0>.  
The “Approx. ****K” (K: Kelvin)  
displayed for the white balance  
settings <W>, <E>, <R>, <Y>  
or <U> is the respective color  
temperature.  
O Custom White Balance  
Custom white balance enables you to manually set the white balance  
for a specific light source for better accuracy. Perform this procedure  
under the actual light source to be used.  
Shoot a white object.  
Look through the viewfinder and aim  
1
the entire dotted line box (shown in  
the illustration) over a plain, white  
object.  
Focus manually and shoot with the  
standard exposure set for the white  
object.  
You can use any white balance setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
142  
         
B: Matching the Light SourceK  
Select [Custom White Balance].  
2
3
Under the [z2] tab, select [Custom  
White Balance], then press <0>.  
The custom white balance selection  
screen will appear.  
Import the white balance data.  
Select the image that was captured in  
step 1, then press <0>.  
On the dialog screen that appears,  
select [OK] and the data will be  
imported.  
When the menu reappears, press the  
<M> button to exit the menu.  
Select [O (Custom)].  
4
Press the <WB> button.  
Select [O (Custom)], then press  
<0>.  
If the exposure obtained in step 1 differs greatly from the standard  
exposure, a correct white balance may not be obtained.  
In step 3, the following images cannot be selected: Images captured  
while the Picture Style was set to [Monochrome] (p.136), images  
processed with a Creative filter, cropped images, and images taken with  
another camera.  
Instead of a white object, a gray chart or 18% gray reflector  
(commercially available) can produce a more accurate white balance.  
The personal white balance registered with EOS Utility (EOS software,  
p.420) will be registered under [O]. If you perform step 3, the data for  
the registered personal white balance will be erased.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
143  
   
u
Adjusting the Color Tone for the Light SourceK  
You can correct the white balance that is set. This adjustment will have  
the same effect as using a commercially-available color temperature  
conversion filter or color compensating filter. Each color can be  
corrected to one of nine levels.  
This function is for advanced users who are familiar with using color  
temperature conversion or color compensating filters.  
White Balance Correction  
Select [WB Shift/Bkt.].  
1
Under the [z2] tab, select [WB  
Shift/Bkt.], then press <0>.  
The WB correction/WB bracketing  
screen will appear.  
Set the white balance correction.  
2
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to move the “ ” mark to the  
appropriate position.  
B is for blue, A for amber, M for  
magenta, and G for green. The  
image’s color balance will be adjusted  
Sample setting: A2, G1  
towards the color in the direction of  
the move.  
On the upper right, “Shift” indicates  
the direction and correction amount,  
respectively.  
Pressing the <L> button will cancel  
all the [WB Shift/Bkt.] settings.  
Press <0> to exit the setting and  
return to the menu.  
When the white balance is corrected, <u> will be displayed in the  
viewfinder and on the LCD monitor.  
One level of the blue/amber correction is equivalent to approx. 5 mireds  
of a color temperature conversion filter. (Mired: Measuring unit indicating  
the density of a color temperature conversion filter.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
144  
     
u Adjusting the Color Tone for the Light SourceK  
White Balance Auto Bracketing  
With just one shot, three images with different color tones can be  
recorded simultaneously. Based on the color temperature of the current  
white balance setting, the image will be bracketed with a blue/amber  
bias or magenta/green bias. This is called white balance bracketing  
(WB Bkt.). White balance bracketing is possible up to ±3 levels in  
single-level increments.  
Set the white balance bracketing amount.  
In step 2 for “White Balance  
Correction”, when you turn the <5>  
dial, the “ ” mark on the screen will  
change to “  
” (3 points).  
Turning the dial to the right sets the B/  
A bracketing, and turning it to the left  
sets the M/G bracketing.  
B/A bias ±3 levels  
On the right, “Bracket” indicates the  
bracketing direction and correction amount.  
Pressing the <L> button will cancel  
all the [WB Shift/Bkt.] settings.  
Press <0> to exit the setting and  
return to the menu.  
Bracketing Sequence  
The images will be bracketed in the following sequence: 1. Standard  
white balance, 2. Blue (B) bias, and 3. Amber (A) bias, or 1. Standard  
white balance, 2. Magenta (M) bias, and 3. Green (G) bias.  
During WB bracketing, the maximum burst for continuous shooting will be  
lower and the number of possible shots will also decrease to approx. one-  
third the normal number.  
You can also set white balance correction and AEB together with white  
balance bracketing. If you set AEB in combination with white balance  
bracketing, a total of nine images will be recorded for a single shot.  
Since three images are recorded for one shot, it takes longer to record  
the image on the card.  
During Live View shooting or movie shooting, the white balance icon will blink.  
Bkt” stands for bracketing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
145  
     
3
Auto Correction of Brightness and ContrastK  
If the image comes out dark or the contrast is low, the brightness and  
contrast can be corrected automatically. This function is called Auto  
Lighting Optimizer. The default setting is [Standard]. With JPEG  
images, the correction is applied when the image is captured.  
In Basic Zone modes, [Standard] is set automatically.  
Select [Auto Lighting Optimizer].  
Under the [z2] tab, select [Auto  
1
Lighting Optimizer], then press  
<0>.  
Select the setting.  
Select the desired setting, then press  
2
<0>.  
Take the picture.  
The image will be recorded with the  
3
brightness and contrast corrected if  
necessary.  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [3: Highlight tone priority] is  
set to [1: Enable], [Auto Lighting Optimizer] will be set automatically to  
[Disable].  
If a setting other than [Disable] is set and you use exposure  
compensation or flash exposure compensation to darken the exposure,  
the image may still come out bright. If you want a darker exposure, set  
this function to [Disable].  
Depending on the shooting conditions, noise may increase.  
In step 2, if you press the <B> button and uncheck [X] the [Disable  
during man expo] setting, the Auto Lighting Optimizer can also be set in  
the <a> mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
146  
 
3
Setting Noise ReductionK  
High ISO Speed Noise Reduction  
This function reduces the noise generated in the image. Although noise  
reduction is applied at all ISO speeds, it is particularly effective at high  
ISO speeds. At low ISO speeds, the noise in the darker parts of the  
image (shadow areas) is further reduced. Change the setting to suit the  
noise level.  
Select [High ISO speed NR].  
1
Under the [z3] tab, select [High ISO  
speed NR], then press <0>.  
Set the level.  
Select the desired noise reduction  
2
level, then press <0>.  
[M: Multi Shot Noise Reduction]  
This applies noise reduction with higher image quality than [High].  
For a single photo, four shots are taken continuously and aligned  
and merged automatically into a single JPEG image.  
Take the picture.  
The image will be recorded with noise  
3
reduction applied.  
If you play back or directly print a 1+73 or 1 image with the camera,  
the effect of the high ISO speed noise reduction may look minimal. Check  
the noise reduction effect or print noise-reduced images with Digital Photo  
Professional (EOS software, p.420).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
147  
       
3 Setting Noise ReductionK  
When [Multi Shot Noise Reduction] is Set  
If there is significant misalignment in the image due to camera shake, the  
noise reduction effect may be minimal.  
If you are handholding the camera, keep it steady to prevent camera  
shake. Using a tripod is recommended.  
If you shoot a moving subject, the moving subject may leave  
afterimages.  
The image alignment may not function properly with repetitive patterns  
(lattice, stripes, etc.) or flat, single-tone images.  
If the subject’s brightness changes as the four consecutive shots are  
taken, irregular exposure in the image may result.  
It takes some time to record images to the card since noise reduction is  
applied and the images are merged after shooting. During the  
processing of the images, “buSY” will be displayed in the viewfinder and  
on the LCD panel, and you cannot take another picture until the  
processing is completed.  
1+73 or 1 cannot be selected. AEB and WB bracketing cannot be  
used. [z3: Long exp. noise reduction] cannot be set. If any of these  
has already been selected or set, [Multi Shot Noise Reduction] cannot  
be set.  
The [Distortion] setting will be set automatically to [Disable].  
Flash shooting is not possible. The AF-assist beam will be emitted  
according to the [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)]’s [4: AF-assist beam  
firing] setting.  
You cannot set [Multi Shot Noise Reduction] for bulb exposures.  
If you turn off the power, change the shooting mode to a Basic Zone  
mode, shoot a bulb exposure, or shoot a movie, the setting will  
automatically be changed to [Standard].  
[z3: Dust Delete Data] cannot be set.  
Long Exposure Noise Reduction  
Noise reduction is possible with images exposed for 1 sec. or longer.  
Select [Long exp. noise  
reduction].  
Under the [z3] tab, select [Long  
exp. noise reduction], then press  
<0>.  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
148  
   
3 Setting Noise ReductionK  
Set the desired setting.  
Select the desired setting, then press  
<0>.  
2
[Auto]  
For exposures of 1 sec. or longer, noise reduction is performed  
automatically if noise typical of long exposures is detected. This  
[Auto] setting is effective in most cases.  
[Enable]  
Noise reduction is performed for all exposures of 1 sec. or longer.  
The [Enable] setting may reduce noise that cannot be detected with  
the [Auto] setting.  
Take the picture.  
The image will be recorded with noise  
3
reduction applied.  
With [Auto] and [Enable], the noise reduction process after the picture is  
taken may take the same amount of time as that for the exposure. You  
cannot take another picture until the noise reduction process is  
completed.  
Images taken at ISO 1600 or higher may look grainier with the [Enable]  
setting than with the [Disable] or [Auto] setting.  
With [Auto] and [Enable], if a long exposure is shot with the Live View  
image displayed, “BUSY” will be displayed during the noise reduction  
process. The Live View display will not appear until the noise reduction is  
completed. (You cannot take another picture.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
149  
3
Correction of Lens Peripheral Illumination and Aberrations  
Peripheral light fall-off is a phenomenon that makes the image corners  
look darker due to the lens characteristics. Color fringing along subject  
outlines is called chromatic aberration. And image distortion due to lens  
characteristics is called distortion. These lens aberrations and light fall-  
off can be corrected. By default, Peripheral illumination and Chromatic  
aberration correction are set to [Enable], and Distortion correction is set  
to [Disable].  
If [Cannot correct - no data] is displayed, see “Lens Correction Data”  
Peripheral Illumination Correction  
Select [Lens aberration  
correction].  
Under the [z1] tab, select [Lens  
aberration correction], then press  
<0>.  
1
Select the setting.  
2
Check that [Correction data  
available] is displayed for the  
attached lens.  
Select [Peripheral illumin.], then  
press <0>.  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
Take the picture.  
The image will be recorded with the  
3
peripheral illumination corrected.  
Depending on shooting conditions, noise may appear on the image  
periphery.  
The correction amount applied will be lower than the maximum  
correction amount settable with Digital Photo Professional (EOS  
software, p.420).  
The higher the ISO speed, the lower the correction amount will be.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
150  
     
3 Correction of Lens Peripheral Illumination and Aberrations  
Chromatic Aberration Correction  
Select the setting.  
1
Check that [Correction data  
available] is displayed for the  
attached lens.  
Select [Chromatic aberration], then  
press <0>.  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
Take the picture.  
The image will be recorded with the  
2
chromatic aberration corrected.  
Distortion Correction  
Select the setting.  
1
Check that [Correction data  
available] is displayed for the  
attached lens.  
Select [Distortion], then press <0>.  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
Take the picture.  
The image will be recorded with the  
2
distortion corrected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
151  
     
3 Correction of Lens Peripheral Illumination and Aberrations  
When distortion correction is enabled, the camera records an image  
range narrower than the one seen through the viewfinder. (Image  
periphery will be slightly cropped and resolution slightly lowered.)  
Distortion correction will be reflected in the captured image, but not in the  
viewfinder or Live View image during shooting.  
If you set [Distortion] to [Enable], the continuous shooting speed will  
decrease.  
Distortion correction cannot be set in the <F> or <G> mode, when  
shooting a movie, or when Multi Shot Noise Reduction is set.  
Dust Delete Data (p.287) will not be appended to images recorded with  
distortion correction enabled.  
Lens Correction Data  
The camera already contains data for lens peripheral illumination  
correction, chromatic aberration correction, and distortion correction for  
approx. 30 lenses. If you select [Enable], the peripheral illumination  
correction, chromatic aberration correction, and distortion correction will  
be applied automatically for any lens whose correction data is  
registered in the camera.  
With EOS Utility (EOS software), you can check which lenses have their  
correction data registered in the camera. You can also register the  
correction data for unregistered lenses. For details, refer to the EOS  
For lenses incorporating the correction data, it is not necessary to  
register the correction data to the camera.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
152  
 
3 Correction of Lens Peripheral Illumination and Aberrations  
Cautions for Lens Correction  
Peripheral illumination correction, chromatic aberration correction, and  
distortion correction cannot be applied to JPEG images already taken.  
When using a non-Canon lens, setting the corrections to [Disable] is  
recommended, even if [Correction data available] is displayed.  
If you use the magnified view during Live View shooting, the peripheral  
illumination correction and chromatic aberration correction will not be  
reflected in the image displayed on the screen.  
The correction amount will be less if the lens used does not have  
distance information.  
Notes for Lens Correction  
If the effect of the correction is not visible, magnify the image after  
shooting and check it again.  
Corrections can be applied even when an Extender or Life-size  
Converter is attached.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
153  
3 Reducing FlickerK  
If you shoot an image with a fast shutter speed under a light source  
such as fluorescent light, the blinking of the light source causes flicker  
and the image may be vertically unevenly exposed. If continuous  
shooting is used under these conditions, uneven exposures or colors  
across the images may result.  
With anti-flicker shooting, the camera detects the frequency of the light  
source’s blinking and takes the picture when the flicker causes less  
effect on exposure or color.  
Select [Anti-flicker shoot.].  
1
Under the [z3] tab, select [Anti-  
flicker shoot.], then press <0>.  
Select [Enable].  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
2
3
Take the picture.  
The image will be taken with reduced  
unevenness of exposure or color  
caused by the flicker.  
When [Enable] is set and you shoot under a flickering light source, the  
shutter-release time lag may become slightly longer. Also, the  
continuous shooting speed may become slightly slower, and the  
shooting interval may become irregular.  
This function does not work with Live View shooting and movie shooting.  
In the <d> or <f> mode, if the shutter speed changes during  
continuous shooting or if you shoot multiple shots of the same scene at  
different shutter speeds, the color tone may be inconsistent. To avoid  
inconsistent color tones, use the <s> or <a> mode at a fixed shutter  
speed.  
The color tone of images shot when [Anti-flicker shoot.] is set to  
[Enable] may look different from when [Disable] is set.  
Flicker at a frequency other than 100 Hz or 120 Hz cannot be detected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
154  
   
3 Reducing FlickerK  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if you set [9: Mirror lockup] to  
[1: Enable], the [Anti-flicker shoot.] setting will automatically switch to  
[Disable].  
If the subject is against a dark background or if there is a bright light in  
the image, flicker may not be detected.  
Under certain special types of lighting, the camera may not be able to  
reduce the effects of the flicker even when <G> is displayed.  
Depending on the light source, flicker may not be detected properly.  
If you recompose a shot, <G> may appear and disappear  
intermittently.  
Depending on the light sources or shooting conditions, expected result  
may not be obtained even if you use this function.  
Taking test shots is recommended.  
If <G> is not displayed in the viewfinder, under [52: Viewfinder  
display], set [Flicker detection] to [Show] (p.72). When the camera  
reduces the effects of the flicker when you shoot, <G> will light.  
Under a light source which does not flicker, or if no flicker is detected,  
<G> will not be displayed.  
If [Flicker detection] is set to [Show] and [Anti-flicker shoot.] is set to  
[Disable], metering under a flickering light source will cause  
<G> to blink in the viewfinder as a warning. Setting [Enable]  
before shooting is recommended.  
In Basic Zone modes, <G> will not be displayed, but the effects  
of flicker will be reduced when you shoot.  
Anti-flicker shooting also works with flash. However, the expected result  
may not be obtained during wireless flash shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
155  
3
Setting the Color Reproduction RangeK  
The range of reproducible colors is called the color space. With this  
camera, you can set the color space for captured images to sRGB or  
Adobe RGB. For normal shooting, sRGB is recommended.  
In Basic Zone modes, sRGB is set automatically.  
Select [Color space].  
1
Under the [z2] tab, select [Color  
space], then press <0>.  
Set the desired color space.  
2
Select [sRGB] or [Adobe RGB], then  
press <0>.  
Adobe RGB  
This color space is mainly used for commercial printing and other  
industrial uses. This setting is not recommended if you are not familiar  
with image processing, Adobe RGB, and Design rule for Camera File  
System 2.0 (Exif 2.21 or higher). The image will look very subdued in a  
sRGB computer environment and with printers not compatible with  
Design rule for Camera File System 2.0 (Exif 2.21 or higher). Post-  
processing of the image with computer software will therefore be  
required.  
If the captured still photo was shot in the Adobe RGB color space, the  
first character in the file name will be an underscore “_”.  
The ICC profile is not appended. Refer to explanations about the ICC  
profile in the Digital Photo Professional Instruction Manual (p.422).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
156  
         
5
Advanced Operations  
In Creative Zone modes, you  
can change various settings of  
the camera as you desire to  
obtain a wide variety of  
shooting results, by selecting  
the shutter speed and/or  
aperture, adjusting the  
exposure as you prefer, etc.  
The  
J
icon at the upper right of the page title indicates that  
the function is available only in Creative Zone modes.  
After you press the shutter button halfway and let go, the  
exposure values will remain displayed in the viewfinder and  
on the LCD panel for 4 sec. (0) by the operation of  
metering timer.  
For the functions settable in each shooting mode, see page  
Set the <R> switch to the left.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
157  
 
d: Program AE  
The camera automatically sets the shutter speed and aperture to suit  
the subject’s brightness. This is called Program AE.  
* <d> stands for Program.  
* AE stands for Auto Exposure.  
Set the Mode Dial to <d>.  
1
Focus on the subject.  
2
Look through the viewfinder and aim  
the AF point over the subject. Then  
press the shutter button halfway.  
When focus is achieved, the focus  
indicator <o> on the viewfinder’s  
bottom right will light up (when in  
One-Shot AF mode).  
The shutter speed and aperture will  
be set automatically and displayed in  
the viewfinder and on the LCD panel.  
Check the display.  
A standard exposure will be obtained  
3
as long as the shutter speed and  
aperture display do not blink.  
Take the picture.  
4
Compose the shot and press the  
shutter button completely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
158  
   
d: Program AE  
Shooting Tips  
Change the ISO speed. Use the built-in flash.  
To match the subject and ambient lighting level, you can change the  
ISO speed (p.132) or use the built-in flash (p.176). In the <d>  
mode, the built-in flash will not fire automatically. Therefore, press  
the <I> (flash) button to raise the built-in flash when indoors or  
shooting in low light.  
Change the program using Program shift.  
After pressing the shutter button halfway, turn the <6> dial to  
change the shutter speed and aperture setting combination  
(program). Program shift is canceled automatically after the picture  
is taken. Program shift is not possible with flash.  
If the “30"” shutter speed and the lowest f/number  
blink, it indicates underexposure. Increase the ISO  
speed or use flash.  
If the “4000” shutter speed and the highest f/number  
blink, it indicates overexposure. Decrease the ISO  
speed.  
Differences Between <d> and <A> (Scene Intelligent Auto)  
In the <A> mode, many functions, such as the AF operation and metering  
mode, are set automatically to prevent spoiled shots. The functions you can  
set are limited. With <d> mode, only the shutter speed and aperture are set  
automatically. You can freely set the AF operation, metering mode, and  
other functions (p.370).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
159  
 
s
:
Conveying the Subject’s Movement  
You can either freeze the action or create motion blur with the <s>  
(Shutter-priority AE) mode on the Mode Dial.  
* <s> stands for Time value.  
Blurred motion  
Frozen action  
(Slow shutter speed: 1/30 sec.)  
(Fast shutter speed: 1/2000 sec.)  
Set the Mode Dial to <s>.  
1
Set the desired shutter speed.  
2
While looking at the LCD panel or in  
the viewfinder, turn the <6> dial.  
See “Shooting Tips” on the next page  
for advice on setting the shutter  
speed.  
Turning the <6> dial to the right  
sets a faster shutter speed, and  
turning it to the left sets a slower one.  
Take the picture.  
3
When you focus and press the  
shutter button completely, the picture  
will be taken at the selected shutter  
speed.  
Shutter Speed Display  
The LCD monitor displays the shutter speed as a fraction. However, the  
LCD panel and the viewfinder display only the denominator. “0"5” indicates  
0.5 sec. and “15"” is 15 sec.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
160  
     
s: Conveying the Subject’s Movement  
Shooting Tips  
To freeze the motion of a fast-moving subject  
Use a fast shutter speed such as 1/4000 sec. to 1/500 sec.  
To blur a running child or animal and convey an impression of  
motion  
Use a medium shutter speed such as 1/250 sec. to 1/30 sec. Follow  
the moving subject through the viewfinder and press the shutter  
button to take the picture. If you use a telephoto lens, hold it steady  
to prevent camera shake.  
To blur a flowing river or fountain  
Use a slow shutter speed of 1/30 sec. or slower. Use a tripod to  
prevent hand-held camera shake.  
Set the shutter speed so that the aperture display does not  
blink.  
If you press the shutter button halfway and change  
the shutter speed while the aperture is displayed,  
the aperture display will also change to maintain the  
same exposure (amount of light reaching the image  
sensor). If you exceed the adjustable aperture  
range, the aperture display will blink to indicate that  
the standard exposure cannot be obtained.  
If the exposure will be too dark, the maximum aperture (lowest f/  
number) will blink. If this happens, turn the <6> dial to the left to  
set a slower shutter speed or increase the ISO speed.  
If the exposure will be too bright, the minimum aperture (highest f/  
number) will blink. If this happens, turn the <6> dial to the right to  
set a faster shutter speed or decrease the ISO speed.  
D Using the Built-in Flash  
To obtain a correct flash exposure, the flash output will be set  
automatically (autoflash exposure) to match the automatically-set  
aperture. The shutter speed can be set from 1/200 sec. to 30 sec.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
161  
f
:
Changing the Depth of Field  
To blur the background or to make everything near and far look sharp,  
set the Mode Dial to <f> (Aperture-priority AE) to adjust the depth of  
field (range of acceptable focus).  
* <f> stands for Aperture value, which is the size of the diaphragm hole inside the lens.  
Blurred background  
(With a low aperture f/number: f/5.6)  
Sharp foreground and background  
(With a high aperture f/number: f/32)  
Set the Mode Dial to <f>.  
1
Set the desired aperture.  
While looking at the LCD panel or  
viewfinder, turn the <6> dial.  
2
The higher the f/number, the wider the depth  
of field where sharper focus is obtained in  
both the foreground and background.  
Turning the <6> dial to the right will set  
a higher f/number (smaller aperture  
opening), and turning it to the left will set a  
lower f/number (larger aperture opening).  
Take the picture.  
3
Focus and press the shutter button  
completely. The picture will be taken  
with the selected aperture.  
Aperture Display  
The higher the f/number, the smaller the aperture opening will be. The  
f/number displayed will differ depending on the lens. If no lens is attached to  
the camera, “00” will be displayed for the aperture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
162  
   
f: Changing the Depth of Field  
Shooting Tips  
When using an aperture with a high f/number or shooting in low  
light scenes, note that camera shake can occur.  
A higher aperture f/number will make the shutter speed slower.  
Under low light, the shutter speed can be as long as 30 sec. In such  
cases, increase the ISO speed and hold the camera steady or use a  
tripod.  
The depth of field depends not only on the aperture, but also on  
the lens and on the subject distance.  
Since wide-angle lenses have a wide depth of field (range of  
acceptable focus in front of and behind the point of focus), you need  
not set a high aperture f/number to obtain a sharp picture from the  
foreground to the background. On the other hand, a telephoto lens  
has a narrow depth of field.  
And the closer the subject, the narrower the depth of field. A farther  
subject will have a wider depth of field.  
Set the aperture so that the shutter speed display does not blink.  
If you press the shutter button halfway and change  
the aperture while the shutter speed is displayed,  
the shutter speed display will also change to  
maintain the same exposure (amount of light  
reaching the image sensor). If you exceed the  
adjustable shutter speed range, the shutter speed  
display will blink to indicate that the standard  
exposure cannot be obtained.  
If the picture will be too dark, the “30"” (30 sec.) shutter speed  
display will blink. If this happens, turn the <6> dial to the left to set  
a lower f/number or increase the ISO speed.  
If the picture will be too bright, the “4000” (1/4000 sec.) shutter  
speed display will blink. If this happens, turn the <6> dial to the  
right to set a higher f/number or decrease the ISO speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
163  
f: Changing the Depth of Field  
D Using the Built-in Flash  
To obtain a correct flash exposure, the flash output will be set  
automatically to match the set aperture (autoflash exposure). The  
shutter speed will be set automatically between 1/200 sec. - 30 sec. to  
suit the scene’s brightness.  
In low light, the main subject is exposed with the auto flash metering,  
and the background is exposed with a slow shutter speed set  
automatically. Both the subject and background look properly exposed  
with a touch of atmosphere (automatic slow-speed flash sync). If you  
are handholding the camera, keep it steady to prevent camera shake.  
Using a tripod is recommended.  
To prevent a slow shutter speed, under [z1: Flash control], set  
[Flash sync. speed in Av mode] to [1/200-1/60sec. auto] or [1/200  
sec. (fixed)] (p.184).  
Depth-of-Field PreviewK  
The aperture opening (diaphragm) changes only at the moment when  
the picture is taken. Otherwise, the aperture remains fully open.  
Therefore, when you look at the scene through the viewfinder or on the  
LCD monitor, the depth of field will look narrow.  
Press the depth-of-field preview button  
to stop down the lens to the current  
aperture setting, and check the depth of  
field (range of acceptable focus).  
While looking at the Live View image (p.202) and holding down the depth-of-  
field preview button, you can see how the range of acceptable focus will  
change as you adjust the aperture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
164  
     
a
:
Manual Exposure  
You can set both the shutter speed and aperture manually as desired.  
While referring to the exposure level indicator in the viewfinder, you can  
set the exposure as desired. This method is called manual exposure.  
* <a> stands for Manual.  
Set the Mode Dial to <a>.  
1
Set the ISO speed (p.132).  
2
Set the shutter speed and aperture.  
3
To set the shutter speed, turn the  
<6> dial.  
To set the aperture, turn the <5> dial.  
If it cannot be set, set the <R>  
switch to the left, then turn the <6>  
or <5> dial.  
<6> <5>  
Standard exposure index  
Focus on the subject.  
Press the shutter button halfway.  
4
The exposure setting will be displayed  
in the viewfinder and on the LCD panel.  
Exposure level mark  
The exposure level mark <h> indicates  
how far the current exposure level is  
from the standard exposure level.  
Set the exposure and take the picture.  
Check the exposure level indicator and set the desired shutter  
5
speed and aperture.  
If the exposure level exceeds  
the end of the exposure level indicator will display <  
viewfinder and on the LCD panel. (On the LCD monitor, if the  
exposure level exceeds 3 stops, < > or < > will be displayed.)  
±
2 stops from the standard exposure,  
I
> or < > in the  
J
±
I
J
If ISO Auto is set, the ISO speed setting will change to suit the shutter speed  
and aperture in order to obtain a standard exposure. Therefore, you may not  
obtain the desired exposure effect.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
165  
     
a: Manual Exposure  
Under [z2: Auto Lighting Optimizer], if the checkmark <X> for  
[Disable during man expo] is removed, the Auto Lighting Optimizer can  
be set even in the <a> mode (p.146).  
When ISO Auto is set, you can press the <A> button to lock the ISO speed.  
If you press the <A> button and recompose the shot, you can see the  
exposure level difference on the exposure level indicator compared to  
when the <A> button was pressed.  
I Using the Built-in Flash  
To obtain a correct flash exposure, the flash output will be set  
automatically (autoflash exposure) to match the manually-set aperture.  
The shutter speed can be set from 1/200 sec. to 30 sec or bulb.  
BULB: Bulb Exposures  
A bulb exposure keeps the shutter open for  
as long as you hold down the shutter button.  
It can be used to shoot fireworks and other  
subjects requiring long exposures.  
In step 3 on the preceding page, turn the  
<6> dial to the left to set <BULB>.  
The elapsed exposure time will be  
displayed on the LCD panel.  
Elapsed exposure time  
Do not point the camera toward an intense light source, such as the sun  
or an intense artificial light source. Doing so may damage the image  
sensor or the camera’s internal components.  
Since bulb exposures produce more noise than usual, the image may  
look slightly grainy.  
You can reduce the noise due to long exposures by setting [z3: Long  
exp. noise reduction] to [Auto] or [Enable] (p.148).  
For bulb exposures, using a tripod and a remote switch (sold separately,  
p.367) is recommended.  
You can also use a remote controller (sold separately, p.366) for bulb  
shooting. When you press the remote controller’s transmit button, the  
bulb exposure will start immediately or 2 sec. later. Press the button  
again to stop the bulb exposure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
166  
   
q Changing the Metering ModeK  
Four methods (metering modes) to measure the subject’s brightness  
are provided. Normally, evaluative metering is recommended.  
In Basic Zone modes, metering mode is set automatically.  
Select [Metering mode].  
1
Under the [z2] tab, select [Metering  
mode], then press <0>.  
Set the metering mode.  
2
Select the desired metering mode,  
then press <0>.  
q Evaluative metering  
General-purpose metering mode suited even  
for backlit subjects. The camera sets the  
exposure automatically to suit the scene.  
w Partial metering  
Effective where there are much brighter lights  
around the subject due to backlight, etc. The  
gray area in the left figure is where the  
brightness is metered to obtain the standard  
exposure.  
r Spot metering  
Effective when metering a specific part of the  
subject or scene. The gray area in the left figure  
is where the brightness is metered to obtain the  
standard exposure. This metering mode is for  
advanced users.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
167  
               
q Changing the Metering ModeK  
e Center-weighted average metering  
The brightness is metered at the image center  
and then averaged for the entire scene. This  
metering mode is for advanced users.  
With q (Evaluative metering), the exposure setting will be locked when you  
press the shutter button halfway and focus is achieved. In the w (Partial  
metering), r (Spot metering), and e (Center-weighted average metering)  
modes, the exposure is set at the moment the picture is taken. (Pressing the  
shutter button halfway does not lock the exposure.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
168  
 
Setting Exposure CompensationK  
Set exposure compensation if the exposure (without flash) does not  
come out as desired. This feature can be used in Creative Zone modes  
(except <a>). You can set the exposure compensation up to ±5 stops  
in 1/3-stop increments.  
Check the exposure level indicator.  
1
Press the shutter button halfway (  
0)  
and check the exposure level indicator.  
Increased exposure  
for a brighter image  
Set the compensation amount.  
2
While looking in the viewfinder or at  
the LCD panel, turn the <5> dial.  
If it cannot be set, set the <R>  
switch to the left, then turn the <5>  
dial.  
Decreased exposure  
for a darker image  
Take the picture.  
3
To cancel the exposure  
compensation, set the exposure  
compensation amount back to <E>.  
If [z2: Auto Lighting Optimizer] (p.146) is set to any setting other than  
[Disable], the image may still look bright even if a decreased exposure  
compensation for a darker image is set.  
The exposure compensation amount will remain in effect even after you  
set the power switch to <2>.  
After setting the exposure compensation amount, you can prevent the  
exposure compensation amount from changing accidentally by setting  
the <R> switch to the right.  
The exposure compensation amount displayed in the viewfinder and on  
the LCD panel goes up to only ±2 stops. If the exposure compensation  
amount exceeds ±2 stops, the end of the exposure level indicator will  
display <I> or <J>.  
If you want to set exposure compensation exceeding ±2 stops, setting it  
with [z2: Expo.comp./AEB] (p.170) or with the Quick Control screen  
(p.57) is recommended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
169  
 
3 Auto Exposure BracketingK  
This feature takes exposure compensation a step further by varying the  
exposure automatically (up to ±2 stops in 1/3-stop increments) with  
three shots as shown below. You can then choose the best exposure.  
This is called AEB (Auto Exposure Bracketing).  
Darker exposure  
Brighter exposure  
Standard exposure  
(Decreased exposure)  
(Increased exposure)  
Select [Expo.comp./AEB].  
Under the [z2] tab, select  
1
[Expo.comp./AEB], then press <0>.  
Set the AEB range.  
Turn the <6> dial to set the AEB  
range.  
2
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to set the  
exposure compensation amount. If  
AEB is combined with exposure  
compensation, AEB will be applied  
centering on level of exposure  
compensation.  
AEB range  
Press <0> to set it.  
When you press the <M> button  
to exit the menu, the AEB range will  
be displayed on the LCD panel.  
Take the picture.  
3
Focus and press the shutter button  
completely. The three bracketed  
shots will be taken in this sequence:  
standard exposure, decreased  
exposure, and increased exposure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
170  
         
3 Auto Exposure BracketingK  
Canceling AEB  
Follow steps 1 and 2 to turn off the AEB range display (set to 0).  
The AEB setting will also be canceled automatically if the power  
switch is set to <2>, flash recycling is completed, etc.  
Shooting Tips  
Using AEB with continuous shooting  
If the drive mode is set to <i> or <M> (p.122) and you press the  
shutter button completely, the three bracketed shots will be taken  
continuously in this sequence: standard exposure, decreased  
exposure, and increased exposure. The shooting will then stop  
automatically.  
Using AEB with single shooting (u/B)  
Press the shutter button three times to take the three bracketed  
shots. The three bracketed shots will be taken in the following  
sequence: standard exposure, decreased exposure, and increased  
exposure.  
Using AEB with the self-timer or a remote controller (sold  
separately)  
With the self-timer or a remote control shooting (<Q> or <l>),  
you can take three continuous shots after a 10-sec. or 2-sec. delay.  
With <q> (p.124) set, the number of continuous shots will be three  
times the number set.  
During AEB, <A> in the viewfinder and AEB range will blink.  
AEB cannot be used with flash, [Multi Shot Noise Reduction], Creative  
filters, or bulb exposures.  
If [z2: Auto Lighting Optimizer] (p.146) is set to any setting other  
than [Disable], the effect of AEB may be reduced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
171  
A Locking the ExposureK  
You can lock the exposure when the area of focus is to be different from  
the exposure metering area or when you want to take multiple shots at  
the same exposure setting. Press the <A> button to lock the exposure,  
then recompose and take the picture. This is called AE lock. It is  
effective for backlit subjects, etc.  
Focus on the subject.  
1
Press the shutter button halfway.  
The exposure setting will be  
displayed.  
Press the <A> button. (0)  
2
The <A> icon lights up in the  
viewfinder to indicate that the  
exposure setting is locked (AE lock).  
Each time you press the <A> button,  
the current autoexposure setting is  
locked.  
Recompose and take the picture.  
3
If you want to maintain the AE lock  
while taking more shots, hold down  
the <A> button and press the shutter  
button to take another shot.  
AE Lock Effects  
AF Point Selection Method (p.116)  
Metering Mode  
(p.167)  
Automatic Selection  
Manual Selection  
AE lock is applied at the AF  
point that achieved focus.  
AE lock is applied at the  
selected AF point.  
q*  
AE lock is applied to the center AF point.  
wre  
* When the lens’s focus mode switch is set to <MF>, AE lock is applied to the  
center AF point.  
AE lock is not possible with bulb exposures.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
172  
       
Mirror Lockup to Reduce Camera ShakeK  
Camera vibrations caused by the mirror’s reflex action is called “mirror  
shock”. Mirror lockup can reduce the blur caused by camera vibrations.  
This is useful especially when you are using a super telephoto lens or  
shooting closeups (macro photography).  
Mirror lockup is enabled by setting [9: Mirror lockup] to [1: Enable]  
in [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)] (p.356).  
1 Focus on the subject, then press the shutter button  
completely.  
The mirror will swing up.  
2 Press the shutter button completely again.  
The picture is taken and the mirror goes back down.  
After taking the picture, set [9: Mirror lockup] to [0: Disable].  
Shooting Tips  
Using the self-timer <Q>, <l> with mirror lockup  
When you press the shutter button completely, the mirror locks up.  
The picture will be then taken 10 sec. or 2 sec. later.  
Remote control shooting  
Since you do not touch the camera when the picture is taken, remote  
control shooting together with mirror lockup can further reduce  
camera shake (p.366). With Remote Controller RC-6 (sold  
separately) set to a 2-sec. delay, press the transmit button to lock up  
the mirror, and the picture will be taken 2 sec. after the mirror lockup.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
173  
     
Mirror Lockup to Reduce Camera ShakeK  
Do not point the camera toward an intense light source, such as the sun  
or an intense artificial light source. Doing so may damage the image  
sensor or the camera’s internal components.  
In very bright light, such as at the beach or a ski slope on a sunny day,  
take the picture promptly after mirror lockup is stabilized.  
If you use the self-timer and bulb exposure in combination with a mirror  
lockup, keep pressing the shutter button completely (self-timer delay  
time + bulb exposure time). If you let go of the shutter button during the  
self-timer countdown, there will be a shutter-release sound, but no  
picture will be taken.  
During mirror lockup, shooting function settings and menu operations,  
etc. are disabled.  
If you use flash, the red-eye reduction lamp will not light up (p.177).  
Even if you set the drive mode to <i>, <M>, or <q>, the camera  
will still shoot in single shooting mode.  
When [z3: High ISO speed NR] is set to [Multi Shot Noise  
Reduction], four continuous shots will be taken for the single picture  
regardless of the [9: Mirror lockup] setting.  
If 30 sec. elapse after the mirror is locked up, it will go back down  
automatically. Pressing the shutter button completely again locks up the  
mirror again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
174  
6
Flash Photography  
This chapter explains how to shoot with built-in flash  
and external Speedlites (EX-series, sold separately),  
how to set flash settings with the camera’s menu  
screen, and how to use the built-in flash for wireless  
flash shooting.  
Flash cannot be used with movie shooting. It will not fire.  
AEB cannot be used with flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
175  
 
D Using the Built-in Flash  
In indoor, low light, or backlit conditions in daylight, just raise the built-in  
flash and press the shutter button to take flash pictures. In the <d>  
mode, the shutter speed (1/60 sec. - 1/200 sec.) will be set  
automatically to prevent camera shake.  
Press the <D> button.  
1
In Creative Zone modes, you can  
press the <D> button anytime to take  
flash pictures.  
While the flash is recycling, “buSY” is  
displayed in the viewfinder and on the  
LCD panel.  
Press the shutter button halfway.  
2
In the bottom left of the viewfinder,  
check that the <D> icon is lit.  
Take the picture.  
When focus is achieved and you  
3
press the shutter button completely,  
the flash will fire for the picture.  
Effective Range of Built-in Flash  
(Approx. in meters/feet)  
EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM, EF-S18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM,  
EF-S55-250mm f/4-5.6 IS STM, EF-S18-200mm f/3.5-5.6 IS  
ISO Speed  
Wide Angle  
Telephoto  
f/5.6  
f/3.5  
f/4  
ISO 100  
ISO 400  
ISO 1600  
ISO 6400  
1 - 3.4 / 3.3 - 11.2  
1 - 6.9 / 3.3 - 22.6  
1 - 3 / 3.3 - 9.8  
1 - 6 / 3.3 - 19.7  
1.5 - 12 / 4.9 - 39.4  
3 - 24 / 9.8 - 78.7  
1 - 2.1 / 3.3 - 6.9  
1 - 4.3 / 3.3 - 14.1  
1.1 - 8.6 / 3.6 - 28.2  
2.1 - 17.1 / 6.9 - 56.1  
1.7 - 13.7 / 5.6 - 44.9  
3.4 - 27.4 / 11.2 - 89.9  
* When a high ISO speed is set and focusing distance is long, appropriate  
exposure may not be obtained depending on the subject conditions, etc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
176  
     
D Using the Built-in Flash  
Shooting Tips  
In bright light, decrease the ISO speed.  
If the exposure setting in the viewfinder blinks, decrease the ISO  
speed.  
Detach the lens hood. Do not get too close to the subject.  
If the lens has a hood attached or you are too close to the subject,  
the bottom of the picture may look dark due to the obstructed flash.  
For important shots, check the image on the LCD monitor to make  
sure the flash exposure looks natural (not dark at the bottom).  
3 Red-eye Reduction  
Using the red-eye reduction lamp before taking a flash picture can  
reduce red eye.  
Red-eye reduction will function in any shooting mode except <7>,  
<3>, <5>, <x>, or <G>.  
Under the [z1] tab, select [Red-eye  
reduc.], then press <0>.  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
For flash photography, when you  
press the shutter button halfway, the  
red-eye reduction lamp will light up.  
Then when you press the shutter  
button completely, the picture will be  
taken.  
The red-eye reduction feature is more effective when the subject looks at  
the red-eye reduction lamp, when the room is well lit, or when you are  
close to the subject.  
When you press the shutter button halfway, the  
scale display on the bottom of the viewfinder will  
shrink and turn off. For best results, take the picture  
after this scale display turns off.  
The effectiveness of red-eye reduction varies depending on the  
individual subject.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
177  
 
D Using the Built-in Flash  
y Flash Exposure CompensationK  
Set flash exposure compensation if the flash exposure of the subject  
does not come out as desired. You can set the exposure compensation  
up to ±2 stops in 1/3-stop increments.  
Press the <Q> button (7).  
1
The Quick Control screen will appear  
(p.57).  
Select [y].  
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
2
keys to select [y*].  
[Flash exposure comp.] will be  
displayed at the bottom.  
Set the exposure compensation  
3 amount.  
If the exposure is too dark, turn the  
<6> dial to the right (for increased  
exposure).  
If the exposure is too bright, turn the  
<6> dial to the left (for decreased  
exposure).  
When you press the shutter button halfway, the <y> icon will  
appear in the viewfinder.  
After taking the picture, cancel the flash exposure  
compensation by setting it back to 0.  
If [z2: Auto Lighting Optimizer] (p.146) is set to any setting other  
than [Disable], the image may still look bright even if a decreased flash  
exposure compensation is set.  
If flash exposure compensation is set with an external Speedlite (sold  
separately, p.181), you cannot set the flash exposure compensation with the  
camera (Quick Control or External flash function settings). If it is set with both  
the camera and Speedlite, the Speedlite’s setting overrides the camera’s.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
178  
     
D Using the Built-in Flash  
The exposure compensation amount will remain in effect even after you  
set the power switch to <2>.  
You can also set flash exposure compensation with [Built-in flash  
settings] in [z1: Flash control] (p.186).  
A Locking the Flash Exposure (FE lock)K  
If the subject is on the side of the frame and you use flash, the subject may  
turn out to be too bright or dark depending on the background, etc. Use FE  
lock in such a case. After setting the proper flash exposure for the subject,  
you can recompose (put the subject toward the side) and shoot. This  
feature can also be used with a Canon EX-series Speedlite.  
* FE stands for Flash Exposure.  
Press the <D> button.  
1
The built-in flash will be raised.  
Press the shutter button halfway and  
look in the viewfinder to check that  
the <D> icon is lit.  
Focus on the subject.  
2
3
Press the <A> button. (8)  
Aim the viewfinder center over the  
subject where you want to lock the flash  
exposure, then press the <A> button.  
The flash will fire a preflash and the  
required flash output is calculated  
and retained in memory.  
In the viewfinder, “FEL” is displayed  
for a moment and <d> will light up.  
Each time you press the <A> button, a preflash is fired and the  
required flash output is calculated and retained in memory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
179  
     
D Using the Built-in Flash  
Take the picture.  
4
Compose the shot and press the  
shutter button completely.  
The flash is fired, and the picture is  
taken.  
If the subject is too far away and beyond the effective range of the flash,  
the <D> icon will blink. Move closer to the subject and repeat steps 2 to 4  
FE lock is not possible during Live View shooting.  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
180  
D Using an External Speedlite  
EOS-dedicated, EX-series Speedlites  
Basically operates like a built-in flash for easy operation.  
When an EX-series Speedlite (sold separately) is attached to the  
camera, almost all the autoflash control is done by the camera. In other  
words, it is like a high-output flash attached externally in place of the  
built-in flash.  
For detailed instructions, refer to the EX-series Speedlite’s  
instruction manual. This camera is a Type-A camera that can use all  
the features of EX-series Speedlites.  
Shoe-mount Speedlites  
Macro Lites  
With an EX-series Speedlite not compatible with flash function settings  
(p.183), only [Flash exp. comp] and [E-TTL II meter.] can be set for  
[External flash func. setting]. ([Shutter sync.] can also be set with  
certain EX-series Speedlites.)  
If flash exposure compensation is set with the external Speedlite, the  
flash exposure compensation icon displayed on the camera’s LCD  
monitor will change from y to 0.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
181  
   
D Using an External Speedlite  
Canon Speedlites Other Than the EX-series  
With an EZ/E/EG/ML/TL-series Speedlite set in TTL or A-TTL  
autoflash mode, the flash can be fired at full output only.  
Set the camera’s shooting mode to <a> (manual exposure) or  
<f> (aperture-priority AE) and adjust the aperture setting before  
shooting.  
When using a Speedlite that has manual flash mode, shoot in the  
manual flash mode.  
Using Non-Canon Flash Units  
Sync Speed  
The camera can synchronize with compact, non-Canon flash units at  
1/200 sec. or slower shutter speeds. Use a sync speed slower than  
1/200 sec.  
Be sure to test the flash unit beforehand to make sure it synchronizes  
properly with the camera.  
Cautions for Live View Shooting  
A non-Canon flash will not fire during Live View shooting.  
If the camera is used with a flash unit or flash accessory dedicated to  
another camera brand, the camera may not operate properly and  
malfunction may result.  
Do not attach a high-voltage flash unit on the camera’s hot shoe. It may  
not fire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
182  
     
3 Setting the FlashK  
With the built-in flash or an EX-series, external Speedlite compatible  
with flash function settings, you can use the camera’s menu to set flash  
functions and the external Speedlite’s Custom Functions.  
If you use an external Speedlite, attach the Speedlite to the camera  
and turn on the Speedlite before setting the flash functions. For  
details on the external Speedlite’s flash functions, refer to the  
Speedlite’s instruction manual.  
Select [Flash control].  
Under the [z1] tab, select [Flash  
control], then press <0>.  
The Flash control screen will appear.  
[Flash firing]  
Normally, set this to [Enable].  
If [Disable] is set, neither the built-  
in flash nor the external Speedlite  
will fire. This is useful when you want  
to use only the flash’s AF-assist  
beam.  
[E-TTL II meter.]  
For normal flash exposures, set this  
to [Evaluative].  
[Average] is for advanced users. As  
with an external Speedlite, the  
metering area is averaged. Flash  
exposure compensation may be  
necessary.  
Even if [Flash firing] is set to [Disable], if focus is difficult to achieve in low  
light, the flash may still fire a series of flashes (AF-assist beam, p.113).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
183  
     
3 Setting the FlashK  
[Flash sync. speed in Av mode]  
You can set the flash-sync speed for  
flash photography in the aperture-priority  
AE (f) mode.  
N: Auto  
The flash sync speed is set automatically within a range of 1/200  
sec. to 30 sec. to suit the scene’s brightness. High-speed sync is  
also possible.  
V: 1/200-1/60 sec. auto  
Prevents a slow shutter speed from being set in low-light conditions.  
It is effective for preventing subject blur and camera shake.  
However, while the subject will be properly exposed with the flash,  
the background may come out dark.  
W: 1/200 sec. (fixed)  
The flash-sync speed is fixed at 1/200 sec. This more effectively  
prevents subject blur and camera shake than with [1/200-1/60sec.  
auto]. However, in low light, the subject’s background will come out  
darker than with [1/200-1/60sec. auto].  
If [1/200-1/60sec. auto] or [1/200 sec. (fixed)] is set, high-speed sync is not  
possible in the <f> mode with the external Speedlite.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
184  
 
3 Setting the FlashK  
Displaying the Flash Function Setting Screen Directly  
When you use the built-in flash or an  
external, EX-series Speedlite compatible  
with flash function settings, you can  
press the <D> button to directly display  
the [Built-in flash settings] or [External  
flash func. setting] screen without first  
displaying the menu screen.  
With built-in flash  
Press the <D> button twice.  
The built-in flash will be raised.  
Press the button again to display the  
[Built-in flash settings] screen.  
With external Speedlite  
Press the <D> button.  
With the external Speedlite turned on,  
press the <D> button to display the  
[External flash func. setting]  
screen.  
When you press the <D> button to display the flash function setting  
screen, you cannot set [Flash firing], [E-TTL II meter.], [Flash sync.  
speed in Av mode], or [External flash C.Fn setting]. Set these  
functions with [z1: Flash control] instead.  
If [Flash firing] is set to [Disable] and you press the <D> button, the  
[z1: Flash control] screen will appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
185  
3 Setting the FlashK  
[Built-in flash settings] and [External flash func. setting]  
You can set the functions in the table below. The functions displayed under  
[
External flash func. setting] vary depending on the Speedlite model.  
Select [Built-in flash settings] or  
[External flash func. setting].  
The flash function setting screen will  
be displayed. With [Built-in flash  
settings], only the highlighted  
functions can be selected and set.  
Flash mode  
Sample screen  
Wireless functions  
Flash zoom  
(Flash coverage)  
FEB  
Flash exposure  
compensation  
Shutter  
synchronization  
[Built-in flash settings]  
[External flash func. setting]  
Main Functions for [Built-in flash settings] and [External flash func. settings]  
[Built-in flash settings]  
[External  
Easy  
Custom  
Function  
flash func.  
setting]  
Page  
Normal  
Firing  
Wireless Wireless  
(p.195)  
Flash mode  
Shutter  
synchronization  
k
k
k
k
k
FEB*  
Wireless functions  
k
k
k
k
k
Flash exposure  
compensation  
Flash ratio control  
Master flash firing  
Flash zoom*  
k
k
k
k
* For [FEB] (Flash exposure bracketing) and [Flash zoom], refer to the instruction  
manual of a Speedlite compatible with the functions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
186  
       
3 Setting the FlashK  
Flash mode  
When using an external Speedlite, you can select the flash mode to  
suit your desired flash shooting.  
[E-TTL II] is the standard mode of  
EX-series Speedlites for automatic  
flash shooting.  
[Manual flash] is for advanced users  
who want to set the [Flash output]  
(1/1 to 1/128) themselves.  
Regarding other flash modes, refer to  
the instruction manual of a Speedlite  
compatible with the functions.  
Shutter synchronization  
Normally, set this to [1st curtain] so that the flash fires immediately  
after the exposure starts.  
If [2nd curtain] is set, the flash will fire right before the shutter closes.  
When this is combined with a slow shutter speed, you can create a trail  
of light such as from car headlights at night with a more natural feel.  
With E-TTL II (auto flash exposure), two flashes will be fired: once when  
you press the shutter button completely, and once immediately before  
the exposure ends. Also, if the shutter speed is 1/30 sec. or faster, first-  
curtain synchronization will be applied automatically.  
If an external Speedlite is attached, you can also select [High-speed  
synchronization] (e). For details, refer to the Speedlite’s  
instruction manual.  
Wireless functions  
When performing optical transmission wireless flash shooting using  
the master function of the built-in flash, see “Using Wireless Flash”  
on page 189. When performing wireless flash shooting with radio or  
optical transmission using the master function of the external  
Speedlite, refer to the Speedlite’s instruction manual.  
Flash exposure compensation  
See “Flash Exposure Compensation” on page 178.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
187  
                 
3 Setting the FlashK  
Setting the External Speedlite Custom Functions  
The Custom Functions displayed under [External flash C.Fn setting]  
vary depending on the Speedlite model.  
Display the Custom Function.  
1
With the camera ready to shoot with  
an external Speedlite, select  
[External flash C.Fn setting], then  
press <0>.  
Set the Custom Function.  
2
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select the  
function number, then set the function.  
The procedure is the same as setting the  
camera’s Custom Functions (p.350).  
With an EX-series Speedlite, if the [Flash metering mode] Custom Function is  
set to [TTL flash metering] (autoflash), the Speedlite will always fire at full output.  
Clearing the Settings  
Select [Clear settings].  
1
Under the [z1: Flash control] tab,  
select [Clear settings], then press  
<0>.  
Select the settings to be cleared.  
2
Select [Clear built-in flash set.],  
Clear external flash set.], or [Clear  
ext. flash C.Fn set.], then press < >.  
[
0
When you select [OK], the respective  
flash settings will be cleared.  
The Speedlite’s Personal Function (P.Fn) cannot be set or canceled with the  
camera’s [Flash control] screen. Set it with the Speedlite.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
188  
   
Using Wireless FlashK  
The camera’s built-in flash can work as a master unit for Canon EX-  
series, external Speedlites having a wireless slave feature. It can  
wirelessly trigger the Speedlite(s) to fire via optical transmission.  
Be sure to read the instructions and cautions about wireless flash  
photography (optical transmission) in the Speedlite’s instruction  
manual.  
Slave Unit Settings and Position  
Regarding your Speedlite (slave unit), refer to its instruction manual and  
set it as follows. The settings other than the ones below for the slave  
unit’s control are all set with the camera. Different types of Speedlite  
slave units can be used and controlled together.  
(1) Set the external Speedlite as a slave unit.  
(2) Set the Speedlite’s transmission channel to the same channel  
as set on the camera.*1  
(3) For flash ratio control (p.197), set the slave unit’s firing group.  
(4) Position the camera and slave unit(s) within the range shown  
below.  
(5) Face the slave unit’s wireless sensor toward the camera.*2  
Example of Wireless Flash Set-up  
Indoors  
Approx. 10 m/32.8 ft.  
Outdoors  
Approx. 7 m/23.0 ft.  
Approx. 80°  
Approx. 5 m/ Approx. 7 m/  
16.4 ft. 23.0 ft.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
189  
   
Using Wireless FlashK  
*1: If the Speedlite does not have a transmission channel setting function, it  
operates regardless of the channel set on the camera.  
*2: In small rooms, the slave unit may work even if its wireless sensor does not face  
the camera. The camera’s wireless signals can bounce off the walls and be  
received by the slave unit. When using an EX-series Speedlite with fixed light-  
emitting unit (flash head) and wireless sensor, take pictures while making sure it  
can fire.  
Canceling the slave unit’s auto power off  
To cancel the slave unit’s auto power off, press the camera’s <A>  
button. If you are using manual flash firing, press the slave unit’s test  
firing (PILOT) button to cancel the auto power off.  
The camera’s master function cannot be used for wireless flash shooting  
with radio transmission.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
190  
Using Wireless FlashK  
Wireless Flash Shooting Configurations  
The tables below show the possible configurations for wireless flash  
shooting. Choose the configuration suiting the subject, shooting  
conditions, the number of external Speedlites you use, etc.  
External Speedlite  
Setting  
Built-in  
Flash  
Page  
A:B Flash  
Quantity  
Wireless  
Firing Group  
Ratio  
Functions  
Single  
Single  
-
-
0
1 All  
-
-
-
Used p.195  
0:3  
0
Multiple  
Multiple  
Multiple  
Multiple  
-
1 All  
1(A:B)  
Fully  
Set  
-
-
0
Automatic  
(E-TTL II  
autoflash)  
Used  
Used  
0+3 1 All and 2  
Set  
0+3  
1(A:B)2  
• Flash exposure  
compensation  
• FE lock  
External Speedlite  
Setting  
Built-in  
Flash  
Page  
A:B Flash  
Quantity  
Wireless  
Firing Group  
Ratio  
Functions  
Single/  
-
-
0
0
1 All  
Multiple  
Multiple  
Set  
-
-
1(A:B)  
Manual  
Flash  
Single/  
Multiple  
Used  
Used  
0+3 1 All and 2  
0+3 1(A:B)2  
Multiple  
Set  
Even if you disable the built-in flash from firing, it will still fire in order  
to control the slave unit via optical transmission. The flash fired to  
control the slave unit may therefore appear in the picture depending on the  
shooting conditions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
191  
Easy Wireless Flash ShootingK  
The basics of easy, fully automatic wireless flash shooting are explained  
below.  
Fully Automatic Shooting with One External Speedlite  
Steps 1 to 4 and 6 apply to all  
wireless flash shooting. Therefore,  
these steps are omitted in other  
wireless flash setups explained on  
the pages hereafter.  
Press the <I> button to raise the  
built-in flash.  
For wireless flash shooting, be sure  
1
to raise the built-in flash.  
Select [Flash control].  
2
Under the [z1] tab, select [Flash  
control], then press <0>.  
Select [Evaluative].  
3
For [E-TTL II meter.], select  
[Evaluative], then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
192  
     
Easy Wireless Flash ShootingK  
Select [Built-in flash settings].  
Select [Built-in flash settings], then  
press <0>.  
4
5
6
Select [EasyWireless].  
For [Built-in flash], select  
[EasyWireless], then press <0>.  
Set [Channel].  
Set the transmission channel (1-4) to  
the same one as the slave unit.  
Take the picture.  
7
Set the camera and take the picture  
in the same way as with normal  
shooting.  
Exit the wireless flash shooting.  
For [Built-in flash], select  
[NormalFiring].  
8
Setting [E-TTL II meter.] to [Evaluative] is recommended.  
Even though the firing of the built-in flash is disabled when  
[EasyWireless] is set, it will still fire a small flash in order to control the  
slave unit. Depending on shooting conditions, the flash fired to control  
the slave unit may appear in the picture.  
Firing a test flash is not possible with the slave unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
193  
 
Easy Wireless Flash ShootingK  
Fully Automatic Shooting with Multiple External Speedlites  
You can have multiple slave units fire as if they were a single Speedlite.  
This is convenient when you need a large flash output.  
Basic settings:  
Flash mode  
: E-TTL II  
E-TTL II meter. : Evaluative  
Built-in flash : EasyWireless  
Channel  
: (Same as slave units)  
All the slave units will fire at the same  
output and be controlled to obtain a  
standard exposure.  
No matter which firing group (A, B, or C)  
the slave units belong to, they will all fire  
as one group.  
Flash Exposure Compensation  
If the flash exposure looks too dark or too bright, you can set flash  
exposure compensation to adjust the slave units’ flash output.  
Select [1exp. comp.], then press  
<0>.  
If the flash exposure is too dark, press the  
> key to increase the flash exposure  
and make it brighter. If the flash exposure is  
too bright, press the < > key to decrease  
the flash exposure and make it darker.  
<Z  
Y
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
194  
 
Custom Wireless Flash ShootingK  
Fully Automatic Shooting with One External Speedlite and Built-in Flash  
This is fully automatic wireless flash  
shooting with one external Speedlite and  
the built-in flash.  
You can change the flash ratio between  
the external Speedlite and built-in flash  
to adjust how the shadows cast on the  
subject.  
On the menu screens, the <0> and  
<1> icons indicate the external  
Speedlite, and the <3> and <2>  
icons indicate the built-in flash.  
Select [CustWireless].  
1
Follow step 5 on page 193 to select  
[CustWireless], then press <0>.  
Select [Wireless func.].  
2
For [Wireless func.], select [0:3],  
then press <0>.  
Set the desired flash ratio and  
3 take the picture.  
Select [0:3] and set the flash ratio  
within 8:1 to 1:1. Setting a flash ratio  
to the right of 1:1 is not possible.  
If the built-in flash output is not  
enough, set a higher ISO speed  
The 8:1 to 1:1 flash ratio is equivalent to 3:1 to 1:1 stops (1/2-stop increments).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
195  
       
Custom Wireless Flash ShootingK  
Fully Automatic Shooting with Multiple External Speedlites  
Multiple Speedlite slave units can be fired as one flash unit, or  
separated into slave groups for shooting with flash ratio control.  
The basic settings are shown below. By changing the [Firing group]  
setting, you can shoot with various wireless flash setups with multiple  
Speedlites.  
Basic settings:  
Flash mode  
: E-TTL II  
E-TTL II meter. : Evaluative  
Wireless func. :0  
Channel  
: (Same as slave units)  
[1All] Firing multiple slave Speedlites as one flash unit  
Convenient when you need a large flash  
output. All the slave units will fire at the  
same output and be controlled to obtain  
a standard exposure.  
No matter which firing group (A, B, or C)  
the slave units belong to, they will all fire  
as one group.  
Set [Firing group] to [1All], then  
take the picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
196  
 
Custom Wireless Flash ShootingK  
[1 (A:B)] Firing multiple slave units in multiple groups  
You can divide the slave units into  
groups A and B, and change the flash  
ratio to obtain the desired lighting effect.  
Refer to the Speedlite’s instruction  
manual and set one slave unit to firing  
group A and the other to firing group B.  
Position the Speedlites as shown in the  
illustration.  
A
B
Select [Wireless func.].  
Follow step 2 on page 195 to select  
[0], then press <0>.  
1
2
3
Set [Firing group] to [1 (A:B)].  
Set the A:B flash ratio and shoot.  
Select [A:B fire ratio] and set the  
flash ratio.  
If [Firing group] is set to [1 (A:B)], group C will not fire.  
The 8:1 to 1:1 to 1:8 flash ratio is equivalent to 3:1 to 1:1 to 1:3 stops (1/2-  
stop increments).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
197  
 
Custom Wireless Flash ShootingK  
Fully Automatic Shooting with the Built-in Flash and Multiple External Speedlites  
The built-in flash can also be added to wireless flash shooting explained  
The basic settings are shown below. By changing the [Firing group]  
setting, you can shoot with various wireless flash setups of multiple  
Speedlites complemented with the built-in flash.  
Basic settings:  
1
Flash mode  
: E-TTL II  
E-TTL II meter. : Evaluative  
Wireless func. : [0+3]  
Channel  
: (Same as slave units)  
Select [Firing group].  
Select the firing group, then set the  
flash ratio, flash exposure  
2
compensation, and other necessary  
settings before shooting.  
A
B
[1 All and 2]  
[1 (A:B) 2]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
198  
 
Custom Wireless Flash ShootingK  
Flash Exposure Compensation  
When [Flash mode] is set to [E-TTL II], flash exposure compensation  
can be set. The flash exposure compensation settings (see below)  
which can be set vary depending on the [Wireless func.] and [Firing  
group] settings.  
[Flash exp. comp.]  
The set amount of flash exposure  
compensation will be applied to the  
built-in flash and all the external  
Speedlites.  
[2 exp. comp.]  
Flash exposure compensation is  
applied only to the built-in flash.  
[1 exp. comp.]  
The set amount of flash exposure  
compensation will be applied to all  
the external Speedlites.  
FE Lock  
If [Flash mode] is set to [E-TTL II], you can press the <A> button to  
perform FE lock.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
199  
   
Custom Wireless Flash ShootingK  
Setting the Flash Output Manually for Wireless Flash Shooting  
When [Flash mode] is set to [Manual flash], flash exposure can be set  
manually. The flash output settings that can be set ([1 flash output],  
[Group A output], etc.) vary depending on the [Wireless func.] setting  
(see below).  
[Wireless func.0]  
[Firing group: 1All]:  
The manual flash output setting is  
applied to all the external Speedlites.  
[Firing group: 1 (A:B)]:  
You can set the flash output  
separately for slave groups A and B.  
[Wireless func.0+3]  
[Firing group: 1All and 2]:  
The flash output can be set  
separately for the external  
Speedlite(s) and built-in flash.  
[Firing group: 1 (A:B)2]:  
You can set the flash output  
separately for slave groups A and B.  
You can also set the flash output for  
the built-in flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
200  
   
7
Shooting with the LCD Monitor  
(Live View Shooting)  
You can shoot while viewing the picture on the camera’s  
LCD monitor. This is called “Live View shooting”.  
If you handhold the camera and shoot while viewing the  
LCD monitor, camera shake can cause blurred images.  
Using a tripod is recommended.  
Remote Live View Shooting  
With EOS Utility (EOS software, p.420) installed on your computer,  
you can connect the camera to the computer and shoot remotely  
while viewing the computer screen. For details, refer to the EOS  
Utility Instruction Manual (p.422).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
201  
 
A Shooting with the LCD Monitor  
Display the Live View image.  
Press the <A> button.  
The Live View image will appear on  
the LCD monitor. In the <A> mode,  
the scene icon for the scene detected  
by the camera is displayed on the  
upper left (p.206).  
1
By default, Continuous AF (p.214) will take effect.  
The Live View image will closely reflect the brightness level of the  
actual image you capture.  
Focus on the subject.  
2
When you press the shutter button  
halfway, the camera will focus with  
the current AF method (p.218).  
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter button completely.  
The picture will be taken and the  
captured image is displayed on the  
LCD monitor.  
3
When the playback display ends, the  
camera will return to Live View  
shooting automatically.  
Press the <A> button to exit the  
Live View shooting.  
The image’s field of view is approx. 100% (with the image-recording  
quality set to JPEG 73).  
In Creative Zone modes, you can check the depth of field by pressing the  
depth-of-field preview button.  
You can also tap the subject on the LCD monitor to focus (p.218-225)  
and shoot (p.226).  
You can also use a remote controller (sold separately, p.366) for Live  
View shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
202  
   
A Shooting with the LCD Monitor  
Enabling Live View Shooting  
Set [A: Live View shoot.] to [Enable].  
Number of Possible Shots with Live View Shooting (Approx. number of shots)  
Room Temperature  
(23°C / 73°F)  
Low Temperatures  
(0°C / 32°F)  
Temperature  
No Flash  
200  
180  
170  
150  
50% Flash Use  
The figures above are based on a fully-charged Battery Pack LP-E17 and CIPA  
(Camera & Imaging Products Association) testing standards.  
With a fully-charged Battery Pack LP-E17, continuous Live View shooting is  
possible for approx. 1 hr. 30 min. at room temperature (23°C / 73°F).  
In the <x> mode, Live View shooting is not possible.  
In the <F> and <G> modes, the shooting range will be smaller.  
When the flash is recycling, “BUSY” is displayed on the LCD monitor,  
and you cannot view the subject.  
Do not point the camera toward an intense light source, such as the sun  
or an intense artificial light source. Doing so may damage the image  
sensor or the camera’s internal components.  
General Live View Shooting Cautions are on pages 230-231.  
When flash is used, there will be two shutter sounds, but only one shot will  
be taken. Also, the time it takes to capture an image after you press the  
shutter button completely will be slightly longer than with viewfinder shooting.  
If the camera is not operated for a prolonged period, the power will turn  
off automatically after the time set in [52: Auto power off] (p.273). If  
[52: Auto power off] is set to [Disable], Live View shooting will end  
automatically after 30 min. (camera power remains on).  
With the HDMI cable HTC-100 (sold separately) or stereo AV cable AVC-  
DC400ST (sold separately), you can display the Live View image on a  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
203  
   
A Shooting with the LCD Monitor  
Information Display  
Each time you press the <B> button, the information display will  
change.  
AF point (FlexiZone - Single)  
Histogram display  
Battery check  
Maximum burst*  
Possible shots  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
Shooting mode  
Quick Control  
AF method  
White balance/  
White balance  
correction  
AF operation  
Drive mode  
Picture Style  
Metering mode  
Creative filters  
Image-recording  
quality  
Eye-Fi card  
transmission  
status  
Switch to auto  
selection  
Exposure  
simulation  
(AF point)  
Touch shutter  
Magnified view  
AE lock  
AEB/FEB/Multi Shot  
Noise Reduction  
Flash-ready/Flash off  
Shutter speed  
ISO speed  
Highlight tone priority  
Flash exposure compensation  
GPS connection indicator  
Aperture  
Digital compass  
Exposure level indicator/AEB range  
*
The number will be displayed when the maximum burst decreases to nine or lower.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
204  
   
A Shooting with the LCD Monitor  
You can display the electronic level by pressing the <B> button  
(p.70). Note that if the AF method is set to [u+Tracking] or the camera  
is connected to a TV set with a HDMI cable, the electronic level cannot  
be displayed.  
You can display the histogram by pressing the <B> button. However,  
the histogram is not displayed while pressing the shutter button  
completely.  
When <g> is displayed in white, it indicates that the Live View image  
brightness is close to what the captured image will look like.  
If <g> is blinking, it indicates that the Live View image is displayed at  
a brightness that differs from the actual shooting result because of low-  
or bright-light conditions. However, the actual image recorded will reflect  
the exposure setting. Note that noise may be more noticeable than the  
actual image recorded.  
If the <F> or <G> shooting mode, Multi Shot Noise Reduction, flash, or  
bulb exposure is used, the <g> icon and histogram will be grayed out  
(for your reference). The histogram may not be properly displayed in low-  
or bright-light conditions.  
Do not hold the camera in the same position for long periods of time.  
Even if the camera does not feel too hot, prolonged contact with the same  
body part may cause skin redness, blistering or low-temperature contact  
burns. Using a tripod is recommended for people with circulation problems  
or very sensitive skin, or when using the camera in very hot places.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
205  
 
A Shooting with the LCD Monitor  
Scene Icons  
In the <A> shooting mode, the camera will detect the scene type and  
set everything automatically to suit the scene. The detected scene type  
is indicated on the upper left of the screen. For certain scenes or  
shooting conditions, the icon displayed may not match the actual scene.  
*1  
Subject  
Portrait  
Non-Portrait  
Background  
Color  
Nature and  
Outdoor Scene  
*2  
Movement  
Movement Close  
Background  
Bright  
Backlit  
Gray  
Blue Sky  
Included  
Light blue  
Orange  
Backlit  
Sunset  
Spotlight  
Dark  
*3  
*3  
Dark blue  
With  
*4*5  
*3  
*4*5  
*3  
Tripod  
*1: Displayed only when the AF method is set to [u+Tracking]. If another AF  
method is set, the “Non-portrait” icon will be displayed even if a person is  
detected.  
*2: Displayed when the attached lens has distance information. With an Extension  
Tube or Close-up Lens, the icon displayed may not match the actual scene.  
*3: The icon suiting the scene detected will be displayed.  
*4: Displayed when all the following conditions apply:  
The shooting scene is dark, it is a night scene, and the camera is mounted on  
a tripod.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
206  
   
A Shooting with the LCD Monitor  
*5: Displayed with any of the lenses below:  
• EF-S18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS II • EF-S55-250mm f/4-5.6 IS II  
• EF300mm f/2.8L IS II USM • EF400mm f/2.8L IS II USM  
• Image Stabilizer lenses marketed in 2012 or later.  
*4+*5: If the conditions in both *4 and *5 are met, the shutter speed will slow  
down.  
Final Image Simulation  
The final image simulation reflects the settings of the Picture Style,  
white balance and other functions in the Live View image so you can  
see what the captured image will look like.  
During shooting, the Live View image will automatically reflect the  
function settings listed below.  
Final Image Simulation During Live View Shooting  
Picture Style  
* All settings such as sharpness, contrast, color saturation, and color  
tone will be reflected.  
White balance  
White balance correction  
Light/scene-based shots  
Background blur (in <C> mode)  
* You can check the effect only during the setting procedure (when  
[Simulating blur] is displayed).  
Color tone  
Metering mode  
Exposure  
Depth of field (with depth-of-field preview button ON)  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
Peripheral illumination correction  
Chromatic aberration correction  
Highlight tone priority  
Aspect ratio (shooting range confirmation)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
207  
 
Shooting Function Settings  
Function settings particular to Live View shooting are explained here.  
Q Quick Control  
If you press the <Q> button when the image is displayed on the LCD  
monitor in a Creative Zone mode, you can set the following: AF  
method, AF operation, Drive mode, Metering mode, Image-recording  
quality, White balance, Picture Style, Auto Lighting Optimizer, and  
Creative filters.  
In Basic Zone modes, you can set the functions shown in the table on  
page 99 (except background blur), as well as the functions in bold  
above.  
Press the <Q> button (7).  
1
The settable functions will be  
displayed.  
Select a function and set it.  
2
Press the <W> <X> keys to select a  
function.  
The settings of the function and  
Feature guide (p.73) will appear.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to set the  
function.  
In the <8> mode, select the  
shooting mode box on the upper left  
of the screen, then press <0> to  
select the shooting mode.  
To set the drive mode’s <q>  
setting, WB correction/WB  
bracketing, Picture Style parameters,  
or Creative filter effects, press the  
<B> button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
208  
       
Shooting Function Settings  
Exit the setting.  
Press <0> to finalize the setting and  
return to Live View shooting.  
3
You can also select [2] to return to  
Live View shooting.  
In Creative Zone modes, you can set the ISO speed by pressing the  
<g> button.  
With Live View shooting, you cannot set <B> or <M> for the drive  
mode.  
When you set w (Partial metering) or r (Spot metering), a circle  
indicating the metering area will be displayed on the center of the screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
209  
U Applying Creative Filters  
While viewing the Live View image, you can apply a filter effect (Grainy  
B/W, Soft focus, Fish-eye effect, Art bold effect, Water painting effect,  
Toy camera effect, or Miniature effect) for shooting. These are called  
Creative filters.  
When you take the picture, the camera saves only the image with the  
Creative filter applied. If you also want to save the image without a  
Creative filter applied, take the picture without a Creative filter. Then  
apply a Creative filter effect and save it as a new image (p.326).  
Set any shooting mode except  
<x>, <F>, or <G>.  
1
2
3
Press the <Q> button (7).  
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
Select [q].  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[q] (Creative filter) on the right side  
of the screen.  
Select a filter.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select a  
4
filter (p.212).  
The image will be displayed with the  
effects of the filter applied.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
210  
   
U Applying Creative Filters  
Adjust the filter effect.  
Press the <B> button (except for  
Miniature effect).  
5
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to adjust  
the filter effect, then press <0>.  
For the Miniature effect, press <0>,  
then press the <W> <X> keys to  
move the white frame to where you  
want the image to look sharp.  
Take the picture.  
The image is shot with the filter  
6
applied.  
Even if you set the drive mode to <i> or <q>, the camera will still shoot  
in single shooting mode.  
You cannot shoot with Creative filters if the recording quality is 1+73  
or 1, or if AEB, white balance bracketing, or Multi Shot Noise  
Reduction is set.  
The histogram is not displayed when you shoot with Creative filters.  
With Grainy B/W, the grainy effect displayed on the LCD monitor will look  
different from the grainy effect recorded in the picture.  
With the Soft focus and Miniature effects, the blurred effect displayed on  
the LCD monitor will look different from the blurred effect recorded in the  
picture. In Creative Zone modes, you can check the picture’s blurred  
effect by pressing the depth-of-field preview button.  
Dust Delete Data (p.287) will not be appended to images shot with Fish-  
eye effect applied.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
211  
 
U Applying Creative Filters  
Creative Filter Characteristics  
V Grainy B/W  
Creates a grainy black-and-white photo. You can change the black-  
and-white effect by adjusting the contrast.  
W Soft focus  
Gives the image a soft look. You can change the degree of softness  
by adjusting the blur.  
X Fish-eye effect  
Gives the effect of a fish-eye lens. The image will have a barrel-type  
distortion.  
Depending on the level of this filter effect, the area trimmed along  
the periphery of the image changes. Also, since this filter expands  
the center part of the image, the resolution at the center may  
decrease depending on the number of recorded pixels. Check the  
image on the screen when setting this filter. The AF method will be  
FlexiZone - Single (fixed at center).  
Y Art bold effect  
Makes the photo look like an oil painting and the subject look more  
three-dimensional. You can adjust the contrast and saturation. Note  
that the sky, white walls, and similar subjects may not be rendered  
with a smooth gradation and may look irregular or have significant  
noise.  
Z Water painting effect  
Makes the photo look like a watercolor painting with soft colors. You  
can control the color density by adjusting the filter effect. Note that  
night scenes or dark scenes may not be rendered with a smooth  
gradation and may look irregular or have significant noise.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
212  
           
U Applying Creative Filters  
bToy camera effect  
Darkens the photo’s corners and applies a color tone that makes it  
look as if it was shot by a toy camera. You can change the color cast  
by adjusting the color tone.  
c Miniature effect  
Creates a diorama effect. You can change where the image looks  
sharp. In step 5 on page 211, if you press the <u> button (or tap  
[T] on the lower right of the screen), you can switch between the  
white frame’s vertical and horizontal orientations. The AF method  
will be FlexiZone - Single to focus at the center of the white frame.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
213  
   
3 Menu Function Settings  
The menu options displayed are as  
follows.  
The settable functions on this menu  
screen apply only to Live View  
shooting. They do not work with  
viewfinder shooting (settings are  
disabled).  
Live View shooting  
You can set Live View shooting to [Enable] or [Disable].  
AF method  
You can select [u+Tracking], [FlexiZone - Multi], or [FlexiZone -  
Single]. See pages 218-225 for more about the AF method.  
Continuous AF  
The default setting is [Enable].  
The camera focuses the subject continuously to achieve rough  
focus. This makes it quicker to achieve focus when you press the  
shutter button halfway. If [Enable] is set, the lens will operate  
constantly and consume more battery power. This will reduce the  
number of possible shots due to shorter battery life.  
If you want to set the lens focus mode switch to <MF> during  
Continuous AF, first stop Live View shooting.  
Touch Shutter  
Just by tapping on the LCD monitor screen, you can focus and take  
the picture automatically. For details, see page 226.  
Grid display  
With [Grid 1l] or [Grid 2m], you can display grid lines. You can  
check horizontal or vertical tilt when shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
214  
             
3 Menu Function Settings  
Metering timerK  
You can change how long the exposure setting is displayed (AE lock  
time). In Basic Zone modes, metering timer is fixed at 8 sec.  
Selecting any of the following operations will stop Live View shooting. To  
start Live View shooting again, press the <A> button.  
• [z3: Dust Delete Data], [53: Sensor cleaning], [54: Clear settings],  
or [54: z firmware ver.]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
215  
   
Changing the Autofocus OperationK  
You can select the AF (autofocus) operation characteristics suiting the  
shooting conditions or subject. In Basic Zone modes, the optimum AF  
operation is set for the respective shooting mode.  
Press the <Q> button.  
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
1
2
Select [X].  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[X] (AF operation) on the  
screen’s left side.  
Select the AF operation.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
3
the desired AF operation, then press  
<0>.  
Focus on the subject  
Aim the AF point over the subject and  
4
press the shutter button halfway. The  
camera will then autofocus in the  
selected AF operation.  
If focus cannot be achieved, the AF point will turn orange. If this occurs, the  
picture cannot be taken even if the shutter button is pressed completely.  
Recompose the shot and try to focus again. Or see “Shooting Conditions  
that Make Focusing Difficult” (p.224).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
216  
         
Changing the Autofocus OperationK  
One-Shot AF for Still Subjects  
Suited for still subjects. When you press the shutter button  
halfway, the camera will focus only once.  
When focus is achieved, the AF point will turn green and the beeper  
will sound.  
While you hold down the shutter button halfway, the focus will be  
locked. You can then recompose the shot if desired.  
If [z1: Beep] is set to [Disable], the beeper will not sound when focus  
is achieved.  
During continuous shooting, the exposure set for the first shot will also  
be applied to the subsequent shots.  
Servo AF for Moving Subjects  
This AF operation is suited for moving subjects. While you hold  
down the shutter button halfway, the camera will keep focusing on  
the subject continuously.  
The exposure is set at the moment the picture is taken.  
The continuous shooting speed becomes slower since the camera  
keeps focusing and shooting continuously.  
Setting the [AF method] to [FlexiZone - Single] is recommended.  
Depending on the shooting conditions, it may take a moment until  
the shutter is released.  
Depending on the lens used, the distance to the subject and the  
subject’s speed, the camera may not be able to achieve correct  
focus.  
If you operate the zoom during continuous shooting, the focus may  
be lost. Shoot after using the zoom to obtain the desired  
composition.  
When focus is achieved, the AF point will turn blue.  
With Servo AF, the beeper will not sound even when focus is achieved.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
217  
     
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
Selecting the AF Method  
You can select an AF method to suit the shooting conditions and your  
subject. The following AF methods are provided: [u(face)+Tracking],  
[FlexiZone - Multi] (p.220), and [FlexiZone - Single] (p.222).  
If you want to achieve precise focus, set the lens focus mode switch to  
<MF>, magnify the image, and focus manually (p.228).  
Select the AF method.  
Under the [A] tab, select [AF  
method].  
Select the desired AF method, then  
press <0>.  
While the Live View image is  
displayed, you can also press the  
<Q> button to select the AF method  
on the Quick Control screen (p.208).  
If [AF operation] is set to [Servo AF], the AF point will turn blue when  
focus is achieved (p.216). The beeper will not sound in this case.  
In the <5> and <C> modes, Servo AF is set automatically and when  
focus is achieved, the AF point will turn blue and the beeper will sound.  
u(face)+Tracking:  
c
The camera detects and focuses on human faces. If a face moves, the  
AF point <p> also moves to track the face.  
Display the Live View image.  
Press the <A> button.  
The Live View image will appear on  
1
the LCD monitor.  
Select an AF point.  
When a face is detected, the AF point  
2
<p> will appear over the face to be  
focused on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
218  
       
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
If multiple faces are detected, <e>  
will be displayed. Use the <Y> <Z>  
keys to move the <e> frame over  
the face you want to focus on.  
You can also tap on the LCD monitor  
screen to select the face or subject. If  
the subject is not a face, <z> will be  
displayed.  
If no faces can be detected, or if you  
tap on the LCD monitor but do not  
select any face or subject, the camera  
will switch to [FlexiZone - Multi] with  
automatic selection (p.220).  
Focus on the subject.  
Press the shutter button halfway to  
focus.  
3
When focus is achieved, the AF point  
will turn green and the beeper will  
sound.  
If focus is not achieved, the AF point  
will turn orange.  
Take the picture.  
4
Check the focus and exposure, then  
press the shutter button completely to  
take the picture (p.202).  
If the subject’s face is significantly out of focus, face detection will not be  
possible. In such a case, set the lens’s focus mode switch to <MF> and  
focus manually.  
An object other than a human face may be detected as a face.  
Face detection will not work if the face is very small or large in the  
picture, too bright or too dark, or partially hidden.  
The <p> may cover only a part of the face.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
219  
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
If you press <0> or the <L> button, the AF point <z> will appear at  
the center and you can use the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z> keys to move  
the AF point.  
Since AF is not possible with a face detected near the edge of the  
picture, the <p> will be grayed out. If you press the shutter button  
halfway, the subject will be focused on, in FlexiZone - Multi method with  
automatic selection.  
FlexiZone - Multi:  
o
You can use up to 49 AF points for wide-area focusing (automatic  
selection). This wide area can also be divided into 9 zones for focusing  
(zone selection).  
Display the Live View image.  
Press the <A> button.  
The Live View image will appear on  
1
the LCD monitor.  
Area frame  
Select the AF point.J  
2
Pressing <0> or the <L> button will  
toggle between automatic selection  
and zone selection. In Basic Zone  
modes, automatic selection is set  
automatically.  
Use the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z> keys  
to select a zone. To return to the  
center zone, press <0> or the <L>  
button again.  
You can also tap on the LCD monitor  
screen to select a zone. When a zone  
is selected, tap [n] on the screen  
to switch to automatic selection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
220  
   
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
Focus on the subject.  
3
Aim the AF point over the subject and  
press the shutter button halfway.  
When focus is achieved, the AF point  
will turn green and the beeper will  
sound.  
If focus is not achieved, the area  
frame will turn orange.  
Take the picture.  
4
Check the focus and exposure, then  
press the shutter button completely to  
take the picture (p.202).  
If the camera does not focus on the desired target subject with automatic  
AF point selection, select a zone or switch the AF method to [FlexiZone  
- Single] and refocus.  
The number of AF points varies, depending on the [A3: Aspect ratio]  
setting. At [3:2], [4:3], and [16:9], there are 49 AF points. At [1:1], 35 AF  
points.  
If [AF operation] is set to [Servo AF], the AF point tracks the subject while  
pressing the shutter button halfway. The AF point display will be <p> when  
a human face is detected, and <z> when a subject other than a face is  
detected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
221  
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
FlexiZone - Single:  
d
The camera focuses with a single AF point. This is effective when you  
want to focus on a particular subject.  
Display the Live View image.  
Press the <A> button.  
The Live View image will appear on  
the LCD monitor.  
1
The AF point < > will appear.  
During movie shooting, if [Movie  
Servo AF] is set to [Enable], the AF  
point will be displayed in a larger size.  
AF point  
Move the AF point.  
2
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to move the AF point to where  
you want to focus. (It cannot go to the  
edge of the screen.)  
Pressing <0> or the <L> button will  
return the AF point to the screen’s center.  
You can also tap on the LCD monitor  
screen to move the AF point.  
Focus on the subject.  
Aim the AF point over the subject and  
3
press the shutter button halfway.  
When focus is achieved, the AF point will  
turn green and the beeper will sound.  
If focus is not achieved, the AF point  
will turn orange.  
Take the picture.  
4
Check the focus and exposure, then  
press the shutter button completely to  
take the picture (p.202).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
222  
   
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
Notes for AF  
AF Operation  
Even when focus is achieved, pressing the shutter button halfway  
will focus again.  
The image brightness may change during and after the AF  
operation.  
Depending on the subject or shooting conditions, etc., focusing may  
take longer or the continuous shooting speed may become slower.  
If the light source changes while the Live View image is displayed,  
the screen may flicker and focusing may be difficult. If this happens,  
exit Live View shooting and execute AF under the actual light  
source.  
If [u+Tracking] is set, magnified view is not possible.  
When [FlexiZone - Multi] is set and you press the <u> button (or  
tap <s> on the screen), the center of the selected zone (or image  
center with automatic selection) will be magnified. If you press the  
shutter button halfway, the display will return to normal and the  
camera will focus.  
When [FlexiZone - Single] is set and you press the <u> button (or  
tap <s> on the screen), the area covered by the AF point will be  
magnified. Press the shutter button halfway to focus in the magnified  
view. This is effective when the camera is attached to a tripod and  
you need to attain very precise focus. If focusing is difficult in  
magnified view, return to the normal display and use AF. Note that  
the AF speed may differ between the normal and magnified views.  
If you magnify the view after focusing with [FlexiZone - Multi] or  
[FlexiZone - Single] in the normal view, precise focus may not be  
achieved.  
When in magnified view, Continuous AF (p.214) or Servo AF (p.217) will not  
be executed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
223  
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
Shooting Conditions that Make Focusing Difficult  
Low-contrast subjects such as the blue sky, solid-color flat surfaces  
or when highlight or shadow details are lost.  
Subjects in low light.  
Stripes and other patterns where there is contrast only in the  
horizontal direction.  
Subjects with repetitive patterns (Example: Skyscraper windows,  
computer keyboards, etc.).  
Fine lines and subject outlines.  
Under a light source whose brightness, color, or pattern keeps  
changing.  
Night scenes or points of light.  
The image flickers under fluorescent or LED lighting.  
Extremely small subjects.  
Subjects at the edge of the picture.  
Strongly backlit or reflective subjects (Example: Car with a highly  
reflective body, etc.).  
The AF point covers both near and distant subjects (Example:  
Animal in a cage, etc.).  
Subjects that keep moving within the AF point and cannot keep still  
due to camera shake or subject blur.  
A subject approaching or moving away from the camera.  
Autofocusing while the subject is very far out of focus.  
Soft focus effect is applied with a soft focus lens.  
A special effect filter is used.  
Noise (spots, banding, etc.) appears on the screen during AF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
224  
     
Using AF to Focus (AF Method)  
If focus is not achieved with the shooting conditions on the preceding  
page, set the lens focus mode switch to <MF> and focus manually.  
If you use AF with any of the following lenses, focusing may take longer  
or correct focus may not be achieved.  
EF50mm f/1.4 USM, EF50mm f/1.8 II, EF50mm f/2.5 Compact Macro,  
EF75-300mm f/4-5.6 III, EF75-300mm f/4-5.6 III USM  
For information on discontinued lenses, refer to the Canon Web site.  
If you shoot a peripheral subject and it is out of focus, aim the center AF  
point or zone over the subject to focus, focus again and then take the  
picture.  
The AF-assist beam will not be emitted. However, if an EX-series  
Speedlite (sold separately) equipped with an LED light is used, the LED  
light will turn on for AF-assist when necessary.  
In magnified view, focusing may be difficult due to camera shake. Using  
a tripod is recommended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
225  
   
x Shooting with the Touch Shutter  
Just by tapping on the LCD monitor screen, you can focus and take the  
picture automatically. This works in all shooting modes.  
Display the Live View image.  
Press the <A> button.  
The Live View image will appear on  
1
the LCD monitor.  
Enable the touch shutter.  
2
Tap [y] on the screen’s bottom left.  
Each time you tap on the icon, it will  
toggle between [y] and [x].  
[x] (Touch shutter: Enable)  
You can tap on the spot to focus and  
shoot.  
[y] (Touch shutter: Disable)  
You can tap on the spot to select  
where you want to focus. Press the  
shutter button completely to take the  
picture.  
Tap on the screen to shoot.  
3
Tap on the face or subject on the  
screen.  
On the point you tap, the camera will  
focus in the AF method that was set  
(p.218-222). When [FlexiZone -  
Multi] is set, it will switch to  
[FlexiZone - Single].  
When focus is achieved, the AF point  
turns green and the picture is taken  
automatically.  
If focus is not achieved, the AF point  
turns orange and the picture cannot  
be taken. Tap on the face or subject  
on the screen again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
226  
     
x Shooting with the Touch Shutter  
Even if you set the drive mode to <i>, the camera will still shoot in  
single shooting mode.  
Even if [AF operation] is set to [Servo AF], [One-Shot AF] will take  
effect when touch shutter is used.  
The touch shutter does not work with the magnified view.  
If the Fish-eye effect Creative filter is set, the camera will focus using the  
AF point on the center of the screen regardless of the point you tap on.  
If the Miniature effect Creative filter is set, the touch shutter does not  
work.  
When [10: Shutter/AE lock button] is set to [1: AE lock/AF] or [3: AE/  
AF, no AE lock] under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], autofocusing  
does not take effect.  
You can also set the touch shutter with [A: Touch shutter].  
To shoot with bulb exposure, tap on the screen twice. The first tap on the  
screen will start the bulb exposure. Tapping it again will stop the  
exposure. Be careful not to shake the camera when tapping on the  
screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
227  
MF: Focusing Manually  
You can magnify the image and focus precisely with manual focus.  
Set the lens focus mode switch to  
<MF>.  
Turn the lens focusing ring to focus  
1
roughly.  
Display the magnifying frame.  
Press the <u> button.  
The magnifying frame will appear.  
You can also tap [s] on the screen to  
magnify the image.  
2
Move the magnifying frame.  
3
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to move the magnifying frame to  
the position where you want to focus.  
To return to the screen’s center, press  
<0> or the <L> button.  
Magnifying frame  
Magnify the image.  
4
Each time you press the <u> button,  
the magnification of the image will  
change in the following sequence:  
1x 9 5x 9 10x 9 Normal view  
AE lock  
Magnified area position  
Magnification  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
228  
           
MF: Focusing Manually  
Focus manually.  
5
While looking at the magnified image,  
turn the lens focusing ring to focus.  
After achieving focus, press the <u>  
button to return to the normal view.  
Take the picture.  
6
Check the focus and exposure, then  
press the shutter button to take the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
229  
General Live View Shooting Cautions  
Image Quality  
When you shoot at high ISO speeds, noise (such as dots of light and  
banding) may become noticeable.  
Shooting in high temperatures may cause noise and irregular colors in  
the image.  
If Live View shooting is used continuously for a prolonged period, the  
camera’s internal temperature may rise, and image quality may  
deteriorate. Always exit Live View shooting when you are not shooting.  
If you shoot a long exposure while the camera’s internal temperature is  
high, image quality may deteriorate. Exit Live View shooting and wait a  
few minutes before shooting again.  
White <s> and Red <E> Internal Temperature Warning Icons  
If the camera’s internal temperature increases due to prolonged Live  
View shooting or under a high ambient temperature, a white <s> or red  
<E> icon will appear.  
The white <s> icon indicates that the image quality of still photos will  
deteriorate. It is recommended that you temporarily exit Live View  
shooting and allow the camera to cool down before shooting again.  
The red <E> icon indicates that the Live View shooting will soon stop  
automatically. If this happens, you will not be able to shoot again until the  
camera’s internal temperature decreases. Exit the Live View shooting or  
turn off the power and let the camera rest for a while.  
Using Live View shooting at a high temperature for a prolonged period  
will cause the <s> or <E> icon to appear earlier. When you are not  
shooting, always turn off the camera.  
If the camera’s internal temperature is high, the quality of images shot  
with high ISO speed or long exposure may deteriorate even before the  
white <s> icon is displayed.  
Shooting Results  
If you take the picture in magnified view, the exposure may not come out  
as desired. Return to the normal view before taking the picture. In  
magnified view, the shutter speed and aperture will be displayed in  
orange. Even if you take the picture in magnified view, the image will be  
captured in the normal view range.  
If [z2: Auto Lighting Optimizer] (p.146) is set to any setting other  
than [Disable], the image may look bright even if a decreased exposure  
compensation or decreased flash exposure compensation is set.  
If you use a TS-E lens (except the TS-E17mm f/4L or TS-E24mm f/3.5L  
II) and shift or tilt the lens or use an Extension Tube, the standard  
exposure may not be obtained or an irregular exposure may result.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
230  
       
General Live View Shooting Cautions  
Live View Image  
Under low- or bright-light conditions, the Live View image may not reflect  
the brightness of the captured image.  
Even if a low ISO speed is set, noise may be noticeable in the displayed  
Live View image under low light. However, when you shoot, the image  
recorded will have minimal noise. (The image quality of the Live View  
image is different from that of the recorded image.)  
If the light source (illumination) within the image changes, the screen  
may flicker. If this happens, exit Live View shooting and resume shooting  
under the actual light source.  
If you point the camera in a different direction, it may throw off the Live  
View image’s correct brightness momentarily. Wait until the brightness  
level stabilizes before shooting.  
If there is a very bright light source in the image, the bright area may  
appear black on the LCD monitor. However, the actual captured image  
will correctly show the bright area.  
In low light, if you set the [52: LCD brightness] to a bright setting, noise  
or irregular colors may appear in the Live View image. However, the  
noise or irregular colors will not be recorded in the captured image.  
When you magnify the image, the image sharpness may look more  
pronounced than in the actual image.  
If the shutter speed is 1 sec. or slower, “BUSY” is displayed on the LCD  
monitor, and the Live View display will not appear until the exposure is  
completed.  
Custom Functions  
During Live View shooting, some Custom Function settings will not take  
effect (p.351).  
Lens and Flash  
The focus preset function is possible for Live View shooting only when  
using a (super) telephoto lens equipped with the focus preset mode,  
available since the second half of 2011.  
FE lock will not work if the built-in flash is used. FE lock and modeling  
flash will not work if an external Speedlite is used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
231  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
Shooting Movies  
Movie shooting is enabled by  
setting the power switch to  
<k>. The movie recording  
format will be MP4.  
For cards that can record movies, see page 5.  
If you handhold the camera and shoot movies, camera  
shake can cause blurred movies. Using a tripod is  
recommended.  
To shoot while handholding the camera, see page 80.  
Full HD 1080  
Full HD 1080 indicates compatibility with High-  
Definition featuring 1080 vertical pixels (scanning  
lines).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
233  
     
k Shooting Movies  
Connecting the camera to a TV set is recommended to play back the  
movies shot (p.312-315).  
Autoexposure Shooting  
When the shooting mode is set to any mode other than <  
a>,  
autoexposure control will take effect to suit the scene’s current brightness.  
Set the power switch to <k>.  
1
The reflex mirror will make a sound,  
then the image will appear on the  
LCD monitor.  
Set any shooting mode except  
2 <a>.  
Focus on the subject.  
Before shooting a movie, focus with  
AF or manual focus (p.218-225, 228).  
By default, [Movie Servo AF:  
Enable] is set so that the camera will  
always focus. To stop Movie Servo  
AF, see page 263.  
3
Shoot the movie.  
4
Press the <A> button to start  
shooting a movie. To stop movie  
shooting, press <A> again.  
While the movie is being shot, the  
o” mark will be displayed on the  
upper right of the screen.  
Recording movie  
Sound will be recorded by the built-in  
microphones.  
Built-in microphones  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
234  
             
k Shooting Movies  
General Movie Shooting Cautions are on pages 268-269.  
If necessary, also read the General Live View Shooting Cautions on  
In Basic Zone modes, the shooting result will be the same as with <A>.  
Also, the scene icon for the scene detected by the camera is displayed  
on the upper left (p.236).  
In the <f> and <s> shooting modes, movies will be taken with the  
same settings as in the <d> mode.  
Settable menu functions differ between Basic Zone modes and Creative  
Zone modes (p.374).  
Shutter speed and aperture are set automatically.  
In Creative Zone modes, you can press the <A> button (p.172) to lock  
the exposure (AE lock). The exposure setting will be displayed for the  
number of seconds set with [Z1: Metering timer]. After applying AE  
lock during movie shooting, you can cancel it by pressing the <S>  
button. (AE lock setting is retained until you press the <S> button.)  
In Creative Zone modes, you can set the <R> switch to the left and  
turn the <5> dial to set the exposure compensation.  
Pressing the shutter button halfway displays the shutter speed and ISO  
speed on the screen’s bottom. This is the exposure setting for taking a  
still photo (p.239). The exposure setting for movie shooting is not  
displayed. Note that the exposure setting for movie shooting may differ  
from that for still photo shooting.  
If you shoot a movie with autoexposure, the shutter speed and aperture  
will not be recorded in the image information (Exif).  
ISO Speed in Basic Zone Modes  
The ISO speed will be set automatically within ISO 100 - ISO 6400.  
ISO Speed in <d>, <s>, and <f> Modes  
The ISO speed will be set automatically within ISO 100 - ISO 6400.  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [2: ISO expansion] is set  
to [1: On], the maximum speed will be expanded to H (equivalent to  
ISO 12800).  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [3: Highlight tone priority]  
is set to [1: Enable], the ISO speed will be ISO 200 - ISO 6400.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
235  
k Shooting Movies  
Scene Icons  
During movie shooting in a Basic Zone mode, an icon representing the  
scene detected by the camera will be displayed and the shooting will be  
adapted to that scene. For certain scenes or shooting conditions, the  
icon displayed may not match the actual scene.  
Subject  
Non-Portrait  
Background  
Color  
*1  
Portrait  
Nature and  
Outdoor Scene  
*2  
Background  
Bright  
Close  
Gray  
Backlit  
Blue Sky Included  
Backlit  
Light blue  
Orange  
*3  
*3  
Sunset  
Spotlight  
Dark  
Dark blue  
*1: Displayed only when the AF method is set to [u+Tracking]. If another AF  
method is set, the “Non-portrait” icon will be displayed even if a person is  
detected.  
*2: Displayed when the attached lens has distance information. With an Extension  
Tube or Close-up Lens, the icon displayed may not match the actual scene.  
*3: The icon suiting the scene detected will be displayed.  
Using an EX-series Speedlite (Sold Separately)  
Equipped with an LED Light  
With autoexposure (modes other than a) movie shooting, the camera  
will automatically turn on the Speedlite’s LED light under low-light  
conditions. For details, refer to the Speedlite’s instruction manual.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
236  
   
k Shooting Movies  
Manual Exposure Shooting  
In the <a> mode, you can freely set the shutter speed, aperture, and  
ISO speed for movie shooting. Using manual exposure to shoot movies  
is for advanced users.  
Set the power switch to <k>.  
1
The reflex mirror will make a sound,  
then the image will appear on the  
LCD monitor.  
Set the Mode Dial to <a>.  
2
Set the ISO speed.  
Press the <g> button and turn the  
3
<6> or <5> dial to select the ISO  
speed.  
For details on the ISO speed, see the  
next page.  
Set the shutter speed and  
4 aperture.  
<6> <5>  
To set the shutter speed, turn the  
<6> dial. The settable shutter  
speeds vary depending on the frame  
rate <9>.  
D C B:  
1/4000 sec. - 1/30 sec.  
F E: 1/4000 sec. - 1/60 sec.  
To set the aperture, turn the <5>  
dial.  
If it cannot be set, set the <R>  
switch to the left, then turn the <6>  
or <5> dial.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
237  
   
k Shooting Movies  
Focus and shoot the movie.  
5
The procedure is the same as steps 3  
and 4 for “Autoexposure Shooting”  
ISO Speed During Manual Exposure Shooting  
With [AUTO] (A), the ISO speed will be set automatically within ISO  
100 - ISO 6400.  
You can set the ISO speed manually within ISO 100 - ISO 6400 in  
whole-stop increments. Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if  
[2: ISO expansion] is set to [1: On], the manual setting range will  
expand so you can also select H (equivalent to ISO 12800).  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [3: Highlight tone priority]  
is set to [1: Enable], the ISO speed will be ISO 200 - ISO 6400.  
Since shooting a movie at ISO 12800 may result in much noise, it is  
designated as an expanded ISO speed (displayed as “H”).  
If ISO speed is set to H (ISO 25600) when [2: ISO expansion] is set to  
[1: On] under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)] and you switch from still  
photo shooting to movie shooting, the ISO speed will be H (equivalent to  
ISO 12800). When you switch back to still photo shooting, the ISO speed  
will be ISO 12800.  
Exposure compensation cannot be set.  
Changing the shutter speed or aperture during movie shooting is not  
recommended since the changes in the exposure will be recorded.  
If you change the shutter speed while shooting under fluorescent or LED  
lighting, image flicker may be recorded.  
When ISO Auto is set, you can press the <A> button to lock the ISO  
speed.  
If you press the <A> button and recompose the shot, you can see the  
exposure level difference on the exposure level indicator (p.239)  
compared to when the <A> button was pressed.  
By pressing the <B> button, you can display the histogram.  
When shooting a movie of a moving subject, a shutter speed of 1/30 sec.  
to 1/125 sec. is recommended. The faster the shutter speed, the less  
smooth the subject’s movement will look.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
238  
   
k Shooting Movies  
Information Display  
Each time you press the <B> button, the information display will  
change.  
AF method  
c : u+Tracking  
o : FlexiZone - Multi  
d : FlexiZone - Single  
Possible shots  
Movie shooting mode  
y: Autoexposure  
(Basic Zone  
Image-recording quality  
Movie shooting remaining time* / Elapsed time  
Battery check  
modes)  
k: Autoexposure  
(Creative Zone  
modes)  
AF point (FlexiZone - Single)  
Histogram (with manual exposure)  
z : Manual exposure  
Quick Control  
White balance /  
HDR movie  
shooting  
Drive mode  
Movie recording  
size  
Picture Style  
Frame rate  
Digital zoom  
Auto Lighting  
Optimizer  
Video snapshots  
LED light  
Exposure mode  
L :Autoexposure  
K :Manual  
exposure  
Movie Servo AF  
AE lock  
Magnified view  
Shutter speed  
Miniature effect movie  
Aperture  
Recording level: Manual  
ISO speed  
Eye-Fi card transmission status  
Digital compass  
Attenuator  
GPS connection indicator  
Exposure level indicator  
Highlight tone priority  
Wind filter: Disable  
* Applies to a single movie clip.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
239  
       
k Shooting Movies  
You can display the electronic level by pressing the <B> button  
(p.70). Note that if the AF method is set to [u+Tracking] or the camera  
is connected to a TV set with a cable, the electronic level cannot be  
displayed.  
The electronic level, grid lines, or histogram cannot be displayed during  
movie shooting. (The display will disappear when you start shooting a  
movie.)  
When movie shooting starts, the movie shooting remaining time will  
change to the elapsed time.  
Cautions for Movie Shooting  
Do not point the camera toward an intense light source, such as the sun  
or an intense artificial light source. Doing so may damage the image  
sensor or the camera’s internal components.  
If <Q> is set and the ISO speed or aperture changes during movie  
shooting, the white balance may also change.  
If you shoot a movie under fluorescent or LED lighting, the movie may  
flicker.  
Zooming the lens during movie shooting is not recommended. Zooming  
the lens can cause changes in the exposure regardless of whether the  
lens’s maximum aperture changes or not. Exposure changes may be  
recorded as a result.  
You cannot magnify the image during movie shooting.  
Be careful not to cover the built-in microphones (p.234) with your finger,  
etc.  
General Movie Shooting Cautions are on pages 268-269.  
If necessary, also read the General Live View Shooting Cautions on  
Do not hold the camera in the same position for long periods of time.  
Even if the camera does not feel too hot, prolonged contact with the same  
body part may cause skin redness, blistering or low-temperature contact  
burns. Using a tripod is recommended for people with circulation problems  
or very sensitive skin, or when using the camera in very hot places.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
240  
 
k Shooting Movies  
Movie-related settings are under the [Z1] and [Z2] tabs (p.263).  
A movie file is recorded each time you shoot a movie. If the file size  
exceeds 4 GB, a new file will be created for every subsequent 4 GB.  
The movie image’s field of view is approx. 100% (with movie recording  
size set to [A]).  
Stereo sound is recorded by the camera’s built-in microphones (p.234).  
Most external microphones (commercially available) equipped with a 3.5  
mm diameter mini plug can be used.  
You can use Remote Controller RC-6 (sold separately, p.366) to start and  
stop the movie shooting if the drive mode is < >. Set the shooting timing  
switch to < > (2-sec. delay), then press the transmit button. If the switch is  
set to < > (immediate shooting), still photo shooting will take effect.  
Q
2
o
With a fully-charged Battery Pack LP-E17, the total movie shooting time  
will be as follows: approx. 1 hr. 20 min. at room temperature (23°C/73°F),  
and approx. 1 hr. at low temperatures (0°C/32°F).  
The focus preset function is possible for movie shooting when using a  
(super) telephoto lens equipped with the focus preset mode, available  
since the second half of 2011.  
Final Image Simulation  
The final image simulation shows the results of the current settings for  
the Picture Style, white balance, etc., on the image.  
During movie shooting, the image displayed will automatically show the  
effects of the settings listed below.  
Final Image Simulation for Movie Shooting  
Picture Style  
*
All settings such as sharpness, contrast, color saturation, and color tone will be reflected.  
White balance  
White balance correction  
Exposure  
Depth of field  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
Peripheral illumination correction  
Chromatic aberration correction  
Highlight tone priority  
HDR movie  
Miniature effect movie  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
241  
 
k Shooting Movies  
Shooting Still Photos  
While shooting a movie, you can also  
take a still photo by pressing the shutter  
button completely.  
Taking Still Photos during Movie Shooting  
If you take a still photo during movie shooting, the movie will record  
a still moment lasting approx. 1 sec.  
The captured still photo will be recorded to the card, and the movie  
shooting will resume automatically when the Live View image is displayed.  
The movie and still photo will be recorded as separate files on the card.  
Functions particular to still photo shooting are shown below. Other  
functions will be the same as for movie shooting.  
Function  
Settings  
As set in [z1: Image quality].  
When the movie recording size is [1920x1080] or [1280x720], the  
aspect ratio will be 16:9. When the size is [640x480], the aspect  
ratio will be 4:3.  
Image-  
Recording  
Quality  
• With autoexposure shooting: Automatically set within ISO 100 -  
ISO 6400.  
• With manual exposure shooting: See “ISO Speed During Manual-  
exposure Shooting” on page 238.  
ISO Speed  
*
• With autoexposure shooting: Automatically-set shutter speed and  
aperture (displayed when pressing the shutter button halfway).  
• With manual exposure shooting: Manually-set shutter speed and  
aperture.  
Exposure  
Setting  
AEB  
Canceled  
Flash off  
Flash  
* If highlight tone priority is set, the ISO speed range will start from ISO 200.  
Regardless of the drive mode setting, single shooting will take effect for  
still photo shooting during movie shooting.  
The self-timer can be set before you start shooting a movie. During  
movie shooting, the camera will switch to single shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
242  
   
k Shooting Movies  
When you press the shutter button halfway to autofocus during movie  
shooting, the following phenomena may occur.  
• Focus may become far off momentarily.  
• The brightness of the recorded movie may change.  
• The recorded movie may be momentarily still.  
• The movie may record the lens operation noise.  
• You cannot shoot still photos when focus is not achieved, such as when  
the subject is moving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
243  
Shooting Function Settings  
Function settings particular to movie shooting are explained here.  
Q Quick Control  
If you press the <  
monitor, you can set any of the following: AF method  
Movie recording size Digital zoom Video snapshots, White balance,  
Q
> button while the image is displayed on the LCD  
,
Drive mode  
,
,
,
Picture Style, Auto Lighting Optimizer, and Miniature effect movie  
.
In Basic Zone modes, only the functions in bold can be set.  
Press the <Q> button (7).  
1
The settable functions will be  
displayed.  
[HDR Movie Shooting] is settable  
only in Basic Zone modes (p.249).  
Select a function and set it.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select a  
function.  
The selected function and Feature  
guide (p.73) will appear.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to set the  
function.  
To set the drive mode’s <q>, WB  
correction/WB bracketing, or Picture  
Style parameters, press the <B>  
button.  
2
3
Exit the setting.  
Press <0> to finalize the setting and  
return to movie shooting.  
You can also select <2> to return to  
movie shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
244  
       
3 Setting the Movie Recording Size  
With [Z2: Movie rec. size], you can  
set the movie recording size (image size,  
frame rate, and compression method)  
and other functions.  
Image Size  
L 1920x1080  
Full High-Definition (Full HD) recording quality. The aspect ratio is  
16:9.  
w 1280x720  
High-Definition (HD) recording quality. The aspect ratio is 16:9.  
x 640x480  
Standard-definition recording quality. The aspect ratio is 4:3.  
Frame Rate (fps: frames per second)  
D 29.97 fps/F 59.94 fps  
For areas where the TV format is NTSC (North America, Japan,  
South Korea, Mexico, etc.).  
C 25.00 fps/E 50.00 fps  
For areas where the TV format is PAL (Europe, Russia, China,  
Australia, etc.).  
B 23.98 fps  
Mainly for motion pictures.  
The frame rate displayed on the movie recording size screen switches  
depending on whether [53: Video system] is set to [NTSC] or [PAL].  
B (23.98 fps) can be selected only when [NTSC] is set.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
245  
                     
3 Setting the Movie Recording Size  
Compression Method  
Standard  
Compresses multiple frames at a time efficiently for recording.  
Light (v)  
The movie is recorded at a low bit rate for playback on various  
devices, resulting in a smaller file size than with [Standard].  
Therefore, you can shoot longer than with [Standard].  
If you change the [53: Video system] setting, set the movie recording size  
again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
246  
3 Setting the Movie Recording Size  
Total Movie Recording Time and File Size Per Minute  
(Approx.)  
Total Recording Time on Card  
Movie Recording Size  
File Size  
4 GB  
DCB Standard 17 min.  
8 GB  
16 GB  
L
[1920x  
1080]  
35 min.  
1 hr. 10 min. 216 MB/min.  
DC  
Light  
FE Standard 20 min.  
DC Light  
DC Standard 57 min.  
DC  
43 min.  
1 hr. 26 min. 2 hr. 53 min. 87 MB/min.  
40 min. 1 hr. 21 min. 187 MB/min.  
w
[1280x  
720]  
2 hr. 5 min. 4 hr. 10 min. 8 hr. 20 min. 30 MB/min.  
x
[640x  
480]  
1 hr. 55 min. 3 hr. 50 min. 66 MB/min.  
Light 2 hr. 43 min. 5 hr. 26 min. 10 hr. 53 min. 23 MB/min.  
HDR Movie Shooting [1280x720  
]
40 min.  
1 hr. 20 min. 2 hr. 40 min. 94 MB/min.  
Movie Files Exceeding 4 GB  
Even if you shoot a movie exceeding 4 GB, you can keep shooting  
without interruption.  
During movie shooting, approx. 30 sec. before the movie reaches the  
4 GB file size, the elapsed shooting time displayed in the movie  
shooting screen will start blinking. If you keep shooting until the movie  
file size exceeds 4 GB, a new movie file will be created automatically  
and the elapsed shooting time or time code will stop blinking.  
When you play back the movie, you will have to play each movie file  
individually. Movie files cannot be played back automatically in  
consecutive order. After the movie playback ends, select the next  
movie to be played back.  
Movie Shooting Time Limit  
The maximum recording time of one movie clip is 29 min. 59 sec. If  
the movie shooting time reaches 29 min. 59 sec., the movie shooting  
will stop automatically. You can start shooting a movie again by  
pressing the <A> button. (A new movie file starts being recorded.)  
An increase of the camera’s internal temperature may cause movie shooting  
to stop before the maximum recording time shown in the table above (p.268).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
247  
         
3 Using Movie Digital Zoom  
When the movie size is [1920x1080] (Full HD), you can shoot with an  
approx. 3x to 10x digital zoom.  
Select [Digital zoom].  
Under the [Z2] tab, select [Digital  
1
zoom], then press <0>.  
Select [Approx. 3-10x zoom].  
2
Select [Approx. 3-10x zoom], then  
press <0>.  
Press the <M> button to exit the  
menu and return to movie shooting.  
Use digital zoom.  
3
Press the <W> <X> keys.  
The digital zoom bar will appear.  
Press the <W> key to zoom in or  
press the <X> key to zoom out.  
When you press the shutter button  
halfway, the camera will focus with  
[FlexiZone - Single] (fixed at center).  
To cancel digital zoom, set [Disable]  
in step 2.  
Use a tripod to prevent camera shake.  
When movie digital zoom is set, the maximum ISO speed will be ISO  
6400 (it cannot be expanded to H: equivalent to ISO 12800). Also,  
magnified view is not possible.  
Since movie digital zoom processes the image digitally, the image will  
look rougher at higher magnifications. Noise, light spots, etc., may also  
become noticeable.  
When movie digital zoom is set, the scene icon will not be displayed.  
Also see “Shooting Conditions that Make Focusing Difficult” on page  
Still photo shooting is not possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
248  
     
Shooting HDR Movies  
You can shoot movies by reducing the clipped highlight details of bright  
areas even in high-contrast scenes. This function is settable in Basic  
Zone modes.  
Set the Mode Dial to a Basic Zone  
mode.  
1
Press the <Q> button (7).  
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
2
Select [4].  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
3
[4] (HDR Movie Shooting) on the  
screen’s right side.  
Select [Enable].  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
[Enable], then press <0>.  
For recording time and file sizes, see  
the table on page 247.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
249  
       
Shooting HDR Movies  
The recording size is fixed at [1280x720 29.97fps (Standard)] (it is fixed  
at [1280x720 25.00fps (Standard)] if [53: Video system] is set to  
[PAL]). If [HDR Movie Shooting: Disable] is set, the recording size will  
revert to the original setting.  
Since multiple frames are merged to create an HDR movie, a part of the  
movie may be distorted. During shooting while handholding the camera,  
the distortion caused by camera shake may be noticeable. Using a tripod  
is recommended.  
Note that even if a tripod is used for shooting, afterimages may be  
noticeable or noise may look increased during the HDR movie is played  
back frame-by-frame or in slow-motion compared to when it is played  
back normally.  
HDR movie shooting cannot be set if movie digital zoom, video snapshot,  
or Miniature effect movie is set.  
Still photo shooting is not possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
250  
Shooting Miniature Effect Movies  
You can shoot movies having a Miniature (diorama) effect. Select the  
playback speed and shoot.  
Press the <Q> button.  
The Quick Control screen will appear.  
1
Select [T].  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
2
[T] (Miniature effect movie) on the  
right of the screen.  
Select the playback speed.  
3
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
[5x], [10x], or [20x], then press <0>.  
Position the white frame over the  
4 part you want to look sharp.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to move the  
white frame over the part you want to  
look sharp.  
To switch the white frame’s vertical /  
horizontal orientation, press the <u>  
button (or tap [T] on the screen’s  
lower right).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
251  
     
Shooting Miniature Effect Movies  
Shoot the movie.  
5
The AF method will be FlexiZone -  
Single to focus on the center of the  
white frame.  
The white frame is not displayed  
while you shoot.  
Playback Speed and Length (for 1-minute movie)  
Speed  
O (5x)  
Playback Length  
Approx. 12 sec.  
Approx. 6 sec.  
Approx. 3 sec.  
P (10x)  
Q (20x)  
Sound will not be recorded.  
With Miniature effect movies, Movie Servo AF will not work.  
Miniature effect movie cannot be set if movie digital zoom, video  
snapshot, HDR movie shooting, 1+73, 1, or white balance  
bracketing is set.  
You cannot take still photos while shooting a Miniature effect movie.  
Miniature effect movies whose playback time is shorter than 1 sec.  
cannot be edited (p.306).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
252  
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
You can shoot a series of short movie clips lasting approx. 2 sec., 4  
sec., or 8 sec. called video snapshots. The video snapshots can be  
joined together into a single movie called a video snapshot album. You  
can thereby show quick highlights of a trip or event.  
A video snapshot album can also be played back together with  
Video Snapshot Album Concept  
Video  
Video  
Video  
snapshot 1  
snapshot 2  
snapshot x  
Video snapshot album  
Setting the Video Snapshot Shooting Duration  
Select [Video snapshot].  
1
Under the [Z2] tab, select [Video  
snapshot], then press <0>.  
Select [Enable].  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
253  
         
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Select [Album settings].  
Select [Album settings], then press  
<0>.  
3
Select [Create a new album].  
Select [Create a new album], then  
press <0>.  
4
5
6
Select the snapshot length.  
Press <0> and use the <W> <X>  
keys to select the snapshot’s length,  
then press <0>.  
Select [OK].  
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
Press the <M> button to exit the  
menu.  
A blue bar will appear to indicate the  
snapshot length.  
Go to “Creating a Video Snapshot  
Album” (p.255).  
Shooting duration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
254  
 
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Creating a Video Snapshot Album  
Shoot the first video snapshot.  
7
Press the <A> button, then shoot.  
The blue bar indicating the shooting  
duration will gradually decrease. After  
the set shooting duration elapses, the  
shooting stops automatically.  
The confirmation screen will appear  
Save as a video snapshot album.  
Select [J Save as album], then  
press <0>.  
8
The movie clip will be saved as the  
video snapshot album’s first video  
snapshot.  
Continue to shoot more video  
9 snapshots.  
Repeat step 7 to shoot the next video  
snapshot.  
Select [J Add to album], then press  
<0>.  
To create another video snapshot  
album, select [W Save as a new  
album].  
Repeat step 9 as necessary.  
Exit the video snapshot shooting.  
10  
Set [Video snapshot] to [Disable].  
To return to normal movie  
shooting, be sure to set [Disable].  
Press the <M> button to exit the  
menu, and return to the normal movie  
shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
255  
 
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Options in Steps 8 and 9  
Function  
Description  
J Save as album  
The movie clip will be saved as the video  
snapshot album’s first video snapshot.  
(Step 8)  
The video snapshot just recorded will be  
added to the album recorded immediately  
before.  
J Add to album  
(Step 9)  
A new video snapshot album is created  
and the movie clip is saved as the first  
video snapshot. The new album will be a  
different file from the previously recorded  
album.  
W Save as a new album  
(Step 9)  
The video snapshot just recorded will be  
played back. For playback operations,  
see the table on the next page.  
1 Playback video snapshot  
(Steps 8 and 9)  
r Do not save to album  
The video snapshot just recorded will be  
erased instead of being saved to the  
(Step 8)  
r Delete without saving to album album. Select [OK] on the confirmation  
(Step 9)  
dialog.  
If you want to shoot another video snapshot  
right after shooting one video snapshot, set  
[Show confirm msg] to [Disable]. This  
setting will allow you to immediately shoot the  
next video snapshot without the confirmation  
screen appearing after you shoot each time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
256  
 
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
[Playback video snapshot] Operations in Steps 8 and 9  
Function  
Playback Description  
By pressing <0>, you can play back or pause the video  
snapshot recorded immediately before.  
7 Play  
5 First frame  
Displays the first scene of the album’s first video snapshot.  
Each time you press <0>, the video snapshot skips back  
P Skip backward*  
3 Previous frame  
by a few seconds.  
Each time you press <0>, the previous frame is  
displayed. If you hold down <0>, it will rewind the movie.  
Each time you press <0>, the movie will play frame-by-  
frame. If you hold down <0>, it will fast forward the  
movie.  
6 Next frame  
Each time you press <0>, the video snapshot skips  
O Skip forward*  
4 Last frame  
forward by a few seconds.  
Displays the last scene of the album’s last video snapshot.  
Playback position  
mm’ ss”  
Playback time (minutes:seconds)  
You can adjust the built-in speaker’s (p.304) volume by  
9 Volume  
32  
turning the <6> dial.  
Pressing the <M> button returns to the previous  
screen.  
* With [Skip backward] and [Skip forward], the skipping length corresponds to  
the number of seconds set under [Video snapshot] (approx. 2 sec., 4 sec., or 8  
sec.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
257  
 
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Adding to an Existing Album  
Select [Add to existing album].  
1
Follow step 4 on page 254 to select  
[Add to existing album], then press  
<0>.  
Select an existing album.  
2
Turn the <5> dial to select an  
existing album, then press <0>.  
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
Certain video snapshot settings will  
change to match the existing album’s  
settings.  
Press the <M> button to exit the  
menu.  
The video snapshot shooting screen  
will appear.  
Shoot the video snapshot.  
3
See “Creating a Video Snapshot  
Album” (p.255) to shoot the video  
snapshot.  
You cannot select an album shot with another camera.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
258  
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Cautions for Shooting Video Snapshots  
You can add to an album only video snapshots with the same duration  
(approx. 2 sec., 4 sec., or 8 sec. each).  
Note that if you do any of the following while shooting video snapshots, a  
new album will be created for subsequent video snapshots.  
• Changing the [Movie rec. size].  
• Changing the [Sound rec.] setting from [Auto]/[Manual] to [Disable]  
or from [Disable] to [Auto]/[Manual].  
• Updating the firmware.  
You cannot take still photos while shooting a video snapshot.  
The shooting duration of a video snapshot is only approximate.  
Depending on the frame rate, the shooting duration displayed during  
playback may not be exact.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
259  
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Playing back an Album  
You can play back a video snapshot album in the same way as a normal  
Play back the movie.  
Press the <x> button to display an  
1
image.  
Select the album.  
2
In the single-image display, the  
[st] icon displayed on the upper  
left of the screen indicates a video  
snapshot album.  
Turn the <5> dial to select an  
album.  
Play back the album.  
Press <0>.  
On the movie playback panel  
displayed, select [7] (Play), then  
press <0>.  
3
Background Music  
You can play background music when you play back albums, normal  
movies, and slide shows on the camera (p.305, 308). To play  
background music, you must first copy the background music to the card  
using EOS Utility (EOS software). For information on how to copy the  
background music, refer to the EOS Utility Instruction Manual (p.422).  
Music recorded on the memory card must be used only for private  
enjoyment. Do not violate the rights of the copyright holder.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
260  
 
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Editing an Album  
After shooting, you can rearrange, delete, or play back the video  
snapshots in the album.  
Select [X].  
On the movie playback panel  
1
displayed, select [X] (Edit), then  
press <0>.  
The editing screen will be displayed.  
Select an editing operation.  
2
Select an editing option, then press  
<0>.  
Function  
Description  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select the video snapshot  
you want to move, then press <0>. Press the <Y>  
<Z> keys to move the snapshot, then press <0>.  
T Move snapshot  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select the video snapshot  
you want to delete, then press <0>. The [L] icon will  
L Delete snapshot be displayed on the selected video snapshot. Pressing  
<0> again will cancel the selection and [L] will  
disappear.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select the video snapshot  
7 Play snapshot  
you want to play, then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
261  
3 Shooting Video Snapshots  
Save the edited album.  
3
Press the <M> button to return to  
the Editing panel at the screen’s  
bottom.  
Select [W] (Save), then press <0>.  
The save screen will appear.  
To save it as a new album, select  
[New file]. To save it and overwrite  
the original album, select  
[Overwrite], then press <0>.  
If the card does not have enough free space, [New file] will not be  
available.  
When the battery level is low, editing albums is not possible. Use a fully-  
charged battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
262  
3 Menu Function Settings  
Z1  
When you set the power switch to <k>,  
the [Z1] and [Z2] tabs will show  
functions dedicated to movie shooting.  
AF method  
The AF methods are the same as described on pages 218-225. You  
can select [u+Tracking], [FlexiZone - Multi], or [FlexiZone -  
Single].  
Movie Servo AF  
During movie shooting, the camera focuses on the subject  
continuously. The default setting is [Enable].  
When [Enable] is set:  
The camera focuses on the subject continuously even when you  
are not pressing the shutter button halfway.  
Since this drives the lens continuously, it will consume battery  
power and shorten the total possible movie shooting time (p.247).  
With certain lenses, the lens operation noise during focusing may  
be recorded. If this happens, use an external microphone  
(commercially available) to reduce lens operation noise in the  
movie. Also, using certain STM lenses (for example, the EF-S18-  
135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM) will reduce lens operation noise.  
If you want to set the lens’s focus mode switch to <MF> during  
Movie Servo AF, first set the power switch to <1>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
263  
             
3 Menu Function Settings  
If you want to keep the focus at a specific point, or if you do not  
want the lens operation noise to be recorded, you can temporarily  
stop Movie Servo AF as follows. When you stop Movie Servo AF,  
the AF point will turn gray. When you perform the same steps  
below, Movie Servo AF will resume.  
• Press the <D> button.  
Tap the [P] icon on the lower left of the screen.  
• If [10: Shutter/AE lock button] is set to [2: AF/AF lock, no AE  
lock] in the [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], you can pause the  
Movie Servo AF while holding down the <A> button. When you  
let go of the <A> button, Movie Servo AF will resume.  
When Movie Servo AF is paused, if you return to movie shooting  
after pressing the <M> or <x> button, Movie Servo AF will  
resume.  
When [Disable] is set:  
Press the shutter button halfway to focus.  
Cautions When [Movie Servo AF] is Set to [Enable]  
Shooting Conditions that Make Focusing Difficult  
• A fast-moving subject approaching or moving away from the camera.  
• A subject moving at a close distance in front of the camera.  
• Also see “Shooting Conditions that Make Focusing Difficult” on page  
Movie Servo AF will pause during zooming or in magnified view.  
During movie shooting, if a subject approaches or moves away or if the  
camera is moved vertically or horizontally (panning), the recorded movie  
image may momentarily expand or contract (change in image  
magnification).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
264  
3 Menu Function Settings  
AF with shutter button during movie recording  
While shooting a movie, you can also take a still photo by pressing  
the shutter button completely. By default, AF operation is set to  
[One-Shot AF].  
When [One-Shot AF] is set:  
You can refocus and shoot a still photo by pressing the shutter  
button halfway while shooting a movie.  
• When shooting a still subject, you can perform shooting in  
precise focus.  
When [Disable] is set:  
You can immediately start shooting a still photo by pressing the  
shutter button, even though focus is not achieved. This is  
effective when you want to give priority to the shooting  
opportunity rather than to focusing.  
Grid display  
With [Grid 1l] or [Grid 2m], you can display grid lines. You can  
check horizontal or vertical tilt when shooting.  
Metering timerK  
You can change how long the exposure setting is displayed (AE lock  
time).  
Z2  
Movie recording size  
You can set the movie recording size (image size, frame rate, and  
compression method). For details, see pages 245-247.  
Digital zoom  
You can use digital zoom for telephoto shooting. For details, see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
265  
             
3 Menu Function Settings  
Sound recording J  
Normally, the built-in microphones will  
record stereo sound. If a commercially-  
available external stereo microphone  
equipped with a mini plug (3.5 mm  
diameter) is connected to the camera’s  
external microphone IN terminal (p.26), it  
will be given priority.  
Level meter  
[Sound rec./Rec. level] options  
[Auto] : The sound-recording level is adjusted automatically.  
Auto level control will operate automatically in  
response to the sound level.  
[Manual] : For advanced users. You can adjust the sound-  
recording level to one of 64 levels.  
Select [Rec. level] and look at the level meter while  
pressing the <Y> <Z> keys to adjust the sound-  
recording level. Look at the peak hold indicator  
(approx. 3 sec.), and adjust so that the level meter  
sometimes lights up on the right of the “12” (-12 dB)  
mark for the loudest sounds. If it exceeds “0”, the  
sound will be distorted.  
[Disable] : Sound will not be recorded.  
[Wind filter]  
When set to [Auto], it reduces wind noise when there is wind  
outdoors. This feature takes effect only with the built-in  
microphones. When the wind filter function takes effect, low bass  
sounds will also be reduced.  
[Attenuator]  
Even if you set [Sound recording] to [Auto] or [Manual] before  
shooting, sound distortion may still result if there is a very loud  
sound. In such a case, setting it to [Enable] is recommended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
266  
           
3 Menu Function Settings  
In Basic Zone modes, the settings available for [Sound recording] will  
be [On] or [Off]. If [On] is set, the sound-recording level will be adjusted  
automatically (same as with [Auto]), and the wind filter function will take  
effect.  
The sound volume balance between L (left) and R (right) cannot be  
adjusted.  
Both L and R record audio at a 48 kHz/16-bit sampling rate.  
Video snapshots  
You can shoot video snapshots. For details, see page 253.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
267  
General Movie Shooting Cautions  
White <s> and Red <E> Internal Temperature Warning Icons  
If the camera’s internal temperature increases due to prolonged movie  
shooting or under a high ambient temperature, a white <s> or red <E>  
icon will appear.  
The white <s> icon indicates that the image quality of still photos will  
deteriorate. It is recommended that you stop still photo shooting for a  
while and allow the camera to cool down. Since movie image quality will  
hardly be affected, you can still shoot movies.  
The red <E> icon indicates that movie shooting will soon be terminated  
automatically. If this happens, you will not be able to shoot again until the  
camera’s internal temperature decreases. Turn off the power and let the  
camera rest for a while.  
Shooting a movie at a high temperature for a prolonged period will cause  
the <s> or <E> icon to appear earlier. When you are not shooting,  
always turn off the camera.  
Recording and Image Quality  
If the attached lens has an Image Stabilizer and you set the Image Stabilizer  
(IS) switch to < >, the Image Stabilizer will operate at all times even if you  
1
do not press the shutter button halfway. The Image Stabilizer consumes  
battery power and may shorten the total movie shooting time or decrease  
the number of possible shots. If you use a tripod or if the Image Stabilizer is  
not necessary, it is recommended to set the IS switch to <  
2>.  
The camera’s built-in microphones will also pick up camera operation  
noise. Use an external microphone (commercially available) to reduce  
camera operation noise in the movie.  
Do not connect anything other than an external microphone to the  
camera’s external microphone IN terminal.  
If the brightness changes during autoexposure movie shooting, the movie  
may freeze temporarily. In such cases, shoot movies with manual  
exposure.  
If there is a very bright light source in the image, the bright area may  
appear black on the LCD monitor. The movie will be recorded almost  
exactly as it appears on the LCD monitor.  
In low light, noise or irregular colors may appear in the image. The movie  
will be recorded almost exactly as it appears on the LCD monitor.  
If you play back a movie with other devices, image or sound quality may  
deteriorate or playback may not be possible (even if the devices support  
MP4 format).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
268  
       
General Movie Shooting Cautions  
Recording and Image Quality  
If you use a card with a slow writing speed, a five-level  
indicator may appear on the right of the screen during movie  
shooting. It indicates how much data has not yet been  
written to the card (remaining capacity of the internal buffer  
memory). The slower the card, the faster the indicator will  
climb upward. If the indicator becomes full, movie shooting  
will stop automatically.  
Indicator  
If the card has a fast writing speed, the indicator will either  
not appear or the level (if displayed) will hardly go upward.  
First, shoot a few test movies to see if the card can write fast enough.  
Still Photo Shooting During Movie Shooting  
Regarding the image quality of still photos, see “Image Quality” on page  
Playback and TV Connection  
If you connect the camera to a TV set (p.312-315) and shoot a movie,  
the TV set will not output any sound during the shooting. However, the  
sound will be properly recorded.  
Restrictions on MP4-format Movies  
Note that generally the following restrictions apply to MP4-format movies.  
Sound will not be recorded on approx. the last two frames.  
When you play back movies on Windows, images and sound may  
become slightly out of synchronization.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
269  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
Handy Features  
Disabling the Beeper (p.272)  
Card Reminder (p.272)  
Setting the Image Review Time (p.273)  
Setting the Auto Power-off Time (p.273)  
Adjusting the LCD Monitor Brightness (p.274)  
Creating and Selecting a Folder (p.275)  
File Numbering Methods (p.277)  
Setting Copyright Information (p.279)  
Auto Rotation of Vertical Images (p.281)  
Reverting the Camera to the Default Settings (p.282)  
Preventing the LCD Monitor from Turning Off Automatically  
Changing the Shooting Settings Screen Color (p.285)  
Automatic Sensor Cleaning (p.286)  
Appending Dust Delete Data (p.287)  
Manual Sensor Cleaning (p.289)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
271  
 
Handy Features  
3 Disabling the Beeper  
You can prevent the beeper from sounding when focus is achieved  
during self-timer shooting and touch screen operations.  
Under the [z1] tab, select [Beep], then  
press <0>. Select [Disable], then press  
<0>.  
To silence the beeper only during touch  
screen operations, select [Touch to y].  
3 Card Reminder  
This setting prevents shooting if there is no card in the camera.  
Under the [z1] tab, select [Release  
shutter without card], then press <0>.  
Select [Disable], then press <0>.  
If there is no card inserted in the camera  
and you press the shutter button, “Card”  
will be displayed in the viewfinder and on  
the LCD panel, and you cannot release  
the shutter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
272  
                 
Handy Features  
3 Setting the Image Review Time  
You can set how long the image is displayed on the LCD monitor just  
after shooting. If [Off] is set, the image will not be displayed just after  
shooting. If [Hold] is set, the image review will be displayed up until the  
[Auto power off] time has elapsed.  
During image review, if you operate any camera controls such as  
pressing the shutter button halfway, the image review will end.  
Under the [z1] tab, select [Image  
review], then press <0>. Select the  
desired setting, then press <0>.  
3 Setting the Auto Power-off Time  
To save battery power, the camera turns off automatically after the set  
time of idle operation elapses. You can set this auto power-off time.  
When the camera is turned off due to auto power off, you can turn it on  
again by pressing the shutter button, etc.  
If [Disable] is set, either turn off the camera or press the <B>  
button to turn off the LCD monitor to save battery power.  
Even when [Disable] is set, if the camera is not used for 30 min.,  
the LCD monitor will turn off automatically. To turn on the LCD  
monitor again, press the <B> button.  
Under the [52] tab, select [Auto power  
off], then press <0>. Select the desired  
setting, then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
273  
               
Handy Features  
3 Adjusting the LCD Monitor Brightness  
You can adjust the brightness of the LCD monitor to make it easier to  
read.  
Under the [52] tab, select [LCD  
brightness], then press <0>. Press the  
<Y> <Z> keys to adjust the brightness  
on the adjustment screen, then press  
<0>.  
When checking the exposure of an  
image, set the LCD monitor brightness to  
4 and prevent the ambient light from  
affecting the image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
274  
     
Handy Features  
3 Creating and Selecting a Folder  
You can freely create and select the folder where the captured images  
are to be saved.  
This operation is optional since a folder will be created automatically for  
saving captured images.  
Creating a Folder  
Select [Select folder].  
1
Under the [51] tab, select [Select  
folder], then press <0>.  
Select [Create folder].  
2
Select [Create folder], then press  
<0>.  
Create a new folder.  
3
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
A new folder with the folder number  
increased by one is created.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
275  
     
Handy Features  
Selecting a Folder  
With the folder selection screen  
displayed, select a folder and press  
<0>.  
Lowest file number  
Number of images in folder  
The folder where the captured  
images will be saved is selected.  
Subsequent captured images will be  
recorded into the selected folder.  
Folder name  
Highest file number  
Folders  
As with “100CANON” for example, the folder name starts with three digits  
(the folder number) followed by five alphanumeric characters. A folder can  
contain up to 9999 images (file number 0001 - 9999). When a folder  
becomes full, a new folder with the folder number increased by one is  
created automatically. Also, if manual reset (p.278) is executed, a new  
folder will be created automatically. Folders numbered from 100 to 999 can  
be created.  
Creating Folders with a Computer  
With the card open on the screen, create a new folder named “DCIM”. Open  
the DCIM folder and create as many folders as necessary to save and  
organize your images. The folder name must follow the format  
100ABC_D”. The first three digits are the folder number, from 100 to 999.  
The last five characters can be any combination of upper- and lower-case  
letters from A to Z, numerals, and the underscore “_”. The space cannot be  
used. Also note that two folder names cannot share the same three-digit  
folder number (for example, “100ABC_D” and “100W_XYZ”), even if the last  
five characters in each name are different.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
276  
Handy Features  
3 File Numbering Methods  
The image files will be numbered from 0001 to 9999 in the order the  
images are taken, then saved in a folder. You can change how the file  
number is assigned.  
The file number will appear on your computer in this format:  
IMG_0001.JPG.  
Under the [51] tab, select [File  
numbering], then press <0>. The  
available settings are described below.  
Select the option, then press <0>.  
[Continuous]: The file numbering continues in sequence even  
after you replace the card or create a folder.  
Even after you replace the card or create a new folder, the file  
numbering continues in sequence up to 9999. This is convenient  
when you want to save images numbered anywhere between 0001  
to 9999 on multiple cards or in multiple folders into one folder on  
your computer.  
If the replacement card or existing folder already contains images  
recorded previously, the file numbering of the new images may  
continue from the file numbering of the existing images on the card  
or in the folder. If you want to use continuous file numbering, it is  
recommended that you use a newly-formatted card each time.  
File numbering after  
replacing the card  
File numbering after  
creating a folder  
Card-1  
Card-2  
Card-1  
100  
101  
0051  
0052  
0051  
0052  
Next sequential file number  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
277  
       
Handy Features  
[Auto reset]: The file numbering restarts from 0001 each time  
the card is replaced or a new folder is created.  
When you replace the card or create a folder, the file numbering  
restarts from 0001 for the new images saved. This is convenient if  
you want to organize images by cards or folders.  
If the replacement card or existing folder already contains images  
recorded previously, the file numbering of the new images may  
continue from the file numbering of the existing images on the card  
or in the folder. If you want to save images with the file numbering  
starting from 0001, use a newly formatted card each time.  
File numbering after  
replacing the card  
File numbering after  
creating a folder  
Card-1  
Card-2  
Card-1  
100  
101  
0051  
0001  
0051  
0001  
File numbering is reset  
[Manual reset]: To reset the file numbering to 0001 manually or  
to start from file number 0001 in a new folder.  
When you reset the file numbering manually, a new folder is created  
automatically and the file numbering of images saved to that folder  
starts from 0001.  
This is convenient if you want to use different folders for the images  
taken yesterday and the ones taken today, for example. After the  
manual reset, the file numbering returns to continuous or auto reset.  
(There will be no manual reset confirmation dialog.)  
If the file number in folder 999 reaches 9999, shooting will not be possible  
even if the card still has storage capacity. The LCD monitor will display a  
message telling you to replace the card. Replace it with a new card.  
For both JPEG and RAW images, the file name will start with “IMG_”. Movie  
file names will start with “MVI_”. The extension will be “.JPG” for JPEG  
images, “.CR2” for RAW images, and “.MP4” for movies.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
278  
         
Handy Features  
3 Setting Copyright InformationK  
When you set the copyright information, it will be appended to the  
image as Exif information.  
Select [Copyright information].  
1
Under the [54] tab, select [Copyright  
information], then press <0>.  
Select the option to be set.  
2
Select [Enter author’s name] or  
[Enter copyright details], then press  
<0>.  
The text entry screen will appear.  
Select [Display copyright info.] to  
check the copyright information  
currently set.  
Select [Delete copyright  
information] to delete the copyright  
information currently set.  
Enter text.  
See “Text Entry Procedure” on the  
3
next page and enter the copyright  
information.  
Enter up to 63 alphanumeric  
characters and symbols.  
Exit the setting.  
4
After entering the text, press the  
<M> button to exit.  
On the confirmation dialog, select  
[OK], then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
279  
     
Handy Features  
Text Entry Procedure  
Changing the Entry Area:  
Press the <Q> button to toggle  
between the top and bottom entry  
areas.  
Moving the Cursor:  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys in the top  
area to move the cursor.  
Entering Text:  
In the bottom area, press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z> keys to select  
a character, then press <0> to enter it.  
Changing the Entry Mode:*  
Select [E] at the bottom right of the bottom entry area. Each  
time you press <0>, the entry mode will change as follows: Lower  
case 9 Numerals / Symbols 1 9 Numerals / Symbols 2 9 Upper  
case.  
* When [Touch control: Disable] is set, you can enter all characters on one  
screen.  
Deleting a Character:  
Press the <L> button to delete one character.  
Finishing the Text Entry:  
Press the <M> button, check the text, select [OK], then press  
<0>. The screen in step 2 will reappear.  
Canceling the Text Entry:  
Press the <B> button, check the text, select [OK], then press  
<0>. The screen in step 2 will reappear.  
You can also set or check the copyright information with EOS Utility (EOS  
software, p.420).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
280  
Handy Features  
3 Auto Rotation of Vertical Images  
Vertical images are rotated automatically so they  
are displayed vertically on the camera’s LCD  
monitor and on the computer instead of horizontally.  
You can change the setting for this feature.  
Under the [51] tab, select [Auto rotate],  
then press <0>. The available settings  
are described below. Select the option,  
then press <0>.  
[OnzD] : The vertical image is automatically rotated during playback  
on both the camera’s LCD monitor and on the computer.  
[OnD]  
: The vertical image is automatically rotated only on the  
computer.  
[Off]  
: The vertical image is not automatically rotated.  
FAQ  
The vertical image is not rotated during the image review just  
after shooting.  
Press the <x> button and the image playback will display the rotated image.  
[OnzD] is set, but the image does not rotate during playback.  
Auto rotate will not work with vertical images captured while [Auto  
rotate] was set to [Off]. If the vertical image is taken while the camera  
is pointed up or down, the image may not be rotated automatically for  
playback. In such a case, see “Rotating the Image” on page 297.  
On the camera’s LCD monitor, I want to rotate an image  
captured when [OnD] had been set.  
Set [OnzD], then play back the image. It will be rotated.  
The vertical image does not rotate on the computer screen.  
The software used is not compatible with image rotation. Use EOS  
software instead.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
281  
       
Handy Features  
3 Reverting the Camera to the Default SettingsK  
The camera’s shooting function settings and menu settings can be  
reverted to their defaults. This option is available in Creative Zone  
modes.  
Select [Clear settings].  
1
Under the [54] tab, select [Clear  
settings], then press <0>.  
Select [Clear all camera settings].  
2
Select [Clear all camera settings],  
then press <0>.  
Select [OK].  
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
Setting [Clear all camera settings]  
will reset the camera to the default  
settings as shown on pages 283-284.  
3
FAQ  
Clearing all camera settings  
After the procedure above, select [Clear all Custom Func. (C.Fn)]  
in [54: Clear settings] to clear all the Custom Function settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
282  
     
Handy Features  
Shooting Function Settings  
Image Recording Settings  
<8> mode  
C (Kids)  
Image quality  
Picture Style  
73  
AF operation  
One-Shot AF  
Auto  
Auto  
selection:19 pt  
AF  
AF area selection  
mode  
Auto Lighting  
Optimizer  
Standard  
u (Single  
shooting)  
Drive mode  
Peripheral  
illumination  
correction  
Enable /  
Correction  
data retained  
q (Evaluative  
metering)  
Metering mode  
Chromatic  
aberration  
correction  
Enable /  
Correction  
data retained  
ISO speed  
ISO Auto  
AUTO (Auto)  
Maximum 6400  
Exposure  
compensation /  
AEB  
Canceled  
Disable /  
Correction  
data retained  
Distortion  
correction  
Flash exposure  
compensation  
0 (Zero)  
Red-eye reduction Disable  
Color space  
sRGB  
Anti-flicker  
Disable  
White balance  
Q (Auto)  
shooting  
Custom White  
Balance  
Aspect ratio  
3 : 2  
Canceled  
Canceled  
Canceled  
White balance  
correction  
Display only  
flicker detection  
Viewfinder display  
White balance  
bracketing  
Custom Functions Unchanged  
Long exposure  
noise reduction  
Disable  
Flash control  
Flash firing  
Enable  
High ISO speed  
noise reduction  
Standard  
E-TTL II flash  
metering  
Evaluative flash  
metering  
File numbering  
Auto cleaning  
Dust Delete Data  
Continuous  
Enable  
Flash sync.  
speed in Av mode  
Auto  
Erase  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
283  
   
Handy Features  
Camera Settings  
Live View Shooting Settings  
Live View  
Auto power off  
30 sec.  
Enable  
Enable  
Enable  
shooting  
Beep  
AF method  
u+Tracking  
Enable  
Release shutter  
without card  
Continuous AF  
Image review  
2 sec.  
Touch Shutter  
Grid display  
Disable  
Off  
AF point display  
Disable  
Histogram display Brightness  
Metering timer  
8 sec.  
Image jump with  
6
e (10 images)  
Auto rotate  
LCD brightness  
LCD auto off  
Date/Time/Zone  
OnzD  
Movie Shooting Settings  
AF method u+Tracking  
Movie Servo AF Enable  
Enable  
AF with shutter  
button during  
movie recording  
Unchanged  
Unchanged  
Unchanged  
One-Shot AF  
Language  
Video system  
Grid display  
Off  
Metering timer  
8 sec.  
All items  
selected  
B button display  
options  
NTSC:  
LD (Standard)  
PAL:  
Screen color  
Feature guide  
Touch control  
1
Movie recording  
size  
Enable  
Standard  
LC (Standard)  
Copyright information Unchanged  
Control over HDMI Disable  
Eye-Fi transmission Disable  
Digital zoom  
Disable  
Sound recording Auto  
Video snapshot Disable  
My Menu settings  
Unchanged  
Display from My Menu Disable  
Wi-Fi/NFC  
Disable  
Wi-Fi function  
Unchanged  
For Wi-Fi/NFC settings, refer to the Wi-Fi/NFC Function Instruction Manual.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
284  
 
Handy Features  
3
Preventing the LCD Monitor from Turning Off Automatically  
You can prevent the display-off sensor from turning off the LCD monitor  
when your eye approaches the viewfinder.  
Under the [52] tab, select [LCD auto  
off], then press <0>. Select [Disable],  
then press <0>.  
When Angle Finder C (sold separately) is attached to the viewfinder, set it to  
[Disable]. If [Enable] is set, the LCD monitor may remain off.  
3 Changing the Shooting Settings Screen Color  
You can change the background color of the shooting settings screen.  
Under the [53] tab, select [Screen  
color], then press <0>. Select the  
desired color, then press <0>.  
When you exit the menu, the shooting  
settings screen based in the selected  
color will be displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
285  
         
f Automatic Sensor Cleaning  
Whenever you set the power switch to <1> or <2>, the Self  
Cleaning Sensor Unit operates to automatically shake off the dust on  
the front of the sensor. Normally, you need not pay attention to this  
operation. However, you can choose to perform sensor cleaning  
manually, or disable it.  
Cleaning the Sensor Now  
Select [Sensor cleaning].  
1
Under the [53] tab, select [Sensor  
cleaning], then press <0>.  
Select [Clean nowf].  
2
Select [Clean nowf], then press  
<0>.  
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
The screen will indicate that the  
sensor is being cleaned. (A small  
sound may be heard.) Although there  
will be a shutter sound, no picture is  
taken.  
For best results, perform the sensor cleaning with the camera placed  
upright and stable on a table or other flat surface.  
Even if you repeat the sensor cleaning, the result will not improve much.  
Immediately after the sensor cleaning is finished, the [Clean nowf]  
option remains disabled temporarily.  
Disabling Automatic Sensor Cleaning  
In step 2, select [Auto cleaningf] and set it to [Disable].  
The sensor cleaning will no longer be executed when you set the  
power switch to <1> or <2>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
286  
         
3 Appending Dust Delete DataK  
Normally, the Self Cleaning Sensor Unit will eliminate most of the dust  
that may be visible on captured images. However, in case visible dust  
still remains, you can append the Dust Delete Data to the image for  
erasing the dust spots later. The Dust Delete Data is used by Digital  
Photo Professional (EOS software, p.420) to erase the dust spots  
automatically.  
Preparation  
Prepare a solid white object such as a sheet of paper.  
Set the lens focal length to 50 mm or longer.  
Set the lens focus mode switch to <MF> and set the focus to infinity  
(u). If the lens has no distance scale, rotate the camera to face  
towards you and turn the focusing ring clockwise all the way.  
Obtaining the Dust Delete Data  
Select [Dust Delete Data].  
1
Under the [z3] tab, select [Dust  
Delete Data], then press <0>.  
Select [OK].  
Select [OK] and press <0>. After  
2
the automatic self-cleaning of the  
sensor is performed, a message will  
appear. Although there will be a  
shutter sound during the cleaning, no  
picture is taken.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
287  
     
3 Appending Dust Delete DataK  
Shoot a solid-white object.  
3
At a distance of 20 cm - 30 cm (0.7 ft.  
- 1.0 ft.), fill the viewfinder with a  
patternless, solid-white object and  
take a picture.  
The picture will be taken in aperture-  
priority AE mode at an aperture of f/22.  
Since the image will not be saved, the  
data can still be obtained even if there  
is no card in the camera.  
When the picture is taken, the camera  
will start collecting the Dust Delete  
Data. When the Dust Delete Data is  
obtained, a message will appear.  
Select [OK] and the menu will  
reappear.  
If the data is not obtained successfully,  
an error message will appear. Follow  
the “Preparation” procedure on the  
preceding page, then select [OK]. Take  
the picture again.  
Dust Delete Data  
After the Dust Delete Data is obtained, it is appended to all the JPEG  
and RAW images captured thereafter. Before an important shoot, it is  
recommended to update the Dust Delete Data by obtaining it again.  
For details about using Digital Photo Professional (EOS software) to  
erase dust spots, refer to the Digital Photo Professional Instruction  
Manual (p.422).  
The Dust Delete Data appended to the image is so small that it hardly  
affects the image file size.  
Be sure to use a solid-white object such as a new sheet of white paper. If the  
object has any pattern or design, it may be recognized as dust data and  
affect the accuracy of the dust deletion with EOS software.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
288  
3 Manual Sensor CleaningK  
Dust that could not be removed by the automatic sensor cleaning can  
be removed manually with a commercially-available blower, etc. Before  
cleaning the sensor, detach the lens from the camera.  
The image sensor is extremely delicate. If the sensor needs to be  
cleaned directly, having it done by a Canon Service Center is  
recommended.  
Select [Sensor cleaning].  
1
Under the [53] tab, select [Sensor  
cleaning], then press <0>.  
Select [Clean manually].  
2
Select [Clean manually], then press  
<0>.  
Select [OK].  
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
In a moment, the reflex mirror will  
lockup and the shutter will open.  
CLn” will blink on the LCD panel.  
3
Clean the sensor.  
4
End the cleaning.  
5
Set the power switch to <2>.  
If you use a battery, make sure it is fully charged.  
For the power source, using AC Adapter Kit ACK-E18 (sold separately) is  
recommended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
289  
     
3 Manual Sensor CleaningK  
While cleaning the sensor, never do any of the following. If the  
power is cut off, the shutter will close and the shutter curtains and  
image sensor may get damaged.  
Setting the power switch to <2>.  
Removing or inserting the battery.  
The surface of the image sensor is extremely delicate. Clean the sensor  
with care.  
Use a plain blower without any brush attached. A brush can scratch the  
sensor.  
Do not insert the blower tip inside the camera beyond the lens mount. If  
the power is turned off, the shutter will close and the shutter curtains or  
reflex mirror may get damaged.  
Never use pressurized air or gas to clean the sensor. The blowing force  
can damage the sensor, or the spray gas can freeze on the sensor and  
scratch it.  
If the battery level becomes low while cleaning the sensor, the beeper  
will sound as a warning. Stop cleaning the sensor.  
If a smudge that cannot be removed with a blower remains, having the  
sensor cleaned by a Canon Service Center is recommended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
290  
10  
Image Playback  
This chapter explains functions related to viewing  
photos and movies, with more advanced uses than in  
Chapter 2 “Basic Shooting and Image Playback”. Here  
you will find explanations of how to play back and erase  
photos and movies with the camera and view them on a  
TV set.  
Images shot and saved with another device  
The camera may not be able to properly display images captured  
with a different camera, edited with a computer, or that have had their  
file names changed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
291  
       
x Searching for Images Quickly  
H
Displaying Multiple Images on One Screen (Index Display)  
Search for images quickly with the index display showing 4, 9, 36, or  
100 images on one screen.  
Play back the image.  
When you press the <x> button, the  
1
last image captured will be displayed.  
Switch to the index display.  
2
Press the <I> button.  
The 4-image index display will  
appear. The selected image is  
highlighted with an orange frame.  
Pressing the <I> button will  
switch the display as follows: 9  
images 9 36 images 9 100 images.  
Pressing the <u> button will switch  
the display as follows: 100 images 9  
36 images 9 9 images 9 4 images  
9 1 image.  
Select an image.  
3
Turn the <5> dial to move the  
orange frame and select the image.  
You can also press the <W> <X> or  
<Y> <Z> keys to select the image.  
Turning the <6> dial will display  
image(s) on the next or previous  
screen.  
Press <0> in the index display to  
display the selected image in the  
single-image display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
292  
         
x Searching for Images Quickly  
I Jumping through Images (Jump Display)  
In the single-image display, you can turn the <6> dial to jump through  
the images forward or backward according to the jump method set.  
Select [Image jump w/6].  
1
Under the [x2] tab, select [Image  
jump w/6], then press <0>.  
Select the jump method.  
2
Turn the <5> dial to select the jump  
method, then press <0>.  
d: Display images one by one  
e: Jump 10 images  
f: Jump 100 images  
g: Display by date  
h: Display by folder  
i: Display movies only  
j: Display stills only  
k: Display by image rating (p.298)  
Turn the <6> dial to select.  
Browse by jumping.  
3
Press the <x> button to play back  
images.  
In the single-image display, turn the  
Jump method  
Playback position  
<6> dial.  
You can browse images with the  
method that was set.  
To search images by shooting date, select [Date].  
To search images by folder, select [Folder].  
If the card contains both movies and still photos, select [Movies] or  
[Stills] to display only one or the other.  
If no images match the selected [Rating], you cannot browse through the  
images with the <6> dial.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
293  
   
u/y Magnified View  
You can magnify a captured image by approx. 1.5x to 10x on the LCD  
monitor.  
Magnify the image.  
Press the <u> button during image  
1
playback.  
The image will be magnified.  
If you hold down the <u> button, the  
image will be magnified until it  
reaches the maximum magnification.  
Press the <I> button to reduce  
the magnification. If you hold down  
the button, the magnification will be  
reduced to the single-image display.  
Magnified area position  
Scroll around the image.  
2
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z>  
keys to scroll the magnified image in  
the direction pressed.  
To exit magnified view, press the  
<x> button and the single-image  
display will reappear.  
In magnified view, you can turn the <5> dial to view another image at  
the same magnification.  
The image cannot be magnified during the image review just after  
shooting.  
A movie cannot be magnified.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
294  
   
d Playing Back with the Touch Screen  
The LCD monitor is a touch-sensitive panel that you can touch with your  
fingers for various playback operations. First, press the <x> button  
to play back images.  
Browsing Images  
Swipe with one finger.  
With single-image display, touch the  
LCD monitor with one finger. You  
can browse to the next or previous  
image by swiping your finger to the  
left or right.  
Swipe to the left to see the next  
(newer) image, or swipe to the right to  
see the previous (older) image.  
With index display, also touch the  
LCD monitor with one finger. You  
can browse to the next or previous  
screen by swiping your finger up or  
down.  
Swipe up to see the next (newer)  
images or swipe down to see the  
previous (older) images.  
When you select an image, the  
orange frame will appear. Tap on the  
image again to display it as a single  
image.  
Jumping through Images (Jump Display)  
Swipe with two fingers.  
Touch the LCD monitor with two fingers.  
When you swipe two fingers to the left or  
right, you can jump through images with  
the method set in [Image jump w/6]  
under the [x2] tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
295  
   
d Playing Back with the Touch Screen  
Reducing Image (Index Display)  
Pinch two fingers.  
Touch the screen with two fingers spread  
apart, and pinch your fingers together on  
the screen.  
Each time you pinch your fingers, the  
single-image display will change to  
the index display.  
When you select an image, the  
orange frame will appear. Tap on the  
image again to display it as a single  
image.  
Magnifying Image  
Spread two fingers apart.  
Touch the screen with two fingers  
together, then spread your fingers apart  
on the screen.  
As you spread your fingers, the  
image will be magnified.  
The image can be magnified up to  
approx. 10x.  
You can scroll around the image by  
dragging your fingers.  
To reduce the image, pinch your  
fingers together on the screen.  
Tapping on the [2] icon will return to  
the single-image display.  
Touch screen operations on the camera’s LCD monitor are also possible  
while playing back images on a TV set connected to your camera (p.312-  
315).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
296  
b Rotating the Image  
You can rotate the displayed image to the desired orientation.  
Select [Rotate image].  
1
Under the [x1] tab, select [Rotate  
image], then press <0>.  
Select an image.  
2
Turn the <5> dial to select the  
image to be rotated.  
You can also select an image in the  
Rotate the image.  
3
Each time you press <0>, the  
image will rotate clockwise as follows:  
90° 9 270° 9 0°.  
To rotate another image, repeat steps  
2 and 3.  
To exit and return to the menu, press  
the <M> button.  
If you set [51: Auto rotate] to [OnzD] (p.281) before taking vertical  
shots, you need not rotate the image as described above.  
If the rotated image is not displayed in the rotated orientation during  
image playback, set [51: Auto rotate] to [OnzD].  
A movie cannot be rotated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
297  
   
3 Setting Ratings  
You can rate images (still photos and movies) with one of five rating  
marks: l/m/n/o/p. This function is called rating.  
Select [Rating].  
Under the [x2] tab, select [Rating],  
1
then press <0>.  
Select an image.  
Turn the <5> dial to select an image  
2
or movie to be rated, then press  
<0>.  
By pressing the <I> button, you  
can select images from a three-image  
display. To return to the single-image  
display, press the <u> button.  
Rate the image.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select a  
3
rating.  
When you select a rating for the  
image, the number beside the set  
rating will increase by one.  
To rate another image, repeat steps 2  
and 3.  
To return to the menu, press the  
<M> button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
298  
         
3 Setting Ratings  
A total of up to 999 images of a given rating can be displayed. If there are  
more than 999 images with a given rating, [###] will be displayed.  
Taking Advantage of Ratings  
With [x2: Image jump w/6], you can display only images having the  
specified rating.  
With [x2: Slide show], you can play back only images having the  
specified rating.  
With Digital Photo Professional (EOS software, p.420), you can select  
only images with a specific rating (still photos only).  
With Windows 8.1, Windows 8, Windows 7, etc., you can see each file’s  
rating as part of the file information display or in the provided image  
viewer (still photos only).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
299  
 
Q Quick Control for Playback  
During playback, you can press the <Q> button to set the following:  
[J: Protect images, b: Rotate image, 9: Rating, U: Creative  
filters, S: Resize (JPEG images only), N: Cropping, K: AF point  
display, e: Image jump w/6, k: Wi-Fi function*].  
For movies, only the functions in bold above can be set.  
* Not selectable if [51: Wi-Fi/NFC] is set to [Disable].  
Press the <Q> button.  
1
During image playback, press the  
<Q> button.  
The Quick Control options will  
appear.  
Select a function and set it.  
2
Press the <W> <X> keys to select a  
function.  
The name and current setting of the  
selected function are displayed at the  
bottom of the screen.  
Set it by pressing the <Y> <Z> keys.  
When setting the Creative filters  
(p.326), Resize (p.329), Cropping  
(p.331), or Wi-Fi function, also press  
<0> to finalize the setting.  
Image jump w/6: Set the Rating  
(p.298) by pressing the <B>  
button.  
To cancel, press the <M> button.  
Exit the setting.  
Press the <Q> button to exit the  
3
Quick Control screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
300  
   
Q Quick Control for Playback  
To rotate an image, set [51: Auto rotate] to [OnzD]. If [51: Auto rotate]  
is set to [OnD] or [Off], the [b Rotate image] setting will be recorded to  
the image, but the camera will not rotate the image for display.  
Pressing the <Q> button during the index display will switch to the  
single-image display and the Quick Control screen will appear. Pressing  
the <Q> button again will return to the index display.  
For images taken with another camera, the options you can select may  
be restricted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
301  
k Enjoying Movies  
You can play back movies in the following three ways:  
Playback on a TV Set  
Use the HDMI cable HTC-100 (sold  
separately) or stereo AV cable AVC-  
DC400ST (sold separately) to connect  
the camera to a TV set. Then you can  
play back captured movies and still  
photos on the TV set.  
If you have a High-Definition TV set and  
connect your camera with an HDMI  
cable, you can watch Full High-Definition  
(Full HD: 1920x1080) and High-  
Definition (HD: 1280x720) movies with  
higher image quality.  
Since hard disk recorders do not have an HDMI IN terminal, the camera  
cannot be connected to a hard disk recorder with an HDMI cable.  
Even if the camera is connected to a hard disk recorder with a USB  
cable, movies and still photos cannot be played back or saved.  
If the playback device is not compatible with MP4 files, the movie cannot  
be played back.  
Playback on the Camera’s LCD Monitor  
You can play back movies on the  
camera’s LCD monitor. You can also edit  
out the movie’s first and last scenes, and  
play back the still photos and movies on  
the card in an automatic slide show.  
A movie edited with a computer cannot be rewritten to the card or played  
back with the camera.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
302  
             
k Enjoying Movies  
Playback and Editing with a Computer  
To play back or edit a movie, use pre-  
installed or general-purpose software,  
compatible with the movie’s recording  
format.  
If you want to play back or edit a movie with commercially-available  
software, use software compatible with MP4-format movies. For details on  
commercially-available software, contact the software manufacturer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
303  
k Playing Back Movies  
Play back the image.  
Press the <x> button to display an  
1
image.  
Select a movie.  
Turn the <5> dial to select the  
2
movie to be played back.  
In the single-image display, the  
s1> icon displayed on the upper  
<
left of the screen indicates a movie. If  
the movie is a video snapshot,  
<st> will be displayed.  
In the index display, perforations at  
the left edge of a thumbnail indicate a  
movie. As movies cannot be played  
back from the index display, press  
<0> to switch to the single-image  
display.  
In the single-image display, press  
3 <0>.  
The movie playback panel will appear  
at the bottom of the screen.  
Play back the movie.  
4
Select [7] (Play), then press <0>.  
The movie will start playing back.  
You can pause the movie playback by  
pressing <0>.  
Speaker  
You can adjust the sound volume by  
turning the <6> dial even during  
movie playback.  
For more details on the playback  
procedure, see the next page.  
The camera may not be able to play back movies shot with another camera.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
304  
     
k Playing Back Movies  
Movie Playback Panel  
Operation  
Playback Description  
7 Play  
Pressing <0> toggles between play and stop.  
Adjust the slow motion speed by pressing the <Y> <Z>  
keys. The slow motion speed is indicated on the upper right  
of the screen.  
8 Slow motion  
5 First frame  
Displays the movie’s first frame.  
3 Previous  
frame  
Each time you press <0>, the previous frame is displayed.  
If you hold down <0>, it will rewind the movie.  
Each time you press <0>, the movie will play frame-by-  
frame. If you hold down <0>, it will fast forward the movie.  
6 Next frame  
4 Last frame  
Displays the movie’s last frame.  
F Background  
music*  
Plays back a movie with the selected background music  
(p.311).  
X Edit  
Displays the editing screen (p.306).  
Playback position  
mm’ ss”  
Playback time (minutes:seconds)  
Turn the <6> dial to adjust the volume of the built-in  
speaker (p.304).  
9 Volume  
Press the <M> button to return to the single-image  
display.  
32  
* When background music is set, the movie sound will not be played back.  
With a fully-charged Battery Pack LP-E17, the continuous playback time at  
room temperature (23°C / 73°F) is approx. 2 hr. 20 min.  
If you connect the camera to a TV set to play back a movie (p.312, 315),  
adjust the sound volume with the TV set. (Turning the <6> dial will not  
change the sound volume.)  
If you take a still photo while you are shooting the movie, the still photo  
will be displayed for approx. 1 sec. during the movie playback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
305  
   
X Editing a Movie’s First and Last Scenes  
Playback with the Touch Screen  
Tap [7] on the center of the screen.  
The movie will start playing back.  
To display the movie playback panel,  
tap <s1> on the upper left of the  
screen.  
To pause the movie while it is playing  
back, tap on the screen. The movie  
playback panel will also appear.  
X
Editing a Movie’s First and Last Scenes  
You can edit out the first and last scenes of a movie in approx. 1-sec.  
increments.  
On the movie playback screen,  
select [X].  
The movie editing panel will be  
1
displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
Specify the part to be edited out.  
2
Select either [U] (Cut beginning) or  
[V] (Cut end), then press <0>.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to see the  
previous or next frames. Holding  
down the key will fast forward or fast  
rewind the frames. Turn the <5> dial  
for frame-by-frame playback.  
After deciding which part to edit out,  
press <0>. The portion highlighted  
in gray on the top of the screen will  
remain.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
306  
         
X Editing a Movie’s First and Last Scenes  
Check the edited movie.  
Select [7] and press <0> to play  
back the edited movie.  
3
To change the editing, go back to step  
2.  
To cancel the editing, press the  
<M> button, then select [OK] on  
the confirmation dialog.  
Save the edited movie.  
4
Select [W], then press <0>.  
The save screen will appear.  
To save it as a new movie, select  
[New file]. To save it and overwrite  
the original movie file, select  
[Overwrite], then press <0>.  
On the confirmation dialog, select  
[OK], then press <0> to save the  
edited movie and return to the movie  
playback screen.  
Since the editing is performed in approx. 1-sec. increments (position  
indicated by [Z] on the top of the screen), the actual position where the  
movie is edited may differ from the position you specified.  
If the card does not have enough free space, [New file] will not be  
available.  
When the battery level is low, movie editing is not possible. Use a fully-  
charged battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
307  
3 Slide Show (Auto Playback)  
You can play back the images on the card as an automatic slide show.  
Select [Slide show].  
1
Under the [x2] tab, select [Slide  
show], then press <0>.  
Select the images to be played  
Number of images  
to be played back  
2 back.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
the desired option, then press <0>.  
All images/Movies/Stills  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
one of the following: [OAll images]  
[kMovies] [zStills]. Then press  
<0>.  
Date/Folder/Rating  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
one of the following: [iDate]  
[nFolder] [9Rating].  
When <zH> is highlighted,  
press the <B> button.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to select an  
option, then press <0>.  
[Date]  
[Folder]  
[Rating]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
308  
       
3 Slide Show (Auto Playback)  
Item  
Playback Description  
All the still photos and movies on the card will be played  
back.  
OAll images  
Still photos and movies taken on the selected shooting date  
will be played back.  
iDate  
Still photos and movies in the selected folder will be played  
back.  
nFolder  
kMovies  
zStills  
Only the movies on the card will be played back.  
Only the still photos on the card will be played back.  
Only the still photos and movies with the selected rating will  
be played back.  
9Rating  
Configure [Set up] as desired.  
3
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
[Set up], then press <0>.  
Set the [Display time], [Repeat]  
(repeated playback), [Transition  
effect] (effect when changing  
images), and [Background music]  
for the still photos.  
The background music selection  
procedure is explained on page 311.  
After selecting the settings, press the  
<M> button.  
[Display time]  
[Repeat]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
309  
3 Slide Show (Auto Playback)  
[Transition effect]  
[Background music]  
Start the slide show.  
Press the <W><X> keys to select  
[Start], then press <0>.  
After [Loading image...] is displayed,  
the slide show will start.  
4
5
Exit the slide show.  
To exit the slide show and return to  
the setting screen, press the <M>  
button.  
To pause the slide show, press <0>. During pause, [G] will be displayed  
on the upper left of the image. Press <0> again to resume the slide  
show. You can also pause the slide show by tapping on the screen.  
During auto playback, you can press the <B> button to change the  
still photo display format (p.107).  
During movie playback, you can adjust the sound volume by turning the  
<6> dial.  
During auto playback or pause, you can turn the <5> dial to view  
another image.  
During auto playback, auto power off will not take effect.  
The display time may vary depending on the image.  
To view the slide show on a TV set, see page 312.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
310  
3 Slide Show (Auto Playback)  
Selecting the Background Music  
After you use EOS Utility (EOS software) to copy background music to  
the card, you can play background music together with the slide show.  
Select [Background music].  
1
Set [Background music] to [On],  
then press <0>.  
If the card has no background music,  
you cannot perform step 2.  
Select the background music.  
2
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
the desired background music, then  
press <0>. You can also select  
multiple background music tracks.  
Play the background music.  
3
To listen to a sample of the  
background music, press the <B>  
button.  
Press the <W> <X> keys to play  
another background music track. To  
stop listening to the background  
music, press the <B> button  
again.  
Adjust the sound volume by turning  
the <6> dial.  
To delete a background music track,  
press the <W> <X> keys and select  
the track, then press the <L> button.  
At the time of purchase, the camera does not have background music. The  
procedure to copy background music to a card is explained in the EOS  
Utility Instruction Manual (p.422).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
311  
     
Viewing Images on a TV Set  
You can view still photos and movies on a TV set.  
If the video system format does not match the TV set’s, movies will not  
be displayed properly. In such a case, switch to the proper video system  
format with [53: Video system].  
If [51: Wi-Fi/NFC] is set to [Enable], the camera cannot be connected to  
a TV set. Set [Wi-Fi/NFC] to [Disable], then reconnect the camera to the  
TV set with an HDMI cable or stereo AV cable.  
Viewing on High-Definition (HD) TV Sets (Connected with HDMI)  
HDMI Cable HTC-100 (sold separately) is required.  
Connect the HDMI cable to the  
camera.  
With the plug’s <dHDMI MINI> logo  
facing the front of the camera, insert it  
into the <D> terminal.  
1
Connect the HDMI cable to the TV  
2 set.  
Connect the HDMI cable to the TV  
set’s HDMI IN port.  
Turn on the TV set and switch the  
3 TV set’s video input to select the  
connected port.  
Set the camera’s power switch to  
4 <1>.  
Adjust movie sound volume with the TV set. The sound volume cannot  
be adjusted with the camera.  
Before connecting or disconnecting the cable between the camera and  
TV set, turn off the camera and TV set.  
Depending on the TV set, part of the image displayed may be cut off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
312  
               
Viewing Images on a TV Set  
Press the <x> button.  
5
The image will appear on the TV  
screen. (Nothing will be displayed on  
the camera’s LCD monitor.)  
The images will automatically be  
displayed at the optimum resolution  
of the TV set.  
By pressing the <B> button, you  
can change the display format.  
To play back movies, see page 304.  
The images cannot be output at the same time from both the <D>  
and <q> terminals.  
Do not connect any other device’s output to the camera’s <D>  
terminal. Doing so may cause a malfunction.  
Certain TV sets may not be able to display the captured movies. In such  
a case, use the stereo AV cable AVC-DC400ST (sold separately) to  
connect to the TV set.  
Using HDMI CEC TV Sets  
If the TV set connected to the camera with an HDMI cable is compatible  
with HDMI CEC*, you can use the TV set’s remote control for playback  
operations.  
* An HDMI-standard function enabling HDMI devices to control each other so that  
you can control them with one remote control unit.  
Set [Ctrl over HDMI] to [Enable].  
1
Under the [32] tab, select [Ctrl over  
HDMI], then press <0>.  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
313  
   
Viewing Images on a TV Set  
Connect the camera to a TV set.  
Use an HDMI cable to connect the  
2
camera to the TV set.  
The TV set’s input will switch  
automatically to the HDMI port  
connected to the camera. If it does not  
switch automatically, use the TV set’s  
remote control to select the HDMI IN  
port the cable is connected to.  
Press the camera’s <x> button.  
3
An image will appear on the TV  
screen and you can use the TV set’s  
remote control to play back images.  
Select an image.  
4
Point the remote control toward the  
TV set and press the /button to  
select an image.  
Press the remote control’s Enter button.  
Still photo playback menu  
Movie playback menu  
5
The menu appears and you can  
perform the playback operations  
shown on the left.  
Press the  
/  
button to select the  
desired option, then press the Enter  
button. For a slide show, press the  
2
: Return  
a
1
: 9-image index  
: Play movie  
: Slide show  
remote control’s  
/  
button to select  
an option, then press the Enter button.  
If you select [Return] and press the  
Enter button, the menu will disappear  
and you can use the /button to  
select an image.  
c
B : Display shooting info  
: Rotate  
b
Some TV sets require you to first enable the HDMI CEC connection. For  
details, refer to the TV set’s instruction manual.  
Certain TV sets, even those compatible with HDMI CEC, may not  
operate properly. In such a case, set [32: Ctrl over HDMI] to [Disable],  
and use the camera to control the playback operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
314  
Viewing Images on a TV Set  
Viewing on Non-HD TV Sets (Connected with AV Cable)  
Stereo AV Cable AVC-DC400ST (sold separately) is required.  
Connect the AV cable to the  
camera.  
With the plug’s <Canon> logo facing  
the back of the camera, insert it into  
the <q> terminal.  
1
Connect the AV cable to the TV  
(Red)  
2 set.  
(White)  
(Yellow)  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
Connect the AV cable to the TV set’s  
video IN terminal and audio IN  
terminals.  
Turn on the TV set and switch the  
3 TV’s video input to select the  
connected port.  
Set the camera’s power switch to  
4 <1>.  
Press the <x> button.  
The image will appear on the TV  
5
screen. (Nothing will be displayed on  
the camera’s LCD monitor.)  
To play back movies, see page 304.  
Do not use any AV cable other than the Stereo AV cable AVC-DC400ST  
(sold separately). Movies may not be displayed if you use a different cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
315  
       
K Protecting Images  
You can set protections to prevent the precious images from being  
erased accidentally.  
3 Protecting a Single Image  
Select [Protect images].  
1
Under the [31] tab, select [Protect  
images], then press <0>.  
Select [Select images].  
2
Select [Select images], then press  
<0>.  
An image will be displayed.  
Protect the image.  
Turn the <5> dial to select the  
Image protect icon  
3
image to be protected, then press  
<0>.  
The image will be protected, and the  
<K> icon will appear at the top of  
the screen.  
To cancel the image protection, press  
<0> again. The <K> icon will  
disappear.  
To protect another image, repeat step  
3.  
To return to the menu, press the  
<M> button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
316  
     
K Protecting Images  
3 Protecting All Images in a Folder or on a Card  
You can protect all the images in a folder or on a card at once.  
When you select [All images in folder]  
or [All images on card] in [31:  
Protect images], all the images in the  
folder or on the card will be protected.  
To cancel the image protection, select  
[Unprotect all images in folder] or  
[Unprotect all images on card].  
If you format the card (p.65), the protected images will also be erased.  
Movies can also be protected.  
Once an image is protected, it cannot be erased by the camera’s erase  
function. To erase a protected image, you must first cancel the  
protection.  
If you erase all the images (p.319), only the protected images will  
remain. This is convenient when you want to erase unnecessary images  
all at once.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
317  
L Erasing Images  
You can either select and erase unnecessary images one by one or  
erase them in one batch. Protected images (p.316) will not be erased.  
Once an image is erased, it cannot be recovered. Make sure  
you no longer need the image before erasing it. To prevent  
important images from being erased accidentally, protect  
them. Erasing a RAW+JPEG image will erase both the RAW  
and JPEG images.  
Erasing a Single Image  
Play back the image to be erased.  
1
Press the <L> button.  
2
The Erase menu will appear.  
Erase the image.  
Select [Erase], then press <0>. The  
3
image displayed will be erased.  
3
Checkmarking <X> Images to Be Erased in a Batch  
By appending checkmarks <X> to the images to be erased, you can  
erase multiple images at once.  
Select [Erase images].  
1
Under the [31] tab, select [Erase  
images], then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
318  
   
L Erasing Images  
Select [Select and erase images].  
Select [Select and erase images],  
then press <0>.  
2
3
An image will be displayed.  
Select the images to be erased.  
Turn the <5> dial to select the  
image to be erased, then press <0>.  
A checkmark <X> will be displayed  
on the upper left of the screen.  
By pressing the <I> button, you  
can select images from a three-image  
display. To return to the single-image  
display, press the <u> button.  
To select other images to be erased,  
repeat step 3.  
Erase the image.  
Press the <L> button.  
Select [OK], then press <0>.  
The selected images will be erased.  
4
3 Erasing All Images in a Folder or on a Card  
You can erase all the images in a folder or on a card at once. When  
[31: Erase images] is set to [All images in folder] or [All images on  
card], all the images in the folder or on the card will be erased.  
To erase all images including protected images, format the card (p.65).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
319  
 
B: Shooting Information Display  
The information displayed varies depending on the shooting mode and  
settings.  
Sample Information for Still Photos  
Basic information display  
Wi-Fi function  
Eye-Fi transfer completed  
Rating  
Wi-Fi/Eye-Fi card  
transmission status  
Battery level  
Protect images  
Playbacknumber/  
Folder number -  
Total images  
recorded  
File number  
Shutter speed  
Image-recording  
quality  
Aperture  
Highlight tone priority  
Exposure compensation  
amount  
ISO speed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
320  
     
B: Shooting Information Display  
Shooting information display  
Detailed information  
Exposure compensation amount  
Histogram (Brightness/RGB)  
Shooting date and time  
ISO speed  
Shutter speed  
Shooting mode  
Scroll bar  
Highlight tone priority  
Metering mode  
File size  
White balance  
Auto Lighting  
Optimizer  
Flash exposure compensation  
amount /  
Multi Shot Noise Reduction  
White balance correction  
Aperture  
Image-recording quality  
Picture Style/Settings  
* When you shoot in [1+73] image quality, the 1 file size will be displayed.  
* During flash photography without flash exposure compensation, <0> will be  
displayed.  
* <M> will be displayed for images shot with Multi Shot Noise Reduction.  
* For still photos taken during movie shooting, <G> will be displayed.  
* If a Creative filter or resizing is applied to the image and then saved, <u> will  
be displayed.  
* For cropped images, <u> and <N> will be displayed.  
If the image was taken by another camera, certain shooting information may  
not be displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
321  
     
B: Shooting Information Display  
Lens/Histogram information  
Histogram display  
(Brightness)  
Lens name  
Histogram display  
(RGB)  
Focal length  
White balance information  
Picture Style information  
Color space / Noise  
reduction information  
Lens aberration correction  
information  
GPS information  
Latitude  
Longitude  
Elevation  
Direction  
UTC (Coordinated Universal Time)  
If GPS information was not recorded for the image, the GPS information  
screen will not be displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
322  
 
B: Shooting Information Display  
Sample Movie Information Display  
Playback  
Aperture  
Shutter speed  
Shooting mode  
Movie recording size  
Frame rate  
Movie file size  
Shooting time, Playback time  
Compression method  
* If manual exposure is used, the shutter speed, aperture, and ISO speed (when  
set manually) will be displayed.  
* The <t> icon will be displayed for video snapshots.  
* The <t> icon will be displayed for HDR movies.  
* The <c> icon will be displayed for Miniature effect movies.  
AF Point Display  
When [32: AF point disp.] is set to [Enable], the AF point that has  
achieved focus will be displayed in red. If automatic AF point  
selection is set, multiple AF points may be displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
323  
 
B: Shooting Information Display  
Highlight Alert  
When the shooting information is displayed, any overexposed areas  
of the image will blink. To obtain more image detail in the  
overexposed, blinking areas, set the exposure compensation to a  
negative amount and shoot again.  
Histogram  
The brightness histogram shows the exposure level distribution and  
overall brightness. The RGB histogram is for checking the color  
saturation and gradation. The display can be switched with [x2:  
Histogram disp].  
[Brightness] Display  
Sample Histograms  
This histogram is a graph showing the distribution  
of the image’s brightness level. The horizontal axis  
indicates the brightness level (darker on the left  
and brighter on the right), while the vertical axis  
indicates how many pixels exist for each  
Dark image  
brightness level. The more pixels there are toward  
the left, the darker the image. The more pixels  
there are toward the right, the brighter the image.  
If there are too many pixels on the left, the shadow  
detail will be lost. If there are too many pixels on  
the right, the highlight detail will be lost. The  
gradation in-between will be reproduced. By  
checking the image and its brightness histogram,  
Normal brightness  
Bright image  
you can see the exposure level inclination and the overall gradation.  
[RGB] Display  
This histogram is a graph showing the distribution of each primary  
color’s brightness level in the image (RGB or red, green, and blue). The  
horizontal axis indicates the color’s brightness level (darker on the left  
and brighter on the right), while the vertical axis indicates how many  
pixels exist for each color brightness level. The more pixels there are  
toward the left, the darker and less prominent the color. The more pixels  
there are toward the right, the brighter and denser the color. If there are  
too many pixels on the left, the respective color information will be  
lacking. If there are too many pixels on the right, the color will be too  
saturated with no gradation. By checking the image’s RGB histogram,  
you can see the color’s saturation and gradation condition, as well as  
white balance inclination.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
324  
     
11  
Post-Processing  
Images  
After taking a picture, you can apply a Creative filter,  
resize the JPEG image (reduce the number of pixels),  
or crop the image.  
The camera may not be able to process images taken with  
another camera.  
Post-processing images as described in this chapter cannot be  
performed when the camera is connected to a computer via  
the <C> terminal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
325  
 
U Applying Creative Filters  
You can apply the following Creative filters to an image and save it as a  
new image: Grainy B/W, Soft focus, Fish-eye effect, Art bold effect,  
Water painting effect, Toy camera effect, and Miniature effect.  
Select [Creative filters].  
1
Under the [x1] tab, select [Creative  
filters], then press <0>.  
An image will be displayed.  
Select an image.  
Select the image you want to apply a  
2
filter to.  
By pressing the <I> button, you  
can switch to the index display and  
select an image.  
Select a filter.  
When you press <0>, the types of  
3
Creative filters will be displayed  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select a  
filter, then press <0>.  
The image will be displayed with the  
effects of the filter applied.  
Adjust the filter effect.  
4
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to adjust  
the filter effect, then press <0>.  
For the Miniature effect, press the  
<W> <X> keys and select the image  
area (within the white frame) where  
you want the image to look sharp,  
then press <0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
326  
     
U Applying Creative Filters  
Save the image.  
5
Select [OK] to save the image.  
Check the destination folder and  
image file number, then select [OK].  
To apply a filter to another image,  
repeat steps 2 to 5.  
To return to the menu, press the  
<M> button.  
When shooting 1+73 or 1 image, the filter effect will be applied to  
the 1 image and the image will be saved as a JPEG image.  
If an aspect ratio was set for a 1 image and the filter effect is applied  
to it, the image will be saved in the aspect ratio that is set.  
Dust Delete Data (p.287) will not be appended to images with Fish-eye  
effect applied.  
Creative Filter Characteristics  
V Grainy B/W  
Creates a grainy black-and-white photo. You can change the black-  
and-white effect by adjusting the contrast.  
W Soft focus  
Gives the image a soft look. You can change the degree of softness  
by adjusting the blur.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
327  
     
U Applying Creative Filters  
X Fish-eye effect  
Gives the effect of a fish-eye lens. The image will have a barrel-type  
distortion.  
Depending on the level of this filter effect, the area trimmed along  
the periphery of the image changes. Also, since this filter effect will  
magnify the image center, the apparent resolution at the center may  
degrade depending on the number of recorded pixels. Set the filter  
effect in step 4 while checking the resulting image.  
Y Art bold effect  
Makes the photo look like an oil painting and the subject look more  
three-dimensional. You can adjust the contrast and saturation. Note  
that the sky, white walls, and similar subjects may not be rendered  
with a smooth gradation and may look irregular or have significant  
noise.  
Z Water painting effect  
Makes the photo look like a watercolor painting with soft colors. You  
can control the color density by adjusting the filter effect. Note that  
night scenes or dark scenes may not be rendered with a smooth  
gradation and may look irregular or have significant noise.  
b Toy camera effect  
Darkens the photo’s corners and applies a color tone that makes it  
look as if it was shot by a toy camera. You can change the color cast  
by adjusting the color tone.  
c Miniature effect  
Creates a diorama effect. You can change where the image looks  
sharp. In step 4, if you press the <B> button (or tap on [T] at the  
screen’s bottom), you can switch between the white frame’s vertical  
and horizontal orientations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
328  
         
S Resizing JPEG Images  
You can resize a JPEG image to make the pixel count lower and save it  
as a new image. Resizing an image is possible only with JPEG 3/4/a/  
b images. JPEG c and RAW images cannot be resized.  
Select [Resize].  
Under the [31] tab, select [Resize],  
1
then press <0>.  
An image will be displayed.  
Select an image.  
Select the image you want to resize.  
By pressing the <I> button, you  
can switch to the index display and  
select an image.  
2
Select the desired image size.  
3
Press <0> to display the image  
sizes.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the desired image size, then press  
<0>.  
Target sizes  
Save the image.  
Select [OK] to save the resized  
image.  
4
Check the destination folder and  
image file number, then select [OK].  
To resize another image, repeat steps  
2 to 4.  
To return to the menu, press the  
<M> button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
329  
         
S Resizing JPEG Images  
Resize Options by Original Image Size  
Available Resize Settings  
Original Image  
Size  
4
a
k
k
b
k
k
k
c
k
k
k
k
3
4
a
b
k
Image Sizes  
The image sizes displayed in step 3 on the preceding page, such as  
[***M ****x****], have a 3:2 aspect ratio. The image sizes by aspect  
ratios are shown in the table below.  
The asterisked image-recording quality figures do not exactly match the  
aspect ratio. The image will be cropped slightly.  
Aspect Ratio and Pixel Count (Approx.)  
Image  
Quality  
3:2  
4:3  
16:9  
1:1  
3984x2656  
3552x2664  
3984x2240*  
2656x2656  
4
a
(10.6 megapixels) (9.5 megapixels) (8.9 megapixels) (7.1 megapixels)  
2976x1984 2656x1992 2976x1680* 1984x1984  
(5.9 megapixels) (5.3 megapixels) (5.0 megapixels) (3.9 megapixels)  
1920x1280 1696x1280* 1920x1080 1280x1280  
(2.5 megapixels) (2.2 megapixels) (2.1 megapixels) (1.6 megapixels)  
720x480 640x480 720x408* 480x480  
(0.35 megapixels) (0.31 megapixels) (0.29 megapixels) (0.23 megapixels)  
b
c
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
330  
N Cropping JPEG Images  
You can crop the image as desired and save it as a new image. JPEG  
c and RAW images cannot be cropped. The 1+73 image’s  
JPEG image can be cropped.  
Select [Cropping].  
1
Under the [x2] tab, select  
[Cropping], then press <0>.  
An image will be displayed.  
Select an image.  
Select the image you want to crop.  
By pressing the <I> button, you  
can switch to the index display and  
select an image.  
2
Set the cropping frame size,  
3 aspect ratio, position, and  
orientation.  
Press <0> to display the cropping  
frame.  
The image area within the cropping  
frame will be cropped.  
Changing the Cropping Frame Size  
Press the <u> or <I> button.  
The cropping frame size will change. The smaller the cropping  
frame, the larger the image magnification will be.  
Changing the Cropping Frame Aspect Ratio  
Turn the <5> dial.  
Cropping frame aspect ratio will change to [3:2], [16:9], [4:3], or  
[1:1].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
331  
   
N Cropping JPEG Images  
Moving the Cropping Frame  
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z> keys.  
The cropping frame will move up, down, left, or right.  
You can also touch the cropping frame and drag it to the desired  
position.  
Rotating the Cropping Frame Orientation  
Press the <B> button.  
The cropping frame will switch between the vertical and horizontal  
orientations. This enables you to create a vertical image from a  
horizontal one, and vice versa.  
Display the cropped image in the  
4 full view.  
Press the <Q> button.  
You can see the cropped image.  
To return to the original display, press  
the <Q> button again.  
Save the image.  
Press <0> and select [OK] to save  
5
the cropped image.  
Check the destination folder and  
image file number, then select [OK].  
To crop another image, repeat steps 2  
to 5.  
To return to the menu, press the  
<M> button.  
You cannot crop an image that has already been cropped.  
You cannot apply a Creative filter or resizing to a cropped image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
332  
12  
Printing Images  
Printing (p.334)  
You can connect the camera directly to a printer and print  
out the images on the card. The camera is compliant with  
wPictBridge”, which is the standard for direct printing.  
You can also use a wireless LAN to send images to a  
PictBridge (Wireless LAN) printer and print them. For  
details, refer to the Wi-Fi/NFC Function Instruction Manual.  
Digital Print Order Format (DPOF) (p.343)  
DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) enables you to print  
images recorded on the card according to your printing  
instructions such as the image selection, quantity to print,  
etc. You can print multiple images in one batch or give the  
print order to a photofinisher.  
Specifying Images for a Photobook (p.347)  
You can specify images on the card for printing in a  
photobook.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
333  
   
Preparing to Print  
The direct printing procedure can be performed entirely with the  
camera while looking at the setting screens on camera’s LCD monitor.  
Connecting the Camera to a Printer  
Set the camera’s power switch to  
<2>.  
1
Set up the printer.  
2
For details, refer to the printer’s  
instruction manual.  
Connect the camera to the  
3 printer.  
Use the interface cable provided with  
the camera.  
Connect the cable to the camera’s  
<C> terminal with the cable  
plug’s <D> icon facing the front of  
the camera.  
To connect to the printer, refer to the  
printer’s instruction manual.  
Turn on the printer.  
4
Set the camera’s power switch to  
5 <1>.  
Some printers may make a beeping  
sound.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
334  
             
Preparing to Print  
Play back the image.  
Press the <x> button.  
The image will appear with the <w>  
icon on the upper left of the screen to  
indicate that the camera is connected  
to a printer.  
6
Before using the printer, make sure it has a PictBridge connection port.  
Movies cannot be printed.  
The camera cannot be used with printers compatible only with CP Direct  
or Bubble Jet Direct.  
Do not use any interface cable other than the one provided.  
If there is a long beeping sound in step 5, it indicates a problem with the  
printer. Resolve the problem displayed in the error message (p.342).  
If any of the following shooting modes or functions is set, the camera  
cannot be connected to a printer. Cancel all the relevant settings, then  
reconnect the camera to the printer with an interface cable.  
• <F> or <G> in <8> mode  
• Multi Shot Noise Reduction  
• [51: Wi-Fi/NFC] set to [Enable]  
You can also print RAW images taken with this camera.  
When you use a battery to power the camera, make sure it is fully  
charged. With a fully-charged battery pack, you can print for approx. 2 hr.  
Before disconnecting the cable, first turn off the camera and printer. Hold  
the plug (not the cord) to pull out the cable.  
For direct printing, using AC Adapter Kit ACK-E18 (sold separately) to  
power the camera is recommended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
335  
w Printing  
The screen display and setting options will differ depending on the  
printer. Some settings may not be available. For details, refer to the  
printer’s instruction manual.  
Printer-connected icon  
Select the image to be printed.  
Check that the <w> icon is  
1
displayed on the upper left of the LCD  
monitor.  
Turn the <5> dial to select the  
image to be printed.  
Press <0>.  
The print setting screen will appear.  
2
Print setting screen  
Sets the printing effects (p.338).  
Sets the date or file number imprinting to on or off.  
Sets the quantity to be printed.  
Sets the print area (p.341).  
Sets the paper size, type, and layout.  
Returns to the screen in step 1.  
Starts the printing.  
The paper size, type, and layout you have set are displayed.  
* Depending on the printer, certain settings such as the date and file  
number imprinting and cropping may not be selectable.  
Select [Paper settings].  
3
Select [Paper settings], then press  
<0>.  
The paper settings screen will  
appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
336  
     
w Printing  
Q Setting the Paper Size  
Select the size of the paper loaded in  
the printer, then press <0>.  
The paper type screen will appear.  
Y Setting the Paper Type  
Select the type of the paper loaded in  
the printer, then press <0>.  
The page layout screen will appear.  
U Setting the Page Layout  
Select the page layout, then press  
<0>.  
The print setting screen will reappear.  
Bordered  
Prints with white borders along the edges.  
Prints with no borders. If your printer cannot print borderless  
prints, the print will have borders.  
Borderless  
*1  
Imprints the shooting information on the border on 9x13 cm or  
larger prints.  
Borderedc  
xx-up  
Option to print 2, 4, 8, 9, 16, or 20 images on one sheet.  
2
Prints 20 or 35 images as thumbnails on A4 or Letter size paper* .  
• Imprints the shooting information*1 with [20-upc].  
20-upc  
35-upp  
Default  
The page layout varies depending on the printer model or its settings.  
*1: From the Exif data, the camera name, lens name, shooting mode, shutter  
speed, aperture, exposure compensation amount, ISO speed, white balance,  
etc., will be imprinted.  
*2: After ordering the prints with “Digital Print Order Format (DPOF)” (p.343), printing  
by following “Direct Printing of Print-Ordered Images” (p.346) is recommended.  
If the image’s aspect ratio is different from the printing paper’s aspect ratio, the image  
may be cropped significantly when you print it as a borderless print. If the image is  
cropped, the print may look grainier due to the fewer number of pixels.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
337  
 
w Printing  
Set the printing effects (image  
4 optimization).  
Set them if necessary. If you do not need  
to set any printing effects, go to step 5.  
Contents displayed on the screen  
vary depending on the printer.  
Select the option, then press <0>.  
Select the desired printing effect, then  
press <0>.  
If the <ze> icon is displayed  
brightly, you can also adjust the  
printing effects (p.340).  
Printing Effect  
EOn  
Description  
Prints with the printer’s standard colors. The image’s Exif data  
is used to make automatic corrections.  
EOff  
No automatic correction is applied.  
Prints with higher saturation to produce more vivid blues and  
greens.  
EVivid  
Image noise is reduced before printing.  
ENR  
Prints in black-and-white with true blacks.  
0 B/W  
0 Cool tone  
Prints in black-and-white with cool, bluish blacks.  
Prints in black-and-white with warm, yellowish blacks.  
Warm tone  
0
Prints the image in the actual colors and contrast. No automatic  
color adjustments are applied.  
zNatural  
zNatural M  
EDefault  
Printing characteristics are the same as the “Natural” setting.  
However, this setting enables finer printing adjustments than  
with “Natural”.  
Printing differs depending on the printer. For details, refer to the  
printer’s instruction manual.  
*
When you change the printing effects, changes are reflected in the image  
displayed on the upper left of the screen. Note that the printed image may look  
slightly different from the displayed image, which is only an approximation.  
This also applies to [Brightness] and [Adjust levels] on page 340.  
If you imprint shooting information on an image shot at an expanded ISO  
speed (H), the correct ISO speed may not be imprinted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
338  
     
w Printing  
Set the date and file number  
5 imprinting.  
Set them if necessary.  
Select <I>, then press <0>.  
Set the print settings as desired, then  
press <0>.  
Set the number of copies.  
Set it if necessary.  
Select <R>, then press <0>.  
Set the number of copies, then press  
<0>.  
6
Start printing.  
Select [Print], then press <0>.  
7
The [Default] setting for printing effects and other options are the  
printer’s own default settings as set by the printer’s manufacturer. Refer  
to the printer’s instruction manual to find out what the [Default] settings  
are.  
Depending on the image’s file size and image-recording quality, it may  
take some time for the printing to start after you select [Print].  
If image tilt correction (p.341) is applied, it may take longer to print the  
image.  
To stop the printing, press <0> while [Stop] is displayed, then select  
[OK].  
If you execute [54: Clear all camera settings] (p.282), all the settings  
will revert to their defaults.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
339  
 
w Printing  
e Adjusting Printing Effects  
In step 4 on page 338, select the printing  
effect. When the <ze> icon is  
displayed brightly, you can press the  
<B> button. You can then adjust the  
printing effects. What can be adjusted or  
what is displayed will depend on the  
selection made in step 4.  
Brightness  
The image brightness can be adjusted.  
Adjust levels  
When you select [Manual], you can change  
the histogram’s distribution and adjust the  
image’s brightness and contrast.  
With the Adjust levels screen displayed, press  
the <B> button to change the position of  
the <h>. Press the <Y> <Z> keys to freely  
adjust the shadow level (0-127) or highlight level (128-255).  
kBrightener  
Effective in backlit conditions where the subject’s face looks dark.  
When [On] is set, the face will be brightened for printing.  
Red-eye corr.  
Effective in flash images where the subject has red eyes. When [On]  
is set, the red eye will be corrected for printing.  
The [kBrightener] and [Red-eye corr.] effects will not be reflected on  
the screen.  
When [Detail set.] is selected, you can adjust the [Contrast],  
[Saturation], [Color tone], and [Color balance]. To adjust the [Color  
balance], press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z> keys. B is for blue, A for  
amber, M for magenta, G for green. The image’s color balance will be  
adjusted towards the color in the direction of move.  
If you select [Clear all], all the printing effect settings will be reverted to  
their defaults.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
340  
 
w Printing  
Cropping the Image  
Tilt correction  
You can crop the image and print only an  
enlarged version of the cropped portion,  
as if the image is recomposed.  
Set the cropping right before printing.  
If you change the print settings after  
setting the cropping, you may have to set  
the cropping again before printing.  
1 On the print setting screen, select [Cropping].  
2 Set the cropping frame size, position, and aspect ratio.  
The image area within the cropping frame will be printed. The  
cropping frame’s aspect ratio can be changed with [Paper settings].  
Changing the Cropping Frame Size  
Press the <u> or <I> button to change the cropping frame  
size. The smaller the cropping frame, the larger the image  
magnification will be for printing.  
Moving the Cropping Frame  
Press the <W> <X> or <Y> <Z> keys to move the frame over  
the image vertically or horizontally. Move the cropping frame until  
it covers the desired image area.  
Switching the Orientations of the Cropping Frame  
Pressing the <B> button will toggle the cropping frame  
between the vertical and horizontal orientations. This enables you  
to create a vertically oriented print from a horizontal image.  
Image Tilt Correction  
By turning the <6> dial, you can adjust the image tilt angle up to  
±10 degrees in 0.5-degree increments. When you adjust the  
image tilt, the <O> icon on the screen will turn blue.  
3 Press <0> to exit the cropping.  
The print setting screen will reappear.  
You can check the cropped image area on the upper left of the print setting screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
341  
       
w Printing  
Depending on the printer, the cropped image area may not be printed as  
you specified.  
The smaller you make the cropping frame, the grainier the picture will  
look in the print.  
Check the camera’s LCD monitor while cropping the image. If you look at  
the image on a TV screen, the cropping frame may not be displayed  
accurately.  
Handling Printer Errors  
If printing does not resume after you resolve a printer error (no ink, no paper,  
etc.) and select [Continue], operate the buttons on the printer to resume  
printing. For details on resuming the printing, refer to the printer’s instruction  
manual.  
Error Messages  
If a problem occurs during printing, an error message will appear on the  
camera’s LCD monitor. Press <0> to stop printing. After fixing the problem,  
resume printing. For details on how to fix a printing problem, refer to the  
printer’s instruction manual.  
Paper Error  
Check whether the paper is properly loaded in the printer.  
Ink Error  
Check the printer’s ink level and the waste ink tank.  
Hardware Error  
Check for any printer problems other than paper and ink problems.  
File Error  
The selected image cannot be printed via PictBridge. Images taken with a  
different camera or images edited with a computer may not be printable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
342  
   
W Digital Print Order Format (DPOF)  
You can set the print type, date imprinting, and file number imprinting.  
The print settings will be applied to all print-ordered images. (They  
cannot be set individually for each image.)  
Setting the Printing Options  
Select [Print order].  
1
Under the [x1] tab, select [Print  
order], then press <0>.  
Select [Set up].  
Select [Set up], then press <0>.  
2
Set the option as desired.  
3
Set the [Print type], [Date], and [File  
No.].  
Select the option to be set, then press  
<0>. Select the desired setting, then  
press <0>.  
[Print type]  
[Date]  
[File No.]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
343  
       
W Digital Print Order Format (DPOF)  
Standard  
Prints one image on one sheet.  
K
Multiple thumbnail images are printed on  
one sheet.  
Index  
L
Print type  
K
Both  
L
Prints both the standard and index prints.  
On  
Date  
[On] imprints the recorded date on the print.  
[On] imprints the file number on the print.  
Off  
On  
Off  
File number  
Exit the setting.  
4
Press the <7> button.  
The print order screen will reappear.  
Next, select [Sel.Image], [Byn], or  
[All image] to order the images to be  
printed.  
RAW images and movies cannot be print ordered. You can print RAW  
images with PictBridge (p.334).  
Even if [Date] and [File No.] are set to [On], the date or file number may  
not be imprinted depending on the print type setting and printer model.  
With [Index] prints, the [Date] and [File No.] cannot both be set to [On]  
at the same time.  
When printing with DPOF, use the card whose print order specifications  
have been set. It cannot be printed with the specified print order if you  
just extract images from the card and try to print them.  
Certain DPOF-compatible printers and photofinishers may not be able to  
print the images as you specified. Refer to the printer’s instruction  
manual before printing, or check with your photofinisher about  
compatibility when ordering prints.  
Do not insert into the camera a card whose print order was set by a  
different camera and then try to specify a print order. The print order may  
be overwritten. Also, the print order may not be possible, depending on  
the image type.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
344  
W Digital Print Order Format (DPOF)  
Print Ordering  
Sel.Image  
Select and order images one by one.  
By pressing the <I> button, you can  
select images from a three-image  
display. To return to the single-image  
display, press the <u> button.  
Press the <M> button to save the  
print order to the card.  
[Standard] [Both]  
Press the <W> <X> keys to set the  
number of copies to be printed for the  
displayed image.  
Quantity  
Total images selected  
[Index]  
Press <0> to add a checkmark to the  
box <X>. The image will be included in  
the index print.  
Checkmark  
Index icon  
Byn  
Select [Mark all in folder] and select the folder. A print order for one  
copy of all the images in the folder will be specified. If you select  
[Clear all in folder] and select the folder, the print order for that  
folder will all be canceled.  
All image  
If you select [Mark all on card], one copy of all the images on the  
card will be set for printing. If you select [Clear all on card], the print  
order will be cleared for all the images on the card.  
Note that RAW images and movies will not be included in the print order  
even if you set [Byn] or [All image].  
When using a PictBridge printer, print no more than 400 images for one  
print order. If you specify more than this, all the images may not be  
printed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
345  
W Direct Printing of Print-Ordered Images  
With a PictBridge printer, you can easily  
print images with DPOF.  
1 Prepare to print.  
See page 334.  
Follow the “Connecting the Camera to a Printer” procedure up to step 5.  
2 Under the [x1] tab, select [Print order].  
3 Select [Print].  
[Print] will be displayed only if the camera is connected to a  
printer and printing is possible.  
4 Set the [Paper settings] (p.336).  
Set the printing effects (p.338) if necessary.  
5 Select [OK].  
Before printing, be sure to set the paper size.  
Certain printers cannot imprint the file number.  
If [Bordered] is set, certain printers may imprint the date on the border.  
Depending on the printer, the date may appear faint if it is imprinted on a  
bright background or on the border.  
Under [Adjust levels], [Manual] cannot be selected.  
If you stopped the printing and want to resume printing the remaining images,  
select [Resume]. Note that printing will not resume if any of the following occurs.  
• You changed the print order or deleted any of the print ordered images  
before resuming the printing.  
• When index is set, you changed the paper setting before resuming the  
printing.  
• The card’s remaining capacity was low when you paused the printing.  
If a problem occurs during printing, see page 342.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
346  
   
p Specifying Images for a Photobook  
You can specify up to 998 images to be printed in a photobook. When  
you use EOS Utility (EOS software) to transfer images to a computer,  
the specified images will be copied to a dedicated folder. This function  
is useful for ordering photobooks online.  
Specifying One Image at a Time  
Select [Photobook Set-up].  
1
Under the [x1] tab, select  
[Photobook Set-up], then press  
<0>.  
Select [Select images].  
2
Select [Select images], then press  
<0>.  
An image will be displayed.  
Select the image to be specified.  
3
Turn the <5  
> dial to select the image  
>.  
to be specified, then press <  
0
By pressing the <I> button, you  
can select images from a three-image  
display. To return to the single-image  
display, press the <u> button.  
Repeat this step to select other  
images. The number of images that  
have been specified will be displayed  
on the upper left of the screen.  
To cancel the image specification,  
press <0> again.  
To return to the menu, press the  
<M> button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
347  
       
p Specifying Images for a Photobook  
Specifying All Images in a Folder or on a Card  
You can specify all the images in a folder or on a card at once.  
When [x1: Photobook Set-up] is set  
to [All images in folder] or [All images  
on card], all the images in the folder or  
on the card will be specified.  
To cancel the image specification, select  
[Clear all in folder] or [Clear all on  
card].  
RAW images and movies cannot be specified.  
Do not specify images already specified for a photobook in another  
camera for another photobook with this camera. The photobook settings  
may be overwritten.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
348  
13  
Customizing the  
Camera  
You can customize various camera functions to suit  
your picture-taking preferences with Custom Functions.  
Custom Functions can be set and used only in Creative  
Zone modes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
349  
 
3 Setting Custom FunctionsK  
Select [Custom Functions (C.Fn)].  
Under the [54] tab, select [Custom  
Functions (C.Fn)], then press <0>.  
1
Custom Function number  
Select the Custom Function  
2 number.  
Press the <Y> <Z> keys to select  
the Custom Function number, then  
press <0>.  
Change the setting as desired.  
3
Press the <W> <X> keys to select  
the desired setting (number), then  
press <0>.  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 if you want to  
set other Custom Functions.  
At the bottom of the screen, the  
current Custom Function settings are  
indicated below the respective  
function numbers.  
Exit the setting.  
Press the <M> button.  
The screen for step 1 will reappear.  
4
Clearing All Custom Functions  
Under [54: Clear settings], select [Clear all Custom Func. (C.Fn)] to  
clear all the Custom Function settings (p.282).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
350  
   
3 Setting Custom FunctionsK  
Custom Functions  
C.Fn I: Exposure  
A LV  
Shooting  
kMovie  
Shooting  
1
2
Exposure level increments  
ISO expansion  
k
k
k
In a  
C.Fn II: Image  
3
Highlight tone priority  
k
k
C.Fn III: Autofocus/Drive  
4
5
6
7
8
9
AF-assist beam firing  
k*  
AF area selection method  
Auto AF point selection: Color Tracking  
AF point display during focus  
VF display illumination  
Mirror lockup  
* When an EX-series Speedlite (sold separately) equipped with an LED light is used.  
C.Fn IV: Operation/Others  
10 Shutter/AE lock button  
k
k
k
k
11 Assign SET button  
(Except 3) (Except 2, 3, 6)*  
12 LCD display when power ON  
13 Multi function lock  
k
k
k
k
14 Retract lens on power off  
* Settings 1 and 4 do not function during movie shooting.  
* [5: ISO speed] is settable only for manual exposure shooting.  
The shaded Custom Functions do not function during Live View (LV)  
shooting or movie shooting. (Settings are disabled.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
351  
 
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
Custom Functions are organized into four groups based on the function  
type: C.Fn I: Exposure, C.Fn II: Image, C.Fn III: Autofocus/Drive, C.Fn  
IV: Operation/Others.  
C.Fn I: Exposure  
C.Fn-1  
Exposure level increments  
0: 1/3-stop  
1: 1/2-stop  
Sets 1/2-stop increments for the shutter speed, aperture, exposure  
compensation, AEB, flash exposure compensation, etc. This is  
effective when you prefer to control the exposure in less fine  
increments than 1/3-stop increments.  
With setting 1, the exposure level will be displayed as shown below.  
C.Fn-2  
ISO expansion  
0: Off  
1: On  
When you set the ISO speed, you can set “H” (equivalent to ISO  
25600) for still photos and “H” (equivalent to ISO 12800) for  
movies. Note that if [C.Fn-3: Highlight tone priority] is set to [1:  
Enable], “H” cannot be set.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
352  
             
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
C.Fn II: Image  
C.Fn-3  
Highlight tone priority  
0: Disable  
1: Enable  
Improves the highlight detail. The dynamic range is expanded from  
the standard 18% gray to bright highlights. The gradation between  
the grays and highlights becomes smoother.  
With setting 1, the Auto Lighting Optimizer (p.146) is automatically set to  
[Disable] and the setting cannot be changed.  
With setting 1, noise (grainy image, banding, etc.) may become slightly  
more noticeable than with setting 0.  
With setting 1, the settable range will be ISO 200 - ISO 12800 (up to ISO  
6400 for movies).  
Also, the <A> icon will be displayed in the viewfinder and on the LCD  
panel to indicate that highlight tone priority is enabled.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
353  
       
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
C.Fn III: Autofocus/Drive  
C.Fn-4  
AF-assist beam firing  
Enables or disables the built-in flash’s AF-assist beam or the EOS-  
dedicated external Speedlite’s AF-assist beam.  
0: Enable  
The AF-assist beam will be emitted when necessary.  
1: Disable  
The AF-assist beam will not be emitted. This prevents the AF-  
assist beam from disturbing others.  
2: Enable external flash only  
If an external Speedlite is attached, it will emit the AF-assist beam  
when necessary. The camera’s built-in flash will not fire the AF-  
assist beam.  
3: IR AF assist beam only  
When an external Speedlite is attached, only the infrared AF-assist  
beam will be emitted. Set this when you do not want the camera to  
fire the AF-assist beam as a burst of small flashes.  
With an EX-series Speedlite equipped with an LED light, the LED  
light will not automatically turn on for AF-assist.  
If the external Speedlite’s [AF-assist beam firing] Custom Function is set  
to [Disable], this function’s setting will be overridden and the AF-assist  
beam will not be emitted.  
C.Fn-5  
AF area selection method  
You can set the method for changing the AF area selection mode.  
0: S 9 AF area selection button  
After you press the <S> or <B> button, each time you press the  
<B> button, the AF area selection mode changes.  
1: S 9 Main Dial  
After you press the <S> or <B> button, turning the <6> dial  
changes the AF area selection mode.  
With setting 1, press the <Y> <Z> keys to move the AF point horizontally.  
When Battery Grip BG-E18 (sold separately) is used and 1 is set, you  
can change the AF area selection mode by operating the battery grip.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
354  
         
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
C.Fn-6  
Auto AF point selection: Color Tracking  
Use this function to autofocus by recognizing colors equivalent to skin tones.  
This function works in One-Shot AF mode when the AF area selection mode  
is set to Zone AF (manual selection of zone) or 19-point AF auto selection.  
0: One-Shot AF only  
In One-Shot AF mode, the camera selects AF points automatically  
based on AF information and information on colors equivalent to  
skin tones. This makes focusing on people easier, so you can  
prioritize composition in shooting.  
1: Disable  
AF points are automatically selected based only on AF information.  
Generally, the nearest subject will be focused on.  
With setting 0, focusing will take slightly longer than with setting 1.  
Even with setting 0, the expected result may not be obtained depending  
on the shooting conditions and subject.  
Under light so low that the flash emits the AF-assist beam automatically,  
AF points are selected automatically based only on AF information. (The  
AF will not use information on colors equivalent to skin tones.)  
C.Fn-7  
AF point display during focus  
You can set whether or not to display the AF point(s) in the following cases: 1.  
when selecting the AF point(s), 2. when the camera is ready to shoot (before  
AF operation), 3. during AF operation, and 4. when focus is achieved.  
0: Selected (constant)  
The selected AF point(s) is always displayed.  
1: All (constant)  
All 19 AF points are always displayed.  
2: Selected (pre-AF, focused)  
The selected AF point(s) is displayed for 1, 2, and 4.  
3: Selected (focused)  
The selected AF point(s) is displayed for 1 and 4.  
4: Disable display  
For 2, 3, and 4, the selected AF point(s) will not be displayed.  
With setting 2 or 3, the AF point will not be displayed even when focus is  
achieved with AI Servo AF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
355  
   
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
C.Fn-8  
VF display illumination  
You can set whether or not the AF points in the viewfinder will light up  
in red when focus is achieved.  
0: Auto  
The AF points automatically light up in red under low light.  
1: Enable  
The AF points light up in red regardless of the ambient light level.  
2: Disable  
The AF points do not light up in red.  
When AI Servo AF is set, there is no illumination in red even when focus is  
achieved.  
When you press the <S> or <B> button, the AF points will be  
illuminated in red regardless of this setting.  
The aspect ratio lines (p.130), and the electronic level, grid, and flicker  
detection set with [52:Viewfinder display] will also light up in red.  
C.Fn-9  
Mirror lockup  
0: Disable  
1: Enable  
Prevents camera shake due to camera vibrations in the camera  
caused by the reflex mirror action (mirror shock), when shooting  
with super telephoto lenses or close-ups (macro photography).  
See page 173 for the mirror lockup procedure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
356  
       
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
C.Fn IV: Operation/Others  
C.Fn-10  
Shutter/AE lock button  
0: AF/AE lock  
1: AE lock/AF  
This is convenient when you want to focus and meter separately.  
Press the <A> button to autofocus, and press the shutter button  
halfway to apply AE lock.  
2: AF/AF lock, no AE lock  
During AI Servo AF (or Servo AF for Live View shooting), you can  
press the <A> button to pause the AF operation momentarily.  
This prevents the AF from being thrown off by any obstacle  
passing between the camera and subject. The exposure is set at  
the moment the picture is taken.  
3: AE/AF, no AE lock  
This is useful for subjects that keep moving and stopping  
repeatedly. During AI Servo AF (or Servo AF for Live View  
shooting), you can press the <A> button to start or stop the AI  
Servo AF operation. The exposure is set at the moment the picture  
is taken. Thus, you can set your camera, so that the optimum  
focusing and exposure can be achieved and wait for the decisive  
moment.  
During Live View shooting  
When touch shutter is set and with setting 1 or 3, AF will not take effect  
for shooting.  
During movie shooting  
With setting 1 or 3, press the <A> button for One-Shot AF.  
With setting 2, press the shutter button halfway for One-Shot AF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
357  
   
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
C.Fn-11  
Assign SET button  
You can assign a frequently-used function to <0>. When the camera  
is ready to shoot, pressing the <0> button will display the respective  
function setting screen.  
0: Normal (disabled)  
1: Image quality  
The image quality setting screen will appear.  
2: Flash exposure compensation  
The flash exposure compensation setting screen will appear.  
3: LCD monitor On/Off  
You can turn on or off the LCD monitor.  
4: Menu display  
The menu screen will appear.  
5: ISO speed  
The ISO speed setting screen will appear.  
6: Flash function settings  
The built-in flash or external flash function setting screen will  
appear.  
C.Fn-12  
LCD display when power ON  
0: Display on  
When the power switch is turned on, the shooting settings will be  
1: Previous display status  
When the power is turned on, the camera will start with the LCD  
monitor display status just before the power was last turned off.  
Therefore, if you turn off the camera when the LCD monitor is off  
or when camera settings (p.362) are displayed, nothing will be  
displayed when you turn on the camera again. This helps to save  
battery power. The menu operations and image playback will be  
available as usual.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
358  
 
3 Custom Function SettingsK  
C.Fn-13  
Multi function lock  
When the <R> switch is set to the right, it can prevent the <6>  
and <5> dials from accidentally changing a setting.  
Select the camera control you want to lock, then press <0> to  
append a checkmark <X> and select [OK].  
6: Main Dial  
5 : Quick Control Dial  
If the <R> switch is set and you try to use one of the locked  
camera controls, [L] will be displayed in the viewfinder and on the LCD  
panel. Also, on the shooting function settings display (p.56), [LOCK] will  
be displayed.  
By default, when locked, the <5> dial will be locked.  
C.Fn-14  
Retract lens on power off  
This is to set the lens retraction mechanism for when a gear-driven  
STM lens (such as EF40mm f/2.8 STM) is attached to the camera. You  
can set it to retract the extended lens automatically when the camera’s  
power switch is set to <OFF>.  
0: Enable  
1: Disable  
With auto power off, the lens will not retract regardless of the setting.  
Before detaching the lens, make sure that it is retracted.  
With setting 0, this function takes effect regardless of the lens’s focus mode  
switch setting (AF or MF).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
359  
   
3 Registering My MenuK  
Under the My Menu tab, you can register up to six menu options and  
Custom Functions whose settings you change frequently.  
Select [My Menu settings].  
1
Under the [9] tab, select [My Menu  
settings], then press <0>.  
Select [Register to My Menu].  
2
Select [Register to My Menu], then  
press <0>.  
Register the desired items.  
3
Select the item, then press <0>.  
On the confirmation dialog, select [OK]  
and press <0> to register the item.  
You can register up to six items.  
To return to the screen in step 2,  
press the <M> button.  
My Menu Settings  
Sort  
You can change the order of the registered items in My Menu. Select  
[Sort] and select the item whose order you want to change. Then  
press <0>. With [z] displayed, press the <W> <X> keys to  
change the order, then press <0>.  
Delete item/items and Delete all items  
You can delete any of the registered items. [Delete item/items]  
deletes one item at a time, and [Delete all items] deletes all  
registered items.  
Display from My Menu  
When [Enable] is set, the [9] tab will be displayed first when you  
display the menu screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
360  
   
14  
Reference  
This chapter provides reference information for camera  
features, system accessories, etc.  
Certification Logo  
Select [54: Certification Logo Display] and press <0> to  
display some of the logos of the camera’s certifications. Other  
certification logos can be found in this Instruction Manual, on the  
camera body, and on the camera’s package.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
361  
   
B Button Functions  
If you press the <B> button when the  
camera is ready to shoot, the screens for  
[Displays camera settings],  
[Electronic level] (p.70), and [Displays  
shooting function] (p.363) will be  
displayed in sequence.  
Under the [53] tab, [z button  
display options] enables you to select  
the options displayed when the <B>  
button is pressed.  
Select the desired display option and  
press <0> to append a checkmark  
<X>.  
After making the selection, select  
[OK], then press <0>.  
Note that you cannot remove the <X> for all three display options.  
The [Displays camera settings] sample screen is displayed in English  
for all languages.  
Even if you uncheck the [Electronic level] so it does not appear, it will  
still appear for Live View shooting and movie shooting when you press  
the <B> button.  
Camera Settings  
Remaining card capacity  
Color space (p.156)  
WB bracketing (p.145)  
Touch control (p.64)  
Red-eye reduction (p.177)  
Daylight saving time  
LCD auto off (p.285)  
Auto power off (p.273)  
Sensor cleaning (p.286)  
Live View shooting (p.201)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
362  
     
B Button Functions  
Shooting Function Settings  
White balance correction  
Shutter speed  
Aperture  
ISO speed  
Shooting mode  
Highlight tone priority  
Exposure level  
indicator  
Flash exposure  
compensation  
Picture Style  
AF operation  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
Image-recording quality  
Number of possible shots  
Quick Control icon  
Battery level  
Multi Shot Noise Reduction  
White balance bracketing  
Drive mode  
AF area selection mode  
White balance  
Eye-Fi transmission status  
Metering mode  
GPS connection indicator  
Pressing the <Q> button enables Quick Control of the shooting  
settings (p.57).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
363  
     
3 Checking the Battery Information  
You can check the battery’s condition on the LCD monitor.  
Select [Battery info.].  
Under the [53] tab, select [Battery  
info.], then press <0>.  
The battery info. screen will appear.  
Battery position  
Battery model or household power source  
being used.  
The battery level icon (p.43) is displayed.  
Battery’s recharge performance level is  
displayed in one of three levels.  
(Green) : Battery’s recharge  
performance is fine.  
(Green) : Battery’s recharge  
performance is slightly  
degraded.  
(Red) : Purchasing a new  
battery is recommended.  
The use of a genuine Canon Battery Pack LP-E17 is recommended. If you  
use batteries that are not genuine Canon products, this camera’s full  
performance may not be attained or malfunction may result.  
The battery information will be displayed even when Battery Grip BG-  
E18 is used. If two LP-E17 battery packs are attached, it displays the  
remaining battery level of the two combined.  
If a battery communication error message is displayed, follow the  
message.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
364  
       
Using a Household Power Outlet  
With AC Adapter Kit ACK-E18 (sold separately), you can connect the  
camera to a household power outlet and not worry about the remaining  
battery level.  
Connect the DC Coupler’s plug.  
1
Connect the DC Coupler’s plug to the  
AC Adapter’s socket.  
Connect the power cord.  
2
Connect the power cord as shown in  
the illustration.  
After using the camera, unplug the  
power plug from the power outlet.  
Insert the DC Coupler.  
3
Open the battery compartment cover  
and insert the DC Coupler until it  
securely locks in place.  
Push in the DC cord.  
4
Open the DC cord hole cover and  
install the cord as shown in the  
illustration.  
Close the battery compartment cover.  
Do not connect or disconnect the power cord when the camera’s power  
switch is set to <1>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
365  
     
Remote Control Shooting  
Remote Controller RC-6 (Sold Separately)  
This remote controller enables you to take pictures wirelessly up to  
approx. 5 meters/16.4 feet away from the camera. You can either shoot  
immediately or use a 2-sec. delay.  
Remote control sensor  
Set the drive mode to <Q> (p.124).  
Point the remote controller toward the camera’s remote control  
sensor and press the transmit button.  
The camera will autofocus.  
When focus is achieved, the self-timer lamp will light up and the  
picture will be taken.  
Fluorescent or LED lighting may cause camera misoperation by  
triggering the shutter inadvertently. Try to keep the camera away from  
such light sources.  
If you point a remote controller for a TV set toward the camera and  
operate it, it may cause camera misoperation by triggering the shutter  
inadvertently.  
Remote Controller RC-1/RC-5 (sold separately) can also be used.  
Remote control shooting is also possible with an EX-series Speedlite  
equipped with a remote-release function.  
The Remote Controller can also be used during movie shooting (p.233).  
Note that Remote Controller RC-5 cannot be used to take still photos in  
the movie shooting mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
366  
     
Remote Control Shooting  
F Remote Switch RS-60E3 (Sold Separately)  
Remote Switch RS-60E3 (sold separately) comes with an approx. 60  
cm/2.0 ft cord. When connected to the camera’s remote control  
terminal, it can be pressed halfway and completely, just like the shutter  
button.  
Using the Eyepiece Cover  
When you use the self-timer, bulb, or Remote Switch and do not look  
through the viewfinder, stray light entering the viewfinder can cause the  
picture to look dark. To prevent this, use the eyepiece cover (p.35)  
attached to the camera strap.  
During Live View shooting and movie shooting, attaching the  
eyepiece cover is unnecessary.  
Detach the eyecup.  
1
Push the bottom of the eyecup to  
detach it.  
Attach the eyepiece cover.  
2
Slide the eyepiece cover down into  
the eyepiece groove to attach it.  
After you finish shooting, detach the  
eyepiece cover and attach the  
eyecup by sliding it down into the  
eyepiece groove.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
367  
         
H Using Eye-Fi Cards  
With a commercially-available Eye-Fi card already set up, you can  
automatically transfer captured images to a computer or upload them to  
an online service via a wireless LAN.  
The image transfer is a function of the Eye-Fi card. For instructions on  
how to set up and use the Eye-Fi card or to troubleshoot any image  
transfer problems, refer to the Eye-Fi card’s instruction manual or  
contact the card manufacturer.  
The camera is not guaranteed to support Eye-Fi card functions  
(including wireless transfer). In case of a problem with an Eye-  
Fi card, please check with the card manufacturer. Also note  
that approval is required to use Eye-Fi cards in many countries  
or regions. Without approval, use of the card is not permitted.  
If it is unclear whether the card has been approved for use in  
your area, please check with the card manufacturer.  
Insert an Eye-Fi card (p.39).  
1
Select [Eye-Fi settings].  
2
Under the [51] tab, select [Eye-Fi  
settings], then press <0>.  
This menu is displayed only when an  
Eye-Fi card is inserted into the  
camera.  
Enable Eye-Fi transmission.  
3
Select [Eye-Fi trans.], then press  
<0>.  
Select [Enable], then press <0>.  
If you set [Disable], there will be no  
automatic transmission even with the  
Eye-Fi card inserted (transmission  
status icon I).  
Display the connection information.  
4
Select [Connection info.], then press  
<0>.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
368  
       
H Using Eye-Fi Cards  
Check the [Access point SSID:].  
5
Check that an access point is  
displayed for [Access point SSID:].  
You can also check the Eye-Fi card’s  
MAC address and firmware version.  
Press the <M> button three times  
to exit the menu.  
Take the picture.  
6
The picture is transferred and the  
<H> icon switches from gray (not  
connected) to one of the icons below.  
For transferred images, O is  
displayed in the shooting information  
display (p.320).  
Transmission status icon  
H (Gray) Not connected : No connection with access point.  
H (Blinking) Connecting...: Connecting to access point.  
H (Illuminated) Connected: Connection to access point established.  
H () Transferring...  
:
Image transfer to access point in progress.  
Cautions for Using Eye-Fi Cards  
If [51:Wi-Fi/NFC] is set to [Enable], image transfer with an Eye-Fi card  
is not possible.  
If “J” is displayed, an error occurred while retrieving the card  
information. Turn the camera’s power switch off and on again.  
Even if [Eye-Fi trans.] is set to [Disable], it may still transmit a signal. In  
hospitals, airports, and other places where wireless transmissions are  
prohibited, remove the Eye-Fi card from the camera.  
If the image transfer does not function, check the Eye-Fi card and  
computer settings. For details, refer to the card’s instruction manual.  
Depending on the wireless LAN’s connection conditions, the image  
transfer may take longer or it may be interrupted.  
The Eye-Fi card may become hot as it transmits.  
The battery power will be consumed faster.  
During the image transfer, auto power off will not take effect.  
If you insert a wireless LAN card other than an Eye-Fi card, [Eye-Fi settings  
]
will not appear. Also, the transmission status icon < > will not appear.  
H
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
369  
Function Availability Table by Shooting Mode  
Still Photo Shooting in Basic Zone Modes  
o: Set automatically k: User selectable  
: Not selectable/Disabled  
8
Function  
A 7 C  
2
3
4
5
C
P
x
6
F
G
All image quality settings selectable  
k
o
k k k k k k k k k  
k
o
k*1 k*1  
Automatically set/Auto  
ISO speed  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Manually set  
Automatically set/Auto  
D D D D D D D D D D D  
D
D
Picture  
Style  
Manual selection  
Extra Effect Shot*1  
Ambience-based shots  
Lighting/scene based shots  
Background blur  
Color tone  
k
k k k k k k k k  
k k k  
k
k
o
k
k
k
k k  
k k k k k k k k  
Creative filters*1*2  
k
o
k
o
Auto  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Preset  
White  
balance  
Custom  
Correction/Bracketing  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
o
k
k
k
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
k
k
k
o
k
k
o
k
k
Peripheral illumination correction  
k k k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k k k  
Lens  
aberration Chromatic aberration correction  
correction  
Distortion correction  
Long exposure noise reduction  
High ISO speed noise reduction  
Highlight tone priority  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Anti-flicker shooting*3  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
sRGB  
Color  
space  
Adobe RGB  
Evaluative metering  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Center-weighted  
average metering  
Metering  
mode  
o
Metering mode selection  
*1: 1+73 or 1 cannot be selected.  
*2: Settable only during Live View shooting.  
*3: Works only during viewfinder shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
370  
   
Function Availability Table by Shooting Mode  
8
Function  
One-Shot AF  
A
7
C
2
3
4
5
C
P
x
6
F
G
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
AF operation  
(Viewfinder AI Servo AF  
o
o
shooting)  
AI Focus AF  
o
o
o
o
o
o
One-Shot AF  
AF operation  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
(
Live View shooting)  
Servo AF  
o
o
k
o
o
k
AF area selection mode  
AF point selection  
AF-assist beam  
o
o
k
o
k
o
o
k
o
o
k
o
k
o
o
k
o
o
k
o
o
k
o
o
k
o
o
k
o
o
k
AF  
*2  
Continuous AF  
Program shift  
Exposure compensation  
AEB  
Exposure  
AE lock  
Depth-of-field preview  
Single shooting  
Continuous shooting  
Silent single  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
*3  
Drive mode  
shooting  
Silent continuous  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
*3  
shooting  
Self-timer  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
Automatic firing  
Manual firing  
Flash off  
k
k
k
k
k
k
o
o
o
o
o
k
Built-in  
flash  
Red-eye reduction  
k
k
*3  
FE lock  
Flash exposure compensation  
Wireless control  
Function settings  
Custom Function settings  
External  
flash  
Live View shooting  
Aspect ratio  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Quick Control  
Feature guide  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
371  
 
Function Availability Table by Shooting Mode  
Still Photo Shooting in Creative Zone Modes  
o: Set automatically k: User selectable  
: Not selectable/Disabled  
Function  
d
s
f
a
All image quality settings selectable  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Automatically set/Auto  
ISO speed  
Manually set  
Automatically set/Auto  
Manual selection  
Picture Style  
Extra Effect Shot  
Ambience-based shots  
Lighting/scene based shots  
Background blur  
Color tone  
*1*2  
Creative filters  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Auto  
Preset  
White balance  
Custom  
Correction/Bracketing  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
Peripheral illumination  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
correction  
Lens aberration  
correction  
Chromatic aberration  
correction  
Distortion correction  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Long exposure noise reduction  
High ISO speed noise reduction  
Highlight tone priority  
*3  
Anti-flicker shooting  
sRGB  
Color space  
Adobe RGB  
Evaluative metering  
Metering mode selection  
Metering mode  
*1: 1+73 or 1 cannot be selected.  
*2: Settable only during Live View shooting.  
*3: Works only during viewfinder shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
372  
 
Function Availability Table by Shooting Mode  
Function  
One-Shot AF  
d
s
f
a
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
AF operation  
AI Servo AF  
(Viewfinder shooting)  
AI Focus AF  
One-Shot AF  
AF operation  
(Live View shooting)  
Servo AF  
AF area selection mode  
AF point selection  
AF  
AF-assist beam  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
*2  
Continuous AF  
Program shift  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Exposure compensation  
AEB  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Exposure  
k
*4  
AE lock  
Depth-of-field preview  
Single shooting  
Continuous shooting  
k
k
k
k
k
k
*3  
Drive mode  
Silent single shooting  
Silent continuous shooting*3  
Self-timer  
Automatic firing  
Manual firing  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Flash off  
Built-in flash  
External flash  
Red-eye reduction  
FE lock  
Flash exposure compensation  
Wireless control  
Function settings  
Custom Function settings  
Live View shooting  
Aspect ratio  
Quick Control  
Feature guide  
*4: With ISO Auto, you can set a fixed ISO speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
373  
 
Function Availability Table by Shooting Mode  
Movie Shooting  
o: Set automatically k: User selectable  
: Not selectable/Disabled  
Movies  
Still Photos  
z*1  
Function  
A 7 C  
2
3
4
5 8 d s f a  
y
k
M y k  
M
All image quality settings  
selectable (movie)  
k k k k k k k  
k
k k k k  
All image quality settings  
selectable (still photos)  
k
k
k
Video snapshot  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k
k
k
k
o
k k k k  
HDR movie shooting  
Miniature effect movie  
Digital zoom  
k k k k k*2 k*2 k*2  
k k k k  
Automatically set/Auto  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o o o k  
k
o
o
o
o
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
ISO  
speed  
Manually set  
Automatically set/Auto  
o
o
k k k k  
k k k k  
k k k k  
k k k k  
k k k k  
k k k k  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
Picture  
Style  
Manual selection  
Auto  
Preset  
White  
balance  
Custom  
Correction  
Bracketing  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
k
k k k k  
k k k k  
o
k
Peripheral illumination  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k
k
k
k
correction  
Lens  
Chromatic aberration  
aberration  
correction correction  
k
k k k k  
k
Distortion correction  
Long exposure noise reduction  
High ISO speed noise reduction  
Highlight tone priority  
k k k k  
o o o o  
k
k
k
k
k
k
sRGB  
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Color  
space  
Adobe RGB  
*1: The z icon indicates still photo shooting during movie shooting.  
*2: Still photos with a Miniature effect will be taken.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
374  
 
Function Availability Table by Shooting Mode  
Movies  
5 8 d s f a  
Still Photos  
Function  
A 7 C  
2
3
4
z*1  
M
M
y k  
y
k
Metering mode  
Face+Tracking  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k
k
k
k k k k  
k k k k  
k k k k  
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
FlexiZone - Multi  
FlexiZone - Single  
AF  
Manual focus  
(MF)  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k
k
k k k k  
k k k k  
k
k
k
k
k
k
Servo AF  
Program shift  
AE lock  
*3  
*3  
k k k  
k
k
Exposure  
compensation  
Exposure  
k k k  
AEB  
Depth-of-field preview  
Single shooting  
k
k
k
k
k
k
Continuous  
shooting*4  
Drive  
mode  
Silent single  
shooting  
Silent continuous  
shooting  
Self-timer*4  
k
k
k
k
k
k
Built-in flash  
Aspect ratio  
Sound recording  
Quick Control  
k k k k k k k  
k k k k k k k  
k
k
k k k k  
k k k k  
*3: With ISO Auto, you can set a fixed ISO speed.  
*4: Works only before you start shooting a movie.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
375  
 
System Map  
ST-E2 ST-E3-RT 90EX 270EX II 320EX 430EX II 600EX-RT/ Macro Ring Lite Macro Twin Lite  
600EX  
MR-14EX II  
MT-24EX  
Eyepiece Extender  
EP-EX15ll  
Bundled  
Accessories  
Magnifier  
MG-Ef  
Eyecup Ef  
Rubber Frame Ef  
Wide Strap  
E-series Dioptric  
Adjustment Lenses  
Angle Finder C  
AC Adapter Kit  
ACK-E18  
Semi Hard Case  
EH26-L/EH27-L  
Battery Charger  
LC-E17 or LC-E17E  
Battery Pack  
LP-E17  
AC Adapter DC Coupler  
Hand Strap E2  
AC-E6  
DR-E18  
Battery Grip  
BG-E18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
376  
   
System Map  
Remote  
Controller Remote Switch  
RC-6  
GPS Receiver  
GP-E2  
RS-60E3  
EF lenses  
EF-S lenses  
External microphone  
HDMI Cable  
HTC-100 (2.9 m/9.5 ft.)  
TV/Video  
Stereo AV Cable AVC-DC400ST (1.3 m/4.3 ft.)  
Connect Station CS100  
EOS DIGITAL  
Solution Disk  
PictBridge-compatible printer  
Interface Cable  
(1.3 m/4.3 ft.)  
Interface Cable IFC-200U/500U  
(1.9 m/6.2 ft.) / (4.7 m/15.4 ft.)  
USB port  
SD/SDHC/SDXC  
memory card  
Card reader  
Computer  
Card slot  
* All cable lengths given are approximate figures.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
377  
3 Menu Settings  
Viewfinder Shooting and Live View Shooting  
r Shooting 1 (Red)  
Page  
73 / 83 / 74 / 84 / 7a / 8a / b / c /  
Image quality  
1+73* / 1*  
Beep  
Enable / Touch to y / Disable  
Release shutter  
without card  
Enable / Disable  
Image review  
Off / 2 sec. / 4 sec. / 8 sec. / Hold  
Peripheral illumination correction: Enable / Disable  
Chromatic aberration correction: Enable / Disable  
Distortion correction: Disable / Enable  
Disable / Enable  
Lens aberration  
correction  
Red-eye reduction  
Flash control  
Flash firing / E-TTL II metering / Flash sync.  
speed in Av mode / Built-in flash settings /  
External flash function settings / External flash  
C.Fn setting / Clear settings  
* Not selectable in the <F> and <G> modes.  
s Shooting 2 (Red)  
1/3-stop or 1/2-stop increments, ±5 stops (AEB:  
±2 stops)  
Exposure  
compensation/AEB  
Disable / Low / Standard / High  
Disabled in manual exposure  
Auto Lighting  
Optimizer  
Custom White Balance Manual setting of white balance  
WB correction: White balance correction  
BKT setting: White balance bracketing  
White balance shift/  
bracketing  
Color space  
sRGB / Adobe RGB  
DAuto / PStandard /QPortrait /  
RLandscape /SNeutral / UFaithful /  
VMonochrome / WUser Def. 1-3  
Picture Style  
q Evaluative metering / w Partial metering /  
r Spot metering /  
Metering mode  
e Center-weighted average metering  
Shaded menu options are not displayed in Basic Zone modes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
378  
   
3 Menu Settings  
t Shooting 3 (Red)  
Page  
Obtain data to be used by EOS software to  
delete dust spots  
Dust Delete Data  
Max. ISO 400, Max. ISO 800, Max. ISO 1600,  
Max. ISO 3200, Max. ISO 6400  
ISO Auto  
Long exposure noise  
reduction  
Disable / Auto / Enable  
Disable / Low / Standard / High /  
Multi Shot Noise Reduction  
High ISO speed noise  
reduction  
Aspect ratio  
3:2 / 4:3 / 16:9 / 1:1  
Disable / Enable  
Anti-flicker shooting  
i Live View Shooting (Red)  
Live View shooting  
Enable / Disable  
u+Tracking / FlexiZone - Multi /  
FlexiZone - Single  
AF method  
Continuous AF  
Touch Shutter  
Grid display  
Enable / Disable  
Disable / Enable  
Off / Grid 1l / Grid 2m  
4 sec. / 8 sec. / 16 sec. / 30 sec. / 1 min. /  
10 min. / 30 min.  
Metering timer  
1 Playback 1 (Blue)  
Protect images  
Rotate image  
Protect images  
Rotate images  
Erase images  
Erase images  
Print order  
Specify images to be printed (DPOF)  
Specify images for a photobook  
Photobook Set-up  
Grainy B/W / Soft focus / Fish-eye effect /  
Art bold effect / Water painting effect /  
Toy camera effect / Miniature effect  
Creative filters  
Resize  
Downsize JPEG image’s pixel count  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
379  
 
3 Menu Settings  
2 Playback 2 (Blue)  
Cropping  
Page  
Crop part of the image  
Rating  
[OFF] / l / m / n / o / p  
Playback description / Display time / Repeat /  
Transition effect / Background music  
Slide show  
1 image / 10 images / 100 images / Date /  
Folder / Movies / Stills / Rating  
Image jump with 6  
AF point display  
Histogram display  
Control over HDMI  
Disable / Enable  
Brightness / RGB  
Disable / Enable  
4 Set-up 1 (Yellow)  
Select folder  
Create and select a folder  
Continuous / Auto reset / Manual reset  
OnzD / OnD / Off  
File numbering  
Auto rotate  
Format card  
Initialize and erase data on the card  
Disable / Enable  
Wi-Fi/NFC  
Allow NFC connections  
-*  
Transfer images between cameras / Connect to  
smartphone / Print from Wi-Fi printer / Upload  
to Web service / View images on DLNA devices  
Wi-Fi function  
Eye-Fi settings  
Displayed when a commercially-available Eye-  
Fi card is inserted  
* For details, refer to the Wi-Fi/NFC Function Instruction Manual on the CD-ROM.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
380  
 
3 Menu Settings  
6 Set-up 2 (Yellow)  
Page  
30 sec. / 1 min. / 2 min. / 4 min. / 8 min. /  
15 min. / Disable  
Auto power off  
LCD brightness  
LCD auto off  
Adjust the brightness (seven levels)  
Enable / Disable  
Date (year, month, day) / Time (hr., min., sec.) /  
Daylight saving time / Time zone  
Date/Time/Zone  
LanguageK  
Select the interface language  
Electronic level: Hide / Show  
Grid display: Hide / Show  
Viewfinder display  
GPS device settings  
Flicker detection: Show / Hide  
Settings available when the GPS Receiver  
GP-E2 (sold separately) is attached  
-
When using Wi-Fi function or GPS device, be sure to check the countries  
and areas of use, and use the device in accordance with the laws and  
regulations of the country or region.  
[Wi-Fi/NFC] cannot be set if the camera is connected to a computer,  
printer, GPS receiver, TV set, or other device with a cable. When [Wi-Fi/  
NFC] is set to [Enable], you cannot connect the camera to the above  
devices with a cable.  
When connecting this camera and the GPS Receiver GP-E2 with a  
cable, update the firmware of GP-E2 to Ver.2.0.0 or later. With the older  
versions, you cannot use this camera and GP-E2 connected with a  
cable. Note that GP-E2 can be used by attaching it to the camera’s hot  
shoe.  
For how to update the firmware, refer to the Canon Web site or contact  
the nearest Canon Service Center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
381  
3 Menu Settings  
7 Set-up 3 (Yellow)  
Screen color  
Page  
Select the shooting settings screen color  
Enable / Disable  
Feature guide  
Touch control  
Standard / Sensitive / Disable  
Remaining capacity / Recharge performance  
Auto cleaning: Enable / Disable  
Clean now  
Battery information  
Sensor cleaning  
Clean manually  
Displays camera settings / Electronic level /  
Displays shooting functions  
zbutton display  
options  
Video system  
NTSC / PAL  
C Set-up 4 (Yellow)  
Displays some of the logos of the camera’s  
certifications  
Certification Logo  
Display  
Custom Functions  
(C.Fn)  
Customize camera functions as desired  
Display copyright information /  
Enter author’s name /  
Enter copyright details /  
Delete copyright information  
Copyright information  
Clear all camera settings /  
Clear all Custom Func. (C.Fn)  
Clear settings  
-
zfirmware ver.*  
For updating the firmware  
* During firmware updates, the touch screen will be disabled to prevent accidental  
operations.  
9 My Menu (Green)  
Register frequently-used menu options and  
Custom Functions  
My Menu settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
382  
         
3 Menu Settings  
k Movie Shooting  
r Shooting 1 (Red)  
Image quality  
Page  
73 / 83 / 74 / 84 / 7a / 8a / b / c /  
1+73 / 1  
Beep  
Enable / Touch to y / Disable  
Enable / Disable  
Release shutter  
without card  
Image review  
Off / 2 sec. / 4 sec. / 8 sec. / Hold  
Peripheral illumination correction: Enable /  
Disable  
Lens aberration  
correction  
Chromatic aberration correction: Enable /  
Disable  
s Shooting 2 (Red)  
Exposure  
compensation  
1/3-stop or 1/2-stop increments, ±3 stops  
Disable / Low / Standard / High  
Disable during manual exposure  
Auto Lighting  
Optimizer  
Custom white  
balance  
Manual setting of white balance  
WB correction: White balance correction  
BKT setting: White balance bracketing  
White balance shift/  
bracketing  
Color space  
sRGB / Adobe RGB  
DAuto / PStandard /  
QPortrait / RLandscape /  
SNeutral / UFaithful /  
Picture Style  
VMonochrome / WUser Def. 1-3  
Shaded menu options are not displayed in Basic Zone modes.  
The menu tabs and options displayed will differ between viewfinder  
shooting/Live View shooting and movie shooting. Note that the menu  
tabs and options displayed in [x1] Playback 1, [x2] Playback 2, [51]  
Set-up 1 to [54] Set-up 4 and [9] My Menu are the same as those  
displayed in viewfinder shooting/Live View shooting (p.379-382).  
The [Z1] and [Z2] menu tabs will appear only for movie shooting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
383  
3 Menu Settings  
t Shooting 3 (Red)  
Page  
Obtain data to be used by EOS software to  
delete dust spots  
Dust Delete Data  
v Movie 1 (Red)  
u+Tracking / FlexiZone - Multi /  
FlexiZone - Single  
AF method  
Movie Servo AF  
Enable / Disable  
AF with shutter button  
during movie shooting One-Shot AF / Disable  
k
Grid display  
Off / Grid 1l / Grid 2m  
4 sec. / 8 sec. / 16 sec. / 30 sec. / 1 min. /  
10 min. / 30 min.  
Metering timer  
w Movie 2 (Red)  
Movie recording size  
Digital zoom  
• 1920x1080 / 1280x720 / 640x480  
• NTSC: 59.94p / 29.97p / 23.98p  
PAL: 50.00p / 25.00p  
• Standard / Light  
Disable / Approx. 3-10x zoom  
Sound recording: Auto / Manual / Disable  
Recording level  
Sound recording*  
Video snapshot  
Wind filter: Auto / Disable  
Attenuator: Disable / Enable  
Video snapshot: Enable / Disable  
Album settings: Create a new album / Add to  
existing album  
Show confirm message: Enable/Disable  
* In Basic Zone modes, [Sound recording] will be set to [On/Off].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
384  
Troubleshooting Guide  
If a problem occurs with the camera, first consult this Troubleshooting  
Guide. If this Troubleshooting Guide does not resolve the problem,  
contact your dealer or nearest Canon Service Center.  
Power-Related Problems  
The battery pack does not recharge.  
Do not use any battery pack other than a genuine Battery Pack  
LP-E17.  
The battery charger’s lamp blinks.  
If (1) the battery charger or battery pack has a problem or (2)  
communication with the battery pack failed (with a non-Canon battery  
pack), the protection circuit will stop charging, and the charge lamp will  
blink in orange. In the case of (1), unplug the charger’s power plug  
from the power outlet. Detach and reattach the battery pack to the  
charger. Wait a few minutes, then reconnect the power plug to the  
power outlet. If the problem persists, contact your dealer or nearest  
Canon Service Center.  
The camera does not operate even when the power switch is set to <  
1>.  
Make sure the battery is properly installed in the camera (p.38).  
Make sure the battery compartment cover is closed (p.38).  
Make sure the card slot cover is closed (p.39).  
Recharge the battery (p.36).  
Press the <B> button (p.67).  
The access lamp still blinks even when the power switch is set to <  
2>.  
If the power is turned off while an image is being recorded to the card,  
the access lamp will remain on/continue to blink for a few seconds.  
When the image recording is completed, the power will turn off  
automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
385  
 
Troubleshooting Guide  
[Battery communication error. Does this battery/do these  
batteries display the Canon logo?] is displayed.  
Do not use any battery pack other than a genuine Battery Pack LP-  
E17.  
Remove and install the battery again (p.38).  
If the battery contacts are dirty, use a soft cloth to clean them.  
The battery becomes exhausted quickly.  
Use a fully-charged battery pack (p.36).  
The battery performance may have degraded. See [53: Battery info.]  
to check the battery’s recharge performance level (p.364). If the  
battery performance is poor, replace the battery pack with a new one.  
The rechargeable battery pack performance will degrade over  
repeated use. Purchase a new one.  
The number of possible shots will decrease with any of the following  
operations:  
• Pressing the shutter button halfway for a prolonged period.  
• Activating the AF frequently without taking a picture.  
• Using the lens’s Image Stabilizer.  
• Using the LCD monitor frequently.  
• Continuing Live View shooting or movie shooting for a prolonged  
period.  
• The Eye-Fi card’s communication function is operating.  
The camera turns off by itself.  
Auto power off is in effect. If you do not want auto power off to take  
effect, set [52: Auto power off] to [Disable] (p.273).  
Even if [52: Auto power off] is set to [Disable], the LCD monitor will  
still turn off after the camera is left idle for 30 min. (The camera’s  
power does not turn off.) Press the <B> button to turn on the LCD  
monitor.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
386  
Troubleshooting Guide  
Shooting-Related Problems  
The lens cannot be attached.  
The camera cannot be used with EF-M lenses (p.47).  
The viewfinder is dark.  
Install a recharged battery pack in the camera (p.36).  
No images can be shot or recorded.  
Make sure the card is properly inserted (p.39).  
Slide the card’s write-protect switch to the write/erase position (p.39).  
If the card is full, replace the card or delete unnecessary images to  
make space (p.39, 318).  
If you try to focus in the One-Shot AF mode and the focus indicator  
<o> in the viewfinder blinks, a picture cannot be taken. Press the  
shutter button halfway again to refocus automatically, or focus  
manually (p.52, 121).  
The card cannot be used.  
If a card error message is displayed, see page 39 or 399.  
The image is out of focus.  
Set the lens’s focus mode switch to <AF> (p.47).  
Press the shutter button gently to prevent camera shake (p.51-52).  
If the lens has an Image Stabilizer, set the IS switch to <1>.  
In low light, the shutter speed may become slow. Use a faster shutter  
speed (p.160), set a higher ISO speed (p.132), use flash (p.176), or  
use a tripod.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
387  
Troubleshooting Guide  
I cannot lock the focus and recompose the shot.  
Set the AF operation to One-Shot AF. Focus lock is not possible in the  
AI Servo AF mode, or when servo takes effect in AI Focus AF mode  
(p.110).  
Linear noise or moire appears in the image.  
Depending on the subject, linear noise or moire may be recorded in  
the image.  
It is likely to occur especially in the following cases.  
• Shooting fine horizontal stripes, lattice patterns, etc.  
• When there is an intense light source such as sunlight or lighting in  
or near the shooting range.  
In such a case, noise and moire may be reduced by the following  
measures.  
• Change the size of the subject by changing the focusing distance or  
zoom magnification.  
• Recompose the shot to prevent an intense light source from entering  
the shooting range.  
• Attach the lens hood to prevent intense light from entering the lens.  
If you use a TS-E lens and shift or tilt, linear noise or moire may be  
recorded in the image.  
Horizontal stripes appear, or the exposure or color tone look  
strange.  
Horizontal stripes (noise) or irregular exposures can be caused by  
fluorescent lighting, LED lighting, or other light sources during  
viewfinder or Live View shooting. Also, the exposure or color tone may  
not come out right. A slow shutter speed may solve the problem.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
388  
Troubleshooting Guide  
The continuous shooting speed is slow.  
Depending on the lens type, shutter speed, aperture, subject  
conditions, brightness, etc., the continuous shooting speed may  
become slower.  
If [z3: Anti-flicker shoot.] is set to [Enable] and you shoot under a  
flickering light source, the continuous shooting speed may become  
slightly slower, or the continuous shooting interval may become  
irregular. Also, the time lag until shutter release may be slightly longer  
than usual (p.154).  
If you set [Distortion] to [Enable], the continuous shooting speed will  
decrease (p.151).  
The maximum burst during continuous shooting is lower.  
If you shoot something that has fine detail such as a field of grass, the  
file size will be larger, and the actual maximum burst may be lower  
than the number mentioned on page 127.  
ISO 100 cannot be set.  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [3: Highlight tone priority]  
is set to [1: Enable], ISO 100 cannot be set. If [0: Disable] is set, ISO  
100 can be set (p.353). This also applies to movie shooting (p.238).  
ISO speed [H] (equivalent to ISO 25600) cannot be set.  
Under [  
set to [1: Enable], the [  
be selected even when [2: ISO expansion] is set to [1: On]. If [0:  
Disable] is set for [3: Highlight tone priority], [ ] can be set (p.353).  
5
4: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [3: Highlight tone priority] is  
H
] ISO speed (equivalent to ISO 25600) cannot  
H
The Auto Lighting Optimizer cannot be set.  
Under [54: Custom Functions (C.Fn)], if [3: Highlight tone priority]  
is set to [1: Enable], the Auto Lighting Optimizer cannot be set. If [0:  
Disable] is set, the Auto Lighting Optimizer can be set (p.353).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
389  
Troubleshooting Guide  
Even though I set a decreased exposure compensation,  
the image comes out bright.  
Set [z2: Auto Lighting Optimizer] to [Disable]. When [Low],  
[Standard], or [High] is set, even if you set a decreased exposure  
compensation or flash exposure compensation, the image may come  
out bright (p.146).  
When I use the <f> mode with flash, the shutter speed  
becomes slow.  
If you shoot at night when the background is dark, the shutter speed  
automatically becomes slow (slow-sync shooting) so that both the  
subject and background are properly exposed. To prevent a slow  
shutter speed, under [z1: Flash control], set [Flash sync. speed in  
Av mode] to [1/200-1/60sec. auto] or [1/200 sec. (fixed)] (p.184).  
The built-in flash rises by itself.  
In shooting modes (<A> <C> <2> <4> <C> <6>) whose  
default setting is <a> (Auto flash), the built-in flash will be raised  
automatically when necessary.  
In the <x> and <G> modes, when you press the shutter button  
halfway under low-light conditions, the built-in flash may be raised  
automatically and emit the AF-assist beam.  
The built-in flash does not fire.  
If you use the built-in flash too often in too short a period of time, the  
flash may stop firing for a while to protect the light-emitting unit.  
The external flash always fires at full output.  
If you use a flash unit other than an EX-series Speedlite, the flash will  
always be fired at full output (p.182).  
Under [z1: Flash control], if [Flash metering mode] in [External  
flash C.Fn setting] is set to [TTL flash metering] (autoflash), the  
flash will always fire at full output (p.188).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
390  
Troubleshooting Guide  
Flash exposure compensation cannot be set for the  
external Speedlite.  
If flash exposure compensation is set with the external Speedlite, flash  
exposure compensation cannot be set with the camera. When the  
external Speedlite’s flash exposure compensation is canceled (set to 0),  
flash exposure compensation can be set with the camera.  
High-speed sync cannot be set in the <f> mode.  
Under [z1: Flash control], set [Flash sync. speed in Av mode] to  
[Auto] (p.184).  
The camera makes a small noise when it is shaken.  
A small noise may be heard when the camera’s internal mechanism  
moves slightly.  
The shutter makes two shooting sounds during  
Live View shooting.  
If you use flash, the shutter will make two sounds each time you shoot  
(p.203).  
During Live View or movie shooting, a white <s> or  
red <E> icon is displayed.  
It indicates that the camera’s internal temperature is high. If the white  
<s> icon is displayed, the still photo’s image quality may deteriorate.  
If the red <E> icon is displayed, it indicates that the Live View or  
movie shooting will soon stop automatically (p.230, 268).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
391  
Troubleshooting Guide  
Movie shooting stops by itself.  
If the card’s writing speed is slow, movie shooting may stop  
automatically. Use an SD Speed Class 6 “  
find out the card’s reading/writing speed, refer to the card  
manufacturer’s Web site, etc.  
” or faster card. To  
If the movie shooting time reaches 29 min. 59 sec., the movie shooting  
will stop automatically.  
The ISO speed cannot be set for movie shooting.  
In shooting modes other than <a>, the ISO speed is set  
automatically. In the <a> mode, you can freely set the ISO speed  
(p.238).  
The exposure changes during movie shooting.  
If you change the shutter speed or aperture during movie shooting, the  
changes in the exposure may be recorded.  
Zooming the lens during movie shooting can cause changes in the  
exposure regardless of whether the lens’s maximum aperture changes  
or not. The changes in the exposure may be recorded as a result.  
The subject looks distorted during movie shooting.  
If you move the camera to the left or right quickly (high-speed panning)  
or shoot a moving subject, the image may look distorted.  
The image flickers or horizontal stripes appear during  
movie shooting.  
Flickering, horizontal stripes (noise), or irregular exposures can be  
caused by fluorescent lighting, LED lighting, or other light sources  
during movie shooting. Also, changes in the exposure (brightness) or  
color tone may be recorded. In the <a> mode, a slow shutter speed  
may reduce the problem.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
392  
Troubleshooting Guide  
Wi-Fi  
Wi-Fi cannot be set.  
If the camera is connected to a computer, printer, GPS receiver, TV  
set, or other device with a cable, Wi-Fi cannot be set ([51: Wi-Fi/NFC]  
will be grayed out). Disconnect the cable before changing any settings.  
For details, refer to the Wi-Fi/NFC Function Instruction Manual.  
Operation Problems  
I cannot change the setting with the <6> dial or <5> dial.  
Set the <R> switch to the left (lock release, p.55).  
Check the setting for [13: Multi function lock] under [54: Custom  
Functions (C.Fn).] (p.359).  
During touch screen operations, the beeper suddenly  
sounds softer.  
Check if your finger is blocking the speaker (p.26).  
Display Problems  
The LCD monitor does not turn on or suddenly turns off.  
If there is dust on top of the eyepiece cover (p.367), the LCD monitor  
may not turn on or may suddenly turn off, due to incorrect operation of  
the display-off sensor. If this occurs, remove the dust.  
If the LCD monitor does not turn on with Eyepiece Extender EP-EX15ll  
(sold separately) or Magnifier MG-Ef (sold separately) attached to the  
viewfinder, set [52: LCD auto off] to [Disable] (p.285).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
393  
Troubleshooting Guide  
The menu screen shows fewer tabs and options.  
In Basic Zone modes and in movie shooting mode, certain tabs and  
menu options are not displayed. Set the shooting mode to a Creative  
Zone mode (p.59).  
The file name’s first character is an underscore (“_”).  
Set the color space to sRGB. If Adobe RGB is set, the first character  
will be an underscore (p.156).  
The file name starts with “MVI_”.  
It is a movie file (p.278).  
The file numbering does not start from 0001.  
If the card already contains recorded images, the image number may  
not start from 0001 (p.278).  
The shooting date and time displayed is incorrect.  
Check that the correct date and time are set (p.44).  
Check the time zone and daylight saving time (p.44).  
The date and time are not in the picture.  
The shooting date and time do not appear in the picture. The date and  
time are instead recorded in the image data as shooting information.  
When printing, you can imprint the date and time in the picture, using  
the date and time recorded in the shooting information (p.339).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
394  
Troubleshooting Guide  
[###] is displayed.  
If the number of images recorded on the card exceeds the number the  
camera can display, [###] will be displayed (p.299).  
The LCD monitor does not display a clear image.  
If the LCD monitor is dirty, use a soft cloth to clean it.  
In low or high temperatures, the LCD monitor display may seem slow  
or may look black. It will return to normal at room temperature.  
[Eye-Fi settings] does not appear.  
[Eye-Fi settings] will appear only when an Eye-Fi card is inserted in  
the camera. If the Eye-Fi card has a write-protect switch set to the  
LOCK position, you will not be able to check the card’s connection  
status or disable Eye-Fi transmission (p.368).  
Playback Problems  
Part of the image blinks in black.  
It is the highlight alert (p.324). Overexposed areas with clipped  
highlight will blink.  
The image cannot be erased.  
If the image is protected, it cannot be erased (p.316).  
The movie cannot be played back.  
Movies edited with a computer cannot be played back with the camera.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
395  
Troubleshooting Guide  
Camera operation noise can be heard when the movie is  
played back.  
If you operate the camera’s dials or lens during movie shooting, the  
operation noise will also be recorded. Using an external microphone  
(commercially available) is recommended (p.266).  
The movie has still moments.  
During autoexposure movie shooting, if there is a drastic change in the  
exposure level, the recording will stop momentarily until the brightness  
stabilizes. In such cases, shoot in <a> mode (p.237).  
No picture on the TV set.  
Check that the HDMI cable or stereo AV cable’s plug is inserted all the  
way in (p.312-315).  
Set the [53: Video system] correctly to [NTSC] or [PAL] (depending  
on the video system of your TV set).  
If [51: Wi-Fi/NFC] is set to [Enable], the camera cannot be connected  
to a TV set. Set [Wi-Fi/NFC] to [Disable], then reconnect the camera  
to the TV set with the HDMI cable or stereo AV cable.  
There are multiple movie files for a single movie shoot.  
If the movie file size reaches 4 GB, another movie file will be created  
automatically (p.247).  
My card reader does not recognize the card.  
Depending on the card reader and computer OS used, SDXC cards  
may not be correctly recognized. In such a case, connect your camera  
to the computer with the interface cable, then transfer the images to  
your computer using EOS Utility (EOS software, p.420).  
I cannot resize the image. I cannot crop the image.  
JPEG c and RAW images cannot be resized or cropped (p.329,  
p.331).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
396  
Troubleshooting Guide  
A red box is displayed on the image.  
[32: AF point disp.] is set to [Enable] (p.323).  
A red box is not displayed on the image.  
Even if [32: AF point display] is set to [Enable] (p.323), the red box  
is not displayed for the following images:  
• Images shot with Multi Shot Noise Reduction (p.147)  
• Images recorded with distortion correction enabled (p.151)  
• Images shot with <F> or <G> in <8> mode  
• Cropped images (p.331)  
• Images with Fish-eye effect applied after shooting (p.326)  
Sensor Cleaning Problems  
The shutter makes a noise during sensor cleaning.  
If you selected [Clean nowf], the shutter will make a noise, but no  
picture is taken (p.286).  
Automatic sensor cleaning does not work.  
If you repeatedly turn the power switch <1> / <2> at a short  
interval, the <f> icon may not be displayed (p.42).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
397  
Troubleshooting Guide  
Printing-Related Problems  
There are fewer printing effects than listed in  
the instruction manual.  
Contents displayed on the screen vary depending on the printer. This  
instruction manual lists all the printing effects available (p.338).  
Direct printing does not work.  
If any of the following shooting modes or functions is set, the camera  
cannot be connected to a printer. Cancel all the relevant settings, then  
reconnect the camera to the printer with an interface cable.  
• <F> or <G> in <8> mode  
• Multi Shot Noise Reduction  
• [51: Wi-Fi/NFC] set to [Enable]  
Computer Connection Problems  
I cannot download images to a computer.  
Install the EOS software (EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk CD-ROM) on  
the computer (p.420).  
If [51: Wi-Fi/NFC] is set to [Enable], the camera cannot be connected  
to a computer. Set [Wi-Fi/NFC] to [Disable], then reconnect the  
camera to a computer with an interface cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
398  
Error Codes  
If there is a problem with the camera, an  
error message will appear. Follow the on-  
screen instructions.  
Error number  
Cause and countermeasures  
Number  
Error Message and Solution  
Communications between the camera and lens is faulty. Clean the  
lens contacts.  
01  
02  
Clean the electrical contacts on the camera and lens, use a Canon  
lens, or remove and install the battery pack again (p.25, 26, 38).  
Card cannot be accessed. Reinsert/change card or format card  
with camera.  
Remove and insert the card again, replace the card, or format the  
card (p.39, 65).  
Cannot save images because card is full. Replace card.  
04  
05  
06  
Replace the card, erase unnecessary images, or format the card  
The built-in flash could not be raised. Turn the camera off and on  
again.  
Operate the power switch (p.42).  
Sensor cleaning could not be performed. Turn the camera off and  
on again.  
Operate the power switch (p.42).  
10, 20 An error prevented shooting. Turn the camera off and on again or  
30, 40 re-install the battery.  
50, 60  
70, 80  
99  
Operate the power switch, remove and install the battery pack  
again, or use a Canon lens (p.42, 38, 47).  
* If the error still persists, write down the error number and contact your  
nearest Canon Service Center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
399  
   
Handling Precautions: STM Lenses (Kit Lenses)  
Kit lenses* use a stepping motor that drives the focus lens. The motor  
controls the focus lens even during zooming.  
* EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM, EF-S18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM, and  
EF-S55-250mm f/4-5.6 IS STM  
1. When the camera is OFF  
The motor does not operate while the camera is OFF or when the  
camera is OFF due to the auto power off function. Therefore, users  
must be aware of the following points.  
Manual focusing is not possible.  
During zooming, inaccurate focusing may occur.  
2. When the lens is in sleep mode  
If not operated for a certain period of time, this lens will enter sleep  
mode in order to save power, apart from the camera’s auto power off.  
To exit sleep mode, press the shutter button halfway.  
In sleep mode, the motor will not operate even if the camera is ON.  
Therefore, users must be aware of the following points.  
Manual focusing is not possible.  
During zooming, inaccurate focusing may occur.  
3. During initial reset  
When the camera is turned ON or when the camera is turned ON by  
pressing the shutter button halfway when the camera is OFF due to  
the auto power off function*1, the lens performs an initial reset of the  
focus lens.  
Although the image in the viewfinder will appear out of focus  
during the initial reset, this is not a malfunction.  
Wait approx. 1 second*2 until the initial reset has completed  
before shooting.  
*1: Applicable to the following EF-S lens compatible digital SLR cameras:  
EOS 7D Mark II, EOS 7D, EOS 70D, EOS 60D, EOS 60Da, EOS 50D, EOS  
40D, EOS 30D, EOS 20D, EOS 20Da, EOS REBEL T3i/600D, EOS REBEL  
T2i/550D, EOS REBEL T1i/500D, EOS REBEL XSi/450D, EOS REBEL T5/  
1200D, EOS REBEL T3/1100D, EOS REBEL XS/1000D, EOS DIGITAL  
REBEL XTi/400D DIGITAL, EOS DIGITAL REBEL XT/350D DIGITAL, EOS  
DIGITAL REBEL/300D DIGITAL  
*2: The initial reset time varies depending on the camera used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
400  
 
Specifications  
• Type  
Type:  
Recording media:  
Digital, single-lens reflex, AF/AE camera with built-in flash  
SD/SDHC*/SDXC* memory cards  
* Compatible with UHS-I cards  
Approx. 22.3 x 14.9 mm  
Canon EF lenses (including EF-S lenses)  
* Excluding EF-M lenses  
Image sensor size:  
Compatible lenses:  
(35 mm-equivalent focal length is approx. 1.6 times the  
lens focal length)  
Lens mount:  
Canon EF mount  
• Image Sensor  
Type:  
CMOS sensor  
Effective pixels:  
Approx. 24.2 megapixels  
* Rounded off to the nearest 10,000th.  
3:2  
Aspect ratio:  
Dust delete feature:  
Auto/Manual, Appending Dust Delete Data  
• Recording System  
Recording format:  
Image type:  
Design rule for Camera File System (DCF) 2.0  
JPEG, RAW (14-bit Canon original)  
RAW+JPEG Large simultaneous recording possible  
Recorded pixels:  
L (Large)  
: 24 megapixels (6000 x 4000)  
M (Medium) : Approx. 10.6 megapixels (3984 x 2656)  
S1 (Small 1) : Approx. 5.9 megapixels (2976 x 1984)  
S2 (Small 2) : Approx. 2.5 megapixels (1920 x 1280)  
S3 (Small 3) : Approx. 350,000 pixels (720 x 480)  
RAW  
: 24 megapixels (6000 x 4000)  
Aspect ratio:  
3:2, 4:3, 16:9, 1:1  
Create/select a folder: Possible  
File numbering:  
Continuous, Auto reset, Manual reset  
• Image Processing During Shooting  
Picture Style:  
Auto, Standard, Portrait, Landscape, Neutral, Faithful,  
Monochrome, User Def. 1 - 3  
Basic+:  
Extra Effect Shot:  
White balance:  
Ambience-based shots, Light/scene-based shots  
Possible (in <CA> mode)  
Auto, Preset (Daylight, Shade, Cloudy, Tungsten light,  
White fluorescent light, Flash), Custom  
White Balance correction and White balance bracketing  
possible  
* Flash color temperature information transmission  
enabled  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
401  
 
Specifications  
Noise reduction:  
Automatic image  
brightness correction:  
Applicable to long exposures and high ISO speed shots  
Auto Lighting Optimizer  
Highlight tone priority: Provided  
Lens aberration  
correction:  
Peripheral illumination correction, Chromatic aberration  
correction, Distortion correction  
• Viewfinder  
Type:  
Eye-level pentamirror  
Coverage:  
Vertical/Horizontal approx. 95% (with Eye point approx.  
19 mm)  
*
Vertical field of view in the 16:9 aspect ratio is approx. 93%.  
-1  
Magnification:  
Eye point:  
Built-in dioptric  
adjustment:  
Approx. 0.82x (-1 m with 50mm lens at infinity)  
Approx. 19 mm (from eyepiece lens center at -1 m  
Approx. -3.0 - +1.0 m (dpt)  
-1  
)
-1  
Focusing screen:  
Grid display:  
Fixed, Precision Matte  
Possible  
Electronic level display: Possible  
Mirror:  
Quick-return type  
Depth-of-field preview: Provided  
• Autofocus  
Type:  
TTL secondary image-registration, phase-difference  
detection with the dedicated AF sensor  
AF points:  
19 points (cross-type AF point: max. 19 points)  
* With certain lenses, cross-type focusing at the  
peripheral AF points is not possible.  
* Dual cross-type focusing at f/2.8 with center AF point.  
(Except with the EF28-80mm f/2.8-4L USM and  
EF50mm f/2.5 Compact Macro.)  
Focusing brightness range: EV -0.5 - 18 (Conditions: f/2.8-sensitive center AF point,  
One-Shot AF, room temperature, ISO 100)  
Focus operation:  
One-Shot AF, AI Servo AF, AI Focus AF  
Manual focusing (MF)  
AF area selection mode: Single-point AF (Manual selection), Zone AF (Manual  
selection of zone), 19-point automatic selection AF  
Condition of AF point  
automatic selection:  
AF point can be selected automatically in One-Shot AF  
mode, using information on colors equivalent to skin  
tones.  
AF-assist beam:  
Small series of flashes fired by built-in flash  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
402  
Specifications  
• Exposure Control  
Metering mode:  
63-zone TTL full-aperture metering using 7560-pixel  
RGB plus IR metering sensor  
• Evaluative metering (linked to all AF points)  
• Partial metering (approx. 6.0% of viewfinder at center)  
• Spot metering (approx. 3.5% of viewfinder at center)  
• Center-weighted average metering  
Metering brightness range: EV 1 - 20 (One-Shot AF at room temperature, ISO 100)  
Exposure control:  
Program AE (Scene Intelligent Auto, Flash Off, Creative  
Auto, Portrait, Landscape, Close-up, Sports, Special  
scene modes (Kids, Food, Candlelight, Night Portrait,  
Handheld Night Scene, HDR Backlight Control),  
Program), Shutter-priority AE, Aperture-priority AE,  
Manual exposure  
ISO speed  
(Recommended  
exposure index):  
Basic Zone modes*: ISO 100 - ISO 6400 set  
automatically  
* Landscape: ISO 100 - ISO 1600, <SCN> Handheld  
Night Scene: ISO 100 - ISO 12800  
Creative Zone modes: ISO 100 - ISO 12800 set  
manually (whole-stop increments), ISO 100 - ISO 6400  
set automatically, maximum ISO speed settable for ISO  
Auto, or ISO expansion to “H” (equivalent to ISO 25600)  
Manual: ±5 stops in 1/3- or 1/2-stop increments  
Exposure  
compensation:  
AEB:  
±2 stops in 1/3- or 1/2-stop increments (can be  
combined with manual exposure compensation)  
AE lock:  
Auto:  
Applied in One-Shot AF with evaluative  
metering when focus is achieved  
Manual: By AE lock button  
Possible  
Anti-flicker:  
• Shutter  
Type:  
Shutter speed:  
Electronically-controlled, focal-plane shutter  
1/4000 sec. to 30 sec. (Total shutter speed range.  
Available range varies by shooting mode.), Bulb, X-sync  
at 1/200 sec.  
• Drive System  
Drive modes:  
Single shooting, Continuous shooting, Silent single  
shooting, Silent continuous shooting,  
Self-timer: 10-sec. delay/remote control, 2-sec. delay,  
10-sec. delay with continuous shooting  
Continuous shooting  
speed:  
Continuous shooting: Max. approx. 5.0 shots/sec.  
Silent continuous shooting: Max. approx. 3.0 shots/sec.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
403  
Specifications  
Max. burst (Approx.):  
JPEG Large/Fine: 180 (940) shots  
RAW: 7 (8) shots  
RAW+JPEG Large/Fine: 6 (6) shots  
* Figures are based on Canon’s testing standards (3:2  
aspect ratio, ISO 100 and Standard Picture Style) using  
an 8 GB card.  
* Figures in parentheses apply to an UHS-I compatible  
8 GB card based on Canon’s testing standards.  
• Flash  
Built-in flash:  
Retractable, auto pop-up flash  
Guide No.: Approx. 12/39.4 (ISO 100, in meters/feet)  
Flash coverage: Approx. 17mm lens angle of view  
Recycling time approx. 3 sec.  
External flash:  
Flash metering:  
Flash exposure  
compensation:  
FE lock:  
EX-series Speedlite  
E-TTL II autoflash  
±2 stops in 1/3- or 1/2-stop increments  
Provided  
PC terminal:  
Flash control:  
None  
Built-in flash function settings, external Speedlite  
function settings, external Speedlite Custom Function  
settings  
Wireless flash control via optical transmission possible  
• Live View Shooting  
Focus method:  
Hybrid CMOS AF III System (Face+Tracking, FlexiZone-  
Multi, FlexiZone-Single), Manual focus (approx. 5x / 10x  
magnification possible)  
AF operation:  
One-Shot AF, Servo AF  
Continuous AF:  
Provided  
Focusing brightness range: EV 0 - 18 (at room temperature, ISO 100)  
Touch shutter:  
Provided  
Metering mode:  
Real-time metering with image sensor  
Evaluative metering (315 zones), Partial metering  
(approx. 10% of Live View screen), Spot metering  
(approx. 2.7% of Live View screen), Center-weighted  
average metering  
Metering brightness  
range:  
EV 0 - 20 (at room temperature, ISO 100)  
Creative Filter:  
Grainy B/W, Soft focus, Fish-eye effect, Art bold effect,  
Water painting effect, Toy camera effect, Miniature effect  
Two types  
Grid display:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
404  
Specifications  
• Movie Shooting  
Recording format:  
Movie:  
MP4  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264  
Variable (average) bit rate  
AAC  
Audio:  
Recording size and  
frame rate:  
Full HD (1920x1080) : 29.97p/25.00p/23.98p  
HD (1280x720)  
VGA (640x480)  
: 59.94p/50.00p/29.97p/25.00p  
: 29.97p/25.00p  
Compression method: Standard/Light  
File size:  
Full HD (29.97p/25.00p/23.98p)  
(Standard)  
: Approx. 216 MB/min.  
Full HD (29.97p/25.00p) (Light) : Approx. 87 MB/min.  
HD (59.94p/50.00p) (Standard) : Approx. 187 MB/min.  
HD (29.97p/25.00p) (Light)  
: Approx. 30 MB/min.  
VGA (29.97p/25.00p) (Standard) : Approx. 66 MB/min.  
VGA (29.97p/25.00p) (Light)  
HDR Movie Shooting  
: Approx. 23 MB/min.  
: Approx. 94MB/min.  
Focus method:  
Digital zoom:  
Same as focusing with Live View shooting  
Approx. 3x to 10x  
Movie Servo AF:  
Provided  
Focusing brightness range: EV 0 - 18 (at room temperature, ISO 100)  
Metering mode:  
Center-weighted average and evaluative metering with  
the image sensor  
* Automatically set by the focus method.  
Metering brightness range: EV 0 - 20 (at room temperature, ISO 100)  
Exposure control:  
Exposure  
Program AE for movies and manual exposure  
±3 stops in 1/3- or 1/2-stop increments  
compensation:  
ISO speed  
(Recommended  
exposure index):  
With autoexposure shooting:  
ISO 100 - ISO 6400 set automatically  
With manual exposure: ISO 100 - ISO 6400 set  
automatically/manually, expandable to H (equivalent to  
ISO 12800)  
HDR movies:  
Possible  
Miniature effect movie: Possible  
Video snapshots:  
Sound recording:  
Settable to 2 sec./4 sec./8 sec.  
Built-in stereo microphones  
External stereo microphone terminal provided  
Sound-recording level adjustable, wind filter provided,  
attenuator provided  
Grid display:  
Two types  
Still photo shooting:  
Possible  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
405  
Specifications  
• LCD Monitor  
Type:  
TFT color liquid-crystal monitor  
Monitor size and dots: Wide, 7.7 cm (3.0-in.) (3:2) with approx. 1.04 million dots  
Brightness adjustment: Manual (7 levels)  
Electronic level display: Possible  
Interface languages:  
Touch screen  
25  
Capacitive sensing  
technology:  
Feature guide:  
Displayable  
• Playback  
Image display format:  
Single-image display (without shooting information),  
Single-image display (with simple information), Single-  
image display (Shooting information displayed: Detailed  
information, Lens/histogram, White balance, Picture  
Style, Color space/noise reduction, Lens aberration  
correction), Index display (4/9/36/100 images)  
Approx. 1.5x - 10x  
Zoom magnification:  
Highlight alert:  
Overexposed highlights blink  
AF point display:  
Provided  
Image browsing method: Single image, jump by 10 or 100 images, by shooting  
date, by folder, by movies, by stills, by rating  
Image rotate:  
Ratings:  
Possible  
Provided  
Movie playback:  
Enabled (LCD monitor, audio/video OUT, HDMI OUT)  
Built-in speaker  
Image protect:  
Slide show:  
Possible  
All images, by date, by folder, by movies, by stills, by  
rating  
Five transition effects selectable  
Selectable for slide shows and movie playback  
Background music:  
• Post-Processing of Images  
Creative filters:  
Grainy B/W, Soft focus, Fish-eye effect, Art bold effect,  
Water painting effect, Toy camera effect, Miniature effect  
Resize:  
Cropping:  
Possible  
Possible  
• Direct Printing  
Compatible printers:  
Printable images:  
Print ordering:  
PictBridge-compatible printers  
JPEG and RAW images  
DPOF Version 1.1 compatible  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
406  
Specifications  
• Custom Functions  
Custom Functions:  
14  
My Menu registration:  
Possible  
Copyright information: Entry and inclusion enabled  
• Interface  
Audio/video OUT/Digital Analog video (compatible with NTSC/PAL)/stereo audio  
terminal:  
output  
Hi-Speed USB equivalent: Computer communication,  
Direct printing, GPS Receiver GP-E2, Connect Station  
CS100 connection  
HDMI mini OUT  
terminal:  
Type C (Auto switching of resolution), CEC-compatible  
External microphone IN 3.5 mm diameter stereo mini-jack  
terminal:  
Remote control terminal: For Remote Switch RS-60E3  
Wireless remote control: Compatible with Remote Controller RC-6  
Eye-Fi card:  
Compatible  
• Power  
Battery:  
Battery Pack LP-E17 (Quantity 1)  
* AC power can be supplied via AC Adapter Kit ACK-E18  
With viewfinder shooting: Approx. 440 shots at room  
temperature (23°C/73°F), approx. 400 shots at low  
temperatures (0°C/32°F)  
Number of possible  
shots:  
With Live View shooting: Approx. 180 shots at room  
temperature (23°C/73°F), approx. 150 shots at low  
temperatures (0°C/32°F)  
* With a fully-charged Battery Pack LP-E17.  
Approx. 1 hr. 20 min. at room temperature (23°C/73°F)  
Approx. 1 hr. at low temperatures (0°C/32°F)  
* With a fully-charged Battery Pack LP-E17.  
Movie shooting time:  
• Dimensions and Weight  
Dimensions (W x H x D): Approx. 131.9 x 100.9 x 77.8 mm / 5.20 x 3.98 x 3.07 in.  
Weight:  
Approx. 565 g / 19.93 oz. (CIPA Guidelines),  
Approx. 520 g / 18.35 oz. (Body only)  
• Operation Environment  
Working temperature  
range:  
0°C - 40°C / 32°F - 104°F  
Working humidity:  
85% or less  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
407  
Specifications  
• Battery Pack LP-E17  
Type:  
Rated voltage:  
Battery capacity:  
Working temperature  
range:  
Rechargeable lithium-ion battery  
7.2 V DC  
1040 mAh  
During charging: 5°C - 40°C / 41°F - 104°F  
During shooting: 0°C - 40°C / 32°F - 104°F  
85% or less  
Working humidity:  
Dimensions (W x H x D): Approx. 33.0 x 14.0 x 49.4 mm / 1.30 x 0.55 x 1.94 in.  
Weight: Approx. 45 g / 1.59 oz. (excluding protective cover)  
• Battery Charger LC-E17  
Compatible battery:  
Recharging time:  
Rated input:  
Battery Pack LP-E17  
Approx. 2 hours (at room temperature (23°C/73°F))  
100 - 240 V AC (50/60 Hz)  
Rated output:  
8.4 V DC / 700 mA  
Working temperature  
range:  
5°C - 40°C / 41°F - 104°F  
Working humidity:  
85% or less  
Dimensions (W x H x D): Approx. 67.3 x 27.7 x 92.2 mm / 2.65 x 1.09 x 3.63 in.  
(prongs retracted)  
Weight:  
Approx. 85 g / 3 oz.  
• Battery Charger LC-E17E  
Compatible battery:  
Recharging time:  
Rated input:  
Battery Pack LP-E17  
Approx. 2 hours (at room temperature (23°C/73°F))  
100 - 240 V AC (50/60 Hz)  
Rated output:  
8.4 V DC / 700 mA  
Working temperature  
range:  
5°C - 40°C / 41°F - 104°F  
Working humidity:  
85% or less  
Dimensions (W x H x D): Approx. 67.3 x 27.7 x 92.2 mm / 2.65 x 1.09 x 3.63 in.  
(excluding power cord)  
Weight:  
Approx. 80 g / 2.82 oz. (excluding power cord)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
408  
Specifications  
• EF-S18-135mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM  
Focal length / Aperture: 18 mm-135 mm f/3.5-5.6  
Lens construction:  
Minimum aperture:  
16 elements in 12 groups  
f/22 - 36  
* f/22-38 when 1/2-stop increments set for aperture.  
Angle of view:  
Diagonal extent: 74°20´ - 11°30´  
Vertical extent: 45°30´ - 6°20´  
Horizontal extent: 64°30´ - 9°30´  
Closest focusing distance: 0.39 m / 1.28 ft.  
Max. magnification:  
Field of view:  
0.28x (at 135 mm focal length)  
Approx. 248 x 372 - 53 x 80 mm / 9.76 x 14.65 - 2.09 x  
3.15 in. (at 0.39 m / 1.28 ft.)  
67 mm  
Filter size:  
Max. diameter x length: Approx. 76.6 x 96.0 mm / 3.02 x 3.78 in.  
Weight:  
Hood:  
Lens cap:  
Case:  
Approx. 480 g / 16.9 oz.  
EW-73B (sold separately)  
E-67 II  
LP1116 (sold separately)  
• EF-S18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM  
Focal length / Aperture: 18 mm-55 mm f/3.5-5.6  
Lens construction:  
Minimum aperture:  
13 elements in 11 groups  
f/22 - 36  
* f/22-38 when 1/2-stop increments set for aperture.  
Diagonal extent: 74°20´ - 27°50´  
Vertical extent: 45°30´ - 15°40´  
Horizontal extent: 64°30´ - 23°20´  
Angle of view:  
Closest focusing distance: 0.25 m / 0.82 ft.  
Max. magnification:  
Field of view:  
0.36x (at 55 mm focal length)  
Approx. 129 x 199 - 42 x 63 mm / 5.08 x 7.83 - 1.65 x  
2.48 in. (at 0.25 m / 0.82 ft.)  
58 mm  
Filter size:  
Max. diameter x length: Approx. 69.0 x 75.2 mm / 2.72 x 2.96 in.  
Weight:  
Hood:  
Lens cap:  
Case:  
Approx. 205 g / 7.2 oz.  
EW-63C (sold separately)  
E-58 II  
LP1016 (sold separately)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
409  
Specifications  
• EF-S55-250mm f/4-5.6 IS STM  
Focal length / Aperture: 55 mm-250 mm f/4-5.6  
Lens construction:  
Minimum aperture:  
Angle of view:  
15 elements in 12 groups  
f/22 - 32  
Diagonal extent: 27°50´ - 6°15´  
Vertical extent: 15°40´ - 3°30´  
Horizontal extent: 23°20´ - 5°20´  
Closest focusing distance: 0.85 m / 2.79 ft.  
Max. magnification:  
Field of view:  
0.29x (at 250 mm focal length)  
Approx. 197 x 296 - 52 x 78 mm / 7.76 x 11.69 - 2.05 x  
3.07 in. (at 0.85 m / 2.79 ft.)  
58 mm  
Filter size:  
Max. diameter x length: Approx. 70.0 x 111.2 mm / 2.76 x 4.38 in.  
Weight:  
Hood:  
Lens cap:  
Case:  
Approx. 375 g / 13.2 oz.  
ET-63 (sold separately)  
E-58 II  
LP1019 (sold separately)  
• EF-S18-200mm f/3.5-5.6 IS  
Focal length / Aperture: 18 mm-200 mm f/3.5-5.6  
Lens construction:  
Minimum aperture:  
16 elements in 12 groups  
f/22 - 36  
* f/22-38 when 1/2-stop increments set for aperture.  
Diagonal extent: 74°20´ - 7°50´  
Vertical extent: 45°30´ - 4°20´  
Horizontal extent: 64°30´ - 6°30´  
Angle of view:  
Closest focusing distance: 0.45 m / 1.5 ft.  
Max. magnification:  
Field of view:  
0.24x (at 200 mm focal length)  
Approx. 291 x 452 - 62 x 93 mm / 11.5 x 17.8 - 2.4 x 3.7 in.  
(at 0.45 m / 1.48 ft.  
)
Filter size:  
72 mm  
Max. diameter x length: Approx. 78.6 x 102 mm / 3.1 x 4.0 in.  
Weight:  
Hood:  
Lens cap:  
Case:  
Approx. 595 g / 21.0 oz.  
EW-78D (sold separately)  
E-72 II  
LP1116 (sold separately)  
All the data above is based on Canon’s testing standards and CIPA (Camera &  
Imaging Products Association) testing standards and guidelines.  
Dimensions, maximum diameter, length and weight listed above are based on  
CIPA Guidelines (except weight for camera body only).  
Product specifications and the exterior are subject to change without notice.  
If a problem occurs with a non-Canon lens attached to the camera, consult the  
respective lens manufacturer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
410  
Specifications  
Trademarks  
Adobe is a trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated.  
Microsoft and Windows are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft  
Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.  
Macintosh and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and  
other countries.  
SDXC logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.  
HDMI, HDMI logo, and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or  
registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.  
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.  
About MPEG-4 Licensing  
“This product is licensed under AT&T patents for the MPEG-4 standard and may be  
used for encoding MPEG-4 compliant video and/or decoding MPEG-4 compliant video  
that was encoded only (1) for a personal and non-commercial purpose or (2) by a  
video provider licensed under the AT&T patents to provide MPEG-4 compliant video.  
No license is granted or implied for any other use for MPEG-4 standard.”  
* Notice displayed in English as required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
411  
Use of genuine Canon accessories is recommended  
This product is designed to achieve excellent performance when used with  
genuine Canon accessories.  
Canon shall not be liable for any damage to this product and/or accidents such  
as fire, etc., caused by the malfunction of non-genuine Canon accessories (e.g.,  
a leakage and/or explosion of a battery pack). Please note that this warranty  
does not apply to repairs arising out of the malfunction of non-genuine Canon  
accessories, although you may request such repairs on a chargeable basis.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
412  
Digital Camera Model DS126481 Systems  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference,  
and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for  
class B digital devices, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These  
limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful  
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses  
and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in  
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to  
radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference  
will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause  
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be  
determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged  
to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following  
measures:  
— Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
— Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
— Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from  
that to which the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
The cable with the ferrite core provided with the digital camera must be used  
with this equipment in order to comply with Class B limits in Subpart B of Part  
15 of the FCC rules.  
Do not make any changes or modifications to the equipment unless otherwise  
specified in the manual. If such changes or modifications should be made, you  
could be required to stop operation of the equipment.  
Canon U.S.A. Inc.  
One Canon Park, Melville, NY 11747, U.S.A.  
Tel No. 1-800-OK-CANON (1-800-652-2666)  
CAN ICES-3 (B) / NMB-3 (B)  
When connecting to and using a household power outlet, use only AC  
Adapter Kit ACK-E18 (rated input: 100-240 V AC 50/60 Hz, rated  
output: 8.0 V DC). Using anything else can cause fire, overheating, or  
electrical shock.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
413  
USA and Canada only:  
The Lithium ion/polymer battery that powers the product is  
recyclable. Please call 1-800-8-BATTERY for information on  
how to recycle this battery.  
For CA, USA only  
Included lithium battery contains Perchlorate Material – special handling may apply.  
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/ for details.  
CAUTION  
RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT TYPE.  
DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO LOCAL REGULATION.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
414  
15  
Viewing the CD-ROM Instruction Manuals /  
Downloading Images to Your Computer  
This chapter explains how to view the Camera  
Instruction Manual CD-ROM on your computer,  
download images from the camera to your computer,  
gives an overview of the software in the EOS DIGITAL  
Solution Disk (CD-ROM), and explains how to install the  
software on your computer. It also explains how to view  
the Software Instruction Manuals.  
Camera Instruction  
Manual  
EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk  
(Software/Software Instruction Manuals)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
415  
 
Viewing the Camera Instruction Manual CD-ROM  
The Camera Instruction Manual CD-ROM contains  
instruction manuals (PDF files) related to this product.  
Viewing the Camera Instruction Manual CD-ROM  
To view the instruction manuals (PDF files), Adobe Reader 6.0 or higher  
must be installed on your computer. Adobe Reader can be downloaded  
free from the Internet. After installing Adobe Reader, follow the  
procedure below.  
Insert the “CAMERA INSTRUCTION  
MANUAL” CD-ROM into your computer.  
1
2
Double-click the CD-ROM.  
With Windows, double-click on the CD-ROM icon in  
[(My) Computer]. With Macintosh, double-click on  
the CD-ROM icon on the desktop.  
The icon displayed will differ depending on your  
computer’s operating system.  
Double-click the START file.  
The icon displayed will differ depending on your  
3
computer’s operating system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
416  
 
Viewing the Camera Instruction Manual CD-ROM  
Click your language.  
4
Click the instruction manual you want to  
5 read.  
The manual will be displayed.  
You can save the PDF file to your computer.  
To learn how to use Adobe Reader, refer to Adobe Reader’s Help  
section.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
417  
 
Downloading Images to a Computer  
You can use the EOS software to download the images in the camera to  
your computer. There are two ways to do this.  
Downloading by Connecting the Camera to the Computer  
Install the software (p.421).  
1
Use the provided interface cable  
2 to connect the camera to your  
computer.  
Use the interface cable provided with  
the camera.  
Connect the cable to the camera’s  
digital terminal with the cable plug’s  
<D> icon facing the front of the  
camera.  
Connect the cord’s plug to the  
computer’s USB terminal.  
Use EOS Utility to download the  
3 images.  
Refer to the EOS Utility Instruction  
If [51: Wi-Fi/NFC] is set to [Enable], the camera cannot be connected to a  
computer. Set [Wi-Fi/NFC] to [Disable], then reconnect the camera to a  
computer with an interface cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
418  
           
Downloading Images to a Computer  
Downloading Images with a Card Reader  
You can also use a card reader to download images to your computer.  
Install the software (p.421).  
1
Insert the card into the card  
2 reader.  
Use Digital Photo Professional to  
3 download the images.  
Refer to the Digital Photo Professional  
Instruction Manual (p.422).  
When downloading images from the camera to your computer with a card  
reader without using EOS software, copy the DCIM folder on the card to  
your computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
419  
Software Overview  
EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk  
Various software for EOS DIGITAL cameras are contained  
on the EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk.  
EOS Utility  
With the camera connected to a computer, EOS Utility enables you to  
transfer still photos and movies shot with the camera to the computer.  
You can use this software to set various camera settings and shoot  
remotely from the computer connected to the camera. Also, you can  
copy background music tracks, such as EOS Sample Music*, to the  
card.  
* You can use the background music as the soundtrack for a video snapshot  
album, movie, or slide show played back with your camera.  
Digital Photo Professional  
This software is recommended for users who shoot RAW images. You  
can view, edit, and print RAW images and JPEG images.  
* Some functions differ between the version to be installed on a 64-bit computer  
and that to be installed on a 32-bit computer.  
Picture Style Editor  
You can edit Picture Styles, and create and save original Picture Style  
files. This software is aimed at advanced users who are experienced in  
processing images.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
420  
       
Installing the Software  
Do not connect the camera to your computer before you install the  
software. The software will not be installed correctly.  
If a previous version is installed, follow the steps below to reinstall the  
software. (The newer version will overwrite the previous version.)  
1
Insert the EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk into your computer.  
For Macintosh, double-click to open the CD-ROM icon displayed  
on the desktop, then double-click on [setup].  
2 Click [Easy Installation] and follow the on-screen  
instructions to install.  
If the install screen for “Microsoft Silverlight” is displayed during  
installation, install “Microsoft Silverlight”.  
3 Click [Restart] and remove the CD-ROM after the  
computer restarts.  
When the computer has restarted, the installation is complete.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
421  
   
Software Instruction Manual  
Software Instruction Manuals are contained on the EOS  
DIGITAL Solution Disk. You can copy and view the  
software instruction manual (PDF files) as follows:  
1
Insert the EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk into your computer.  
2 Close the install screen.  
When the EOS DIGITAL Solution Disk install screen appears,  
close the install screen.  
3 Open the CD-ROM.  
4 Open the [Manual] folder.  
5 Copy the [English] folder to your computer.  
Instruction Manual PDFs with the names below are copied.  
Windows  
Macintosh  
EOS Utility  
EUx.xW_E_xx  
DPPx.xW_E_xx  
PSEx.xW_E_xx  
EUx.xM_E_xx  
DPPx.xM_E_xx  
PSEx.xM_E_xx  
Digital Photo Professional  
Picture Style Editor  
6 Double-click the copied PDF file.  
Adobe Reader (most recent version recommended) must be  
installed on your computer.  
Adobe Reader can be downloaded free from the Internet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
422  
   
Index  
Numerics  
A
B
AF  
Measurement method  
(metering mode)....................... 167  
C
Camera  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
423  
 
Index  
D
Dials  
Center-weighted average  
metering........................................168  
Color space  
(color reproduction range) ............156  
E
F
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
424  
Index  
Fully automatic shooting  
(Scene Intelligent Auto).................. 76  
Functions settable by  
shooting mode.............................. 370  
G
Flash  
H
Flash exposure bracketing  
(FEB) ........................................186  
Shutter synchronization  
(1st/2nd curtain)........................187  
I
Focusing 9 AF  
Images  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
425  
Index  
Jump display  
Chromatic aberration  
(image browsing)......................293  
correction................................. 151  
Peripheral illumination  
correction................................. 150  
Maximum ISO speed  
for ISO Auto..............................133  
J
K
M
L
Memory cards 9 Cards  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
426  
Index  
N
Noise reduction  
Editing out first and  
O
P
last scenes................................306  
Power  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
427  
Index  
SD, SDHC, SDXC cards 9 Cards  
Sensitivity 9 ISO speed  
Q
R
Shutter synchronization  
(1st/2nd curtain) ........................... 187  
Silent shooting  
S
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
428  
Index  
W
T
Z
U
V
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
429  
The descriptions in this Instruction Manual are current as of March 2015. For  
information on the compatibility with any products introduced after this date,  
contact any Canon Service Center. For the latest version Instruction Manual,  
refer to the Canon Web site.  
CPX-E123-001  
© CANON INC. 2015  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Beko Washer WM5120S User Manual
Black Box Surge Protector 26761 User Manual
Black Decker Laser Level BDL190S User Manual
Blaupunkt Car Stereo System Car Multimedia User Manual
Blomberg Clothes Dryer TAF 7230 A User Manual
Blue Rhino Insect Control Equipment SV3500C User Manual
Caframo Fan 827CA TCS User Manual
Chauvet Insect Control Equipment Hurricane 1100 User Manual
Chief Manufacturing Indoor Furnishings SSC 1 User Manual
Cisco Systems Computer Hardware 78 16356 01 User Manual